]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
3f60c3f603a903035084d1228c319f3be34abfe1
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
53 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
54 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
57
58 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
59 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
61 \else
62 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
63 \fi
64 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69
70 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
77 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
94
95 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
96 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
97 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
98 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
99 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
100 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
103 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
108
109 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
110 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
111 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
112 }
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
115
116 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
117 {\mbox{}}
118 }
119
120 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
121 \gnusdimen 0pt
122
123 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
124 \gnuscleardoublepage
125 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
126 \chapter{#2}
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
128 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
129 \thispagestyle{empty}
130 \hspace*{-2cm}
131 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
132 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
133 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
134 \end{picture}
135 \clearpage
136 }
137
138 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
139 \begin{figure}
140 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
141 #3
142 \end{picture}
143 \caption{#1}
144 \end{figure}
145 }
146
147 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
148 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
149 }
150
151 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
152 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
153 }
154
155 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
156 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
157 }
158
159 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
160 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
161 }
162
163 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
164
165 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
166 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
167 \section{#1}
168 }
169
170 \newenvironment{codelist}%
171 {\begin{list}{}{
172 }
173 }{\end{list}}
174
175 \newenvironment{asislist}%
176 {\begin{list}{}{
177 }
178 }{\end{list}}
179
180 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
181 {\begin{list}{}{
182 \labelwidth=0cm
183 }
184 }{\end{list}}
185
186 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
187 {\begin{list}{}{
188 }
189 }{\end{list}}
190
191 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
192 {\begin{list}{}{
193 }
194 }{\end{list}}
195
196 \newenvironment{samplist}%
197 {\begin{list}{}{
198 }
199 }{\end{list}}
200
201 \newenvironment{varlist}%
202 {\begin{list}{}{
203 }
204 }{\end{list}}
205
206 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
207 {\begin{list}{}{
208 }
209 }{\end{list}}
210
211 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
212 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
213 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
214
215 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
216 {
217 {
218 \ifodd\count0
219 {
220 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
221 }
222 \else
223 {
224 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
225 }
226 }
227 \fi
228 }
229 }
230 {
231 \ifodd\count0
232 \mbox{} \hfill
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \else
235 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
236 \hfill \mbox{}
237 \fi
238 }
239
240 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
241 {
242 {
243 \ifodd\count0
244 {
245 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
246 }
247 \else
248 {
249 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
250 }
251 \fi
252 }
253 }
254 {
255 \ifodd\count0
256 \mbox{} \hfill
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \else
259 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
260 \hfill \mbox{}
261 \fi
262 }
263
264 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
265 {
266 {
267 \ifodd\count0
268 {
269 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
270 }
271 \else
272 {
273 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
274 }
275 \fi
276 }
277 }
278 {
279 \ifodd\count0
280 \mbox{} \hfill
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \else
283 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
284 \hfill \mbox{}
285 \fi
286 }
287
288 \pagenumbering{roman}
289 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
290
291 @end iflatex
292 @end iftex
293
294 @iftex
295 @iflatex
296
297 \begin{titlepage}
298 {
299
300 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
301 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
302 \parindent=0cm
303 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
304
305 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
306 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
307 \vfill
308 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
309 \vfill
310 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
311 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
312 \newpage
313 }
314
315 \mbox{}
316 \vfill
317
318 \thispagestyle{empty}
319
320 @c @insertcopying
321 \newpage
322 \end{titlepage}
323 @end iflatex
324 @end iftex
325
326 @ifnottex
327 @insertcopying
328 @end ifnottex
329
330 @dircategory Emacs
331 @direntry
332 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
333 @end direntry
334 @iftex
335 @finalout
336 @end iftex
337 @setchapternewpage odd
338
339
340
341 @titlepage
342 @title Gnus Manual
343
344 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
345 @page
346 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
347 @insertcopying
348 @end titlepage
349
350
351 @node Top
352 @top The Gnus Newsreader
353
354 @ifinfo
355
356 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
357 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
358 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
359 luck.
360
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
362
363 @end ifinfo
364
365 @iftex
366
367 @iflatex
368 \tableofcontents
369 \gnuscleardoublepage
370 @end iflatex
371
372 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
373 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
374
375 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
376 being accused of plagiarism:
377
378 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
379 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
380 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
381 can even read news with it!
382
383 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
384 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
385 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
386 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
387 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
388 the program.
389
390 @end iftex
391
392 @menu
393 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
394 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
395 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
396 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
397 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
398 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
399 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
400 * Various:: General purpose settings.
401 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
402 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
403 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
404 * Key Index:: Key Index.
405
406 Other related manuals
407
408 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
409 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
410 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
411 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
412
413 @detailmenu
414 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
415
416 Starting Gnus
417
418 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
419 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
420 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
421 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
422 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
423 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
424 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
425 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
426 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
427 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
428 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
429
430 New Groups
431
432 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
433 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
434 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
435
436 Group Buffer
437
438 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
439 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
440 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
443 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
444 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
445 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
446 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
447 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
448 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
449 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
450 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
451 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
452 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
453 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
454 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
455
456 Group Buffer Format
457
458 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
459 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
460 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
461
462 Group Topics
463
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
466 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
467 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
468 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
469
470 Misc Group Stuff
471
472 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
473 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
474 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
475 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
476 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
477
478 Summary Buffer
479
480 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
481 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
482 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
483 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
484 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
485 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
486 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
487 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
488 * Threading:: How threads are made.
489 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
490 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
491 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
492 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
493 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
494 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
495 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
496 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
497 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
498 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
499 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
500 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
501 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
502 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
503 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
504 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
505 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
506 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
507 or reselecting the current group.
508 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
509 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
510 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
511 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
512
513 Summary Buffer Format
514
515 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
516 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
517 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
518 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
519
520 Choosing Articles
521
522 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
523 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
524
525 Reply, Followup and Post
526
527 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
528 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
529 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
530 * Canceling and Superseding::
531
532 Marking Articles
533
534 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
535 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
536 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
537 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
538 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
539 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
540
541 Threading
542
543 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
544 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
545
546 Customizing Threading
547
548 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
549 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
550 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
551 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
552
553 Decoding Articles
554
555 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
556 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
557 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
558 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
559 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
560 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
561
562 Decoding Variables
563
564 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
565 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
566 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
567
568 Article Treatment
569
570 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
571 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
572 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
573 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
574 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
575 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
576 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
577 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
578 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
579 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
580 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
581
582 Alternative Approaches
583
584 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
585 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
586
587 Various Summary Stuff
588
589 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
590 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
591 * Summary Generation Commands::
592 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
593
594 Article Buffer
595
596 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
597 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
598 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
599 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
600 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
601
602 Composing Messages
603
604 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
605 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
606 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
607 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
608 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
609 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
610 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
611 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
612 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
613
614 Select Methods
615
616 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
617 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
618 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
619 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
620 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
621 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
622 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
623 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
624
625 Server Buffer
626
627 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
628 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
629 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
630 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
631 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
632 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
633 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
634
635 Getting News
636
637 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
638 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
639
640 @acronym{NNTP}
641
642 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
643 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
644 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
645
646 Getting Mail
647
648 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
649 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
650 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
651 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
652 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
653 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
654 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
655 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
656 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
657 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
658 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
659 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
660 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
661
662 Mail Sources
663
664 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
665 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
666 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
667
668 Choosing a Mail Back End
669
670 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
671 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
672 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
673 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
674 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
675 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
676 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
677
678 Browsing the Web
679
680 * Archiving Mail::
681 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
682 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
683 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
684 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
685 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
686 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
687
688 @acronym{IMAP}
689
690 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
691 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
692 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
693 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
694 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
695 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
696
697 Other Sources
698
699 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
700 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
701 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
702 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
703 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
704
705 Document Groups
706
707 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
708
709 SOUP
710
711 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
712 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
713 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
714
715 Combined Groups
716
717 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
718 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
719
720 Gnus Unplugged
721
722 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
723 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
724 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
725 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
726 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
727 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
728 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
729 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
730 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
731 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
732 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
733 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
734 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
735
736 Agent Categories
737
738 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
739 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
740 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
741
742 Agent Commands
743
744 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
745 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
746 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
747
748 Scoring
749
750 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
751 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
752 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
753 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
754 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
755 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
756 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
757 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
758 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
759 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
760 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
761 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
762 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
763 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
764 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
765 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
766 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
767
768 GroupLens
769
770 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
771 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
772 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
773 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
774
775 Advanced Scoring
776
777 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
778 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
779 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
780
781 Various
782
783 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
784 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
785 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
786 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
787 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
788 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
789 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
790 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
791 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
792 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
793 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
794 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
795 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
796 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
797 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
798 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
799 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
800 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
801 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
802 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
803
804 Formatting Variables
805
806 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
807 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
808 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
809 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
810 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
811 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
812 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
813 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
814
815 Image Enhancements
816
817 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
818 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
819 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
820 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
821 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
822
823 Thwarting Email Spam
824
825 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
826 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
827 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
828 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
829 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
830 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
831
832 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
833
834 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
835 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
836 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
838 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
839 * BBDB Whitelists::
840 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
841 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
842 * Blackholes::
843 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
844 * Bogofilter::
845 * ifile spam filtering::
846 * spam-stat spam filtering::
847 * SpamOracle::
848 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
849
850 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
851
852 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
853 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
854 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
855
856 Appendices
857
858 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
859 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
860 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
861 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
862 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
863 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
864 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
865 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
866 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
867
868 History
869
870 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
871 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
872 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
873 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
874 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
875 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
876 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
877 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
878 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
879
880 New Features
881
882 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
883 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
884 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
885 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
886 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
887 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
888
889 Customization
890
891 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
892 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
893 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
894 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
895
896 Gnus Reference Guide
897
898 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
899 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
900 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
901 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
902 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
903 * Group Info:: The group info format.
904 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
905 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
906 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
907
908 Back End Interface
909
910 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
911 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
912 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
913 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
914 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
915 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
916
917 Various File Formats
918
919 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
920 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
921
922 Emacs for Heathens
923
924 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
925 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
926
927 @end detailmenu
928 @end menu
929
930 @node Starting Up
931 @chapter Starting Gnus
932 @cindex starting up
933
934 @kindex M-x gnus
935 @findex gnus
936 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
937 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
938 your Emacs.
939
940 @findex gnus-other-frame
941 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
942 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
943 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
944
945 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
946 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
947 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
948
949 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
950 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
951
952 @menu
953 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
954 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
955 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
956 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
957 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
958 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
959 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
960 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
961 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
962 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
963 @end menu
964
965
966 @node Finding the News
967 @section Finding the News
968 @cindex finding news
969
970 @vindex gnus-select-method
971 @c @head
972 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
973 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
974 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
975 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
976 foreign groups.
977
978 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
979 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
980
981 @lisp
982 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
983 @end lisp
984
985 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
986
987 @lisp
988 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
989 @end lisp
990
991 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
992 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
993 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
994 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
995
996 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
997 @cindex NNTPSERVER
998 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
999 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1000 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1001 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1002 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1003 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1004 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1005
1006 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1007 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1008 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1009 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1010
1011 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1012 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1013 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1014 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1015 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1016 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1017 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1018 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1019 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1020 server.)
1021
1022 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1023 @kindex B (Group)
1024 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1025 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1026 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1027 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1028 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1029 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1030
1031 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1032 @c @head
1033 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1034 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1035 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1036 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1037 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1038 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1039 groups are.
1040
1041 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1042 you would typically set this variable to
1043
1044 @lisp
1045 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1046 @end lisp
1047
1048
1049 @node The First Time
1050 @section The First Time
1051 @cindex first time usage
1052
1053 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1054 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1055
1056 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1057 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1058 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1059 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1060 something useful.
1061
1062 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1063 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1064 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1065
1066 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1067 help you with most common problems.
1068
1069 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1070 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1071 special.
1072
1073
1074 @node The Server is Down
1075 @section The Server is Down
1076 @cindex server errors
1077
1078 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1079 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1080 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1081
1082 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1083 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1084 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1085 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1086 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1087 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1088 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1089
1090 @findex gnus-no-server
1091 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1092 @c @head
1093 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1094 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1095 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1096 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1097 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1098 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1099 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1100
1101
1102 @node Slave Gnusae
1103 @section Slave Gnusae
1104 @cindex slave
1105
1106 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1107 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1108 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1109 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1110
1111 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1112 @file{.newsrc} file.
1113
1114 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1115 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1116 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1117 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1118 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1119 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1120 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1121
1122 @findex gnus-slave
1123 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1124 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1125 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1126 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1127 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1128 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1129 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1130 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1131
1132 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1133 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1134
1135 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1136 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1137 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1138 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1139 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1140
1141
1142
1143 @node New Groups
1144 @section New Groups
1145 @cindex new groups
1146 @cindex subscription
1147
1148 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1149 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1150 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1151 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1152 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1153 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1154 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1155 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1156 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1157
1158 @menu
1159 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1160 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1161 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1162 @end menu
1163
1164
1165 @node Checking New Groups
1166 @subsection Checking New Groups
1167
1168 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1169 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1170 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1171 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1172 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1173 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1174 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1175 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1176 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1177 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1178
1179 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1190
1191 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1197
1198
1199 @node Subscription Methods
1200 @subsection Subscription Methods
1201
1202 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1205
1206 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1208
1209 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1210
1211 @table @code
1212
1213 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1216 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1217 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1218
1219 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1220 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1222 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1223
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1227
1228 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1229 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1231 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1232 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1233 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1234 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1235 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1236 up. Or something like that.
1237
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1241 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1242 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1243
1244 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1245 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 Kill all new groups.
1247
1248 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1249 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1251 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1252 topic parameter that looks like
1253
1254 @example
1255 "nnslashdot"
1256 @end example
1257
1258 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1259 that topic.
1260
1261 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1262 top-level topic.
1263
1264 @end table
1265
1266 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1267 A closely related variable is
1268 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1269 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1270 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1271 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1272 hierarchy or not.
1273
1274 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1275 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1277 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1278
1279
1280 @node Filtering New Groups
1281 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1282
1283 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1284 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1285 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1286
1287 @example
1288 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1289 @end example
1290
1291 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1292 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1293 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1294 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1295 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1296 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1297 subscribing these groups.
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1299 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1300
1301 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1302 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1303 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1304 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1305 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1306 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1307 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1308 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1309
1310 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1311 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1312 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1313 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1314 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1315 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1316 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1317 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1318 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1319 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1320 @code{nil}.
1321
1322 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1323 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1324
1325
1326 @node Changing Servers
1327 @section Changing Servers
1328 @cindex changing servers
1329
1330 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1331 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1332 very flaky and you want to use another.
1333
1334 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1335 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1336
1337 @emph{Wrong!}
1338
1339 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1340 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1341 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1342 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1343 worthless.
1344
1345 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1346 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1347 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1348 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1349
1350 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1351 @findex gnus-change-server
1352 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1353 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1354 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1355 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1356 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1357
1358 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1359 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1361 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1362 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1363
1364 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1365 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1367 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1368 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1369 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1370
1371 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1372 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1373 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1374 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1375
1376 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1377 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1378 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1379 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1380 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1381 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1382 cache for all groups).
1383
1384
1385 @node Startup Files
1386 @section Startup Files
1387 @cindex startup files
1388 @cindex .newsrc
1389 @cindex .newsrc.el
1390 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1391
1392 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1393 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1394 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1395 read.
1396
1397 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1398 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1399 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1400 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1402 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1403 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1404
1405 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1406 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1407 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1408 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1409 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1410 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1411
1412 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1413 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1414 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1415 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1416 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1417 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1418 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1419 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1420 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1421 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1422 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1423 news reader.
1424
1425 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1426 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1427 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1428 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1429 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1430 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1431 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1432 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1433 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1434 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1435 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1436 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1437
1438 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1439 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1440 @vindex version-control
1441 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1442 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1443 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1444 If you want version control for this file, set
1445 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1446 @code{version-control} variable.
1447
1448 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1449 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1451 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1452 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1453 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1454 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1455 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1456 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1457 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1458
1459 @lisp
1460 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1461 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1462
1463 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 @end lisp
1466
1467 @vindex gnus-init-file
1468 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1469 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1470 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1471 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1472 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1473 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1474 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1475 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1476 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1477 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1478 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1479 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1480 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1481
1482
1483 @node Auto Save
1484 @section Auto Save
1485 @cindex dribble file
1486 @cindex auto-save
1487
1488 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1489 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1490 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1491 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1492 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1493 this file.
1494
1495 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1496 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1497 saved.
1498
1499 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1500 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1501 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1502
1503 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1504 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1505 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1506 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1507 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1508 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1509
1510 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1511 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1512 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1513
1514
1515 @node The Active File
1516 @section The Active File
1517 @cindex active file
1518 @cindex ignored groups
1519
1520 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1521 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1522 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1523
1524 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1525 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1526 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1527 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1528 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1529 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1530 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1531
1532 @c This variable is
1533 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1534 @c if you set it to anything else.
1535
1536 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1537 @c @head
1538 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1539 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1540 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1541
1542 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1543 you actually subscribe to.
1544
1545 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1546 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1547 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1548 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1549
1550 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1551 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1552 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1553 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1554 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1555 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1556
1557 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1558 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1559 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1560 variable.
1561
1562 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1563 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1564 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1565 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1566 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1567 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1568
1569 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1570 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1571
1572 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1573 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1574
1575 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1576 secondary select methods.
1577
1578
1579 @node Startup Variables
1580 @section Startup Variables
1581
1582 @table @code
1583
1584 @item gnus-load-hook
1585 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1586 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1587 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1588 times you start Gnus.
1589
1590 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1593
1594 @item gnus-startup-hook
1595 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1596 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1597
1598 @item gnus-started-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1600 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1601 successfully.
1602
1603 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1604 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1606 generating the group buffer.
1607
1608 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1609 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1611 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1612 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1613 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1614 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1615 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1616
1617 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1618 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1620 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1621 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1622 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1623
1624 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1625 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1626 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1627
1628 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1629 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1631
1632 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1633 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1634 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1635 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1636
1637 @end table
1638
1639
1640 @node Group Buffer
1641 @chapter Group Buffer
1642 @cindex group buffer
1643
1644 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1645 @c
1646 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1647 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1648 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1649 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1650 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1651 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1652 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1653 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1654 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1655 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1656 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1657 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1658 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1659 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1660 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1661 @c human rights at 9...
1662
1663
1664 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1665 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1666 long as Gnus is active.
1667
1668 @iftex
1669 @iflatex
1670 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1671 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1672 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1673 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1674 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1675 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1676 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1677 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1678 }
1679 @end iflatex
1680 @end iftex
1681
1682 @menu
1683 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1684 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1685 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1686 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1687 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1688 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1689 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1690 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1691 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1692 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1693 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1694 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1695 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1696 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1697 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1698 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1699 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1700 @end menu
1701
1702
1703 @node Group Buffer Format
1704 @section Group Buffer Format
1705
1706 @menu
1707 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1708 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1709 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1710 @end menu
1711
1712
1713 @node Group Line Specification
1714 @subsection Group Line Specification
1715 @cindex group buffer format
1716
1717 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1718 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1719
1720 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1721
1722 @example
1723 25: news.announce.newusers
1724 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1725 @end example
1726
1727 Quite simple, huh?
1728
1729 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1730 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1731 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1732 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1733
1734 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1735 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1736 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1737 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1738 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1739 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1740
1741 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1742
1743 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1744 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1745 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1746 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1747 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1748
1749 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1750 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1751 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1752
1753 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1754
1755 @table @samp
1756
1757 @item M
1758 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1759
1760 @item S
1761 Whether the group is subscribed.
1762
1763 @item L
1764 Level of subscribedness.
1765
1766 @item N
1767 Number of unread articles.
1768
1769 @item I
1770 Number of dormant articles.
1771
1772 @item T
1773 Number of ticked articles.
1774
1775 @item R
1776 Number of read articles.
1777
1778 @item U
1779 Number of unseen articles.
1780
1781 @item t
1782 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1783 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1784
1785 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1786 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1787 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1788 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1789 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1790 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1791 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1792 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1793
1794 @item y
1795 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1796
1797 @item i
1798 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1799
1800 @item g
1801 Full group name.
1802
1803 @item G
1804 Group name.
1805
1806 @item C
1807 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1808 comment element in the group parameters.
1809
1810 @item D
1811 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1812 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1813 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1814 command.
1815
1816 @item o
1817 @samp{m} if moderated.
1818
1819 @item O
1820 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1821
1822 @item s
1823 Select method.
1824
1825 @item B
1826 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1827
1828 @item n
1829 Select from where.
1830
1831 @item z
1832 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1833 used.
1834
1835 @item P
1836 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1837
1838 @item c
1839 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1840 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1841 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1842 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1843 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1844
1845 @item m
1846 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1847 @cindex %
1848 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1849 the group lately.
1850
1851 @item p
1852 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1853
1854 @item d
1855 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1856 Timestamp}).
1857
1858 @item u
1859 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1860 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1861 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1862 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1863 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1864 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1865 specifier.
1866 @end table
1867
1868 @cindex *
1869 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1870 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1871 group, or a bogus native group.
1872
1873
1874 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1875 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1876 @cindex group mode line
1877
1878 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1879 The mode line can be changed by setting
1880 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1881 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1882
1883 @table @samp
1884 @item S
1885 The native news server.
1886 @item M
1887 The native select method.
1888 @end table
1889
1890
1891 @node Group Highlighting
1892 @subsection Group Highlighting
1893 @cindex highlighting
1894 @cindex group highlighting
1895
1896 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1897 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1898 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1899 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1900 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1901
1902 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1903 background is dark:
1904
1905 @lisp
1906 (cond (window-system
1907 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1908 (defface my-group-face-1
1909 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1910 (defface my-group-face-2
1911 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1912 "Second group face")
1913 (defface my-group-face-3
1914 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-4
1916 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1917 (defface my-group-face-5
1918 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1919
1920 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1921 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1922 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1923 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1924 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1925 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1926 @end lisp
1927
1928 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1929
1930 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1931 include:
1932
1933 @table @code
1934 @item group
1935 The group name.
1936 @item unread
1937 The number of unread articles in the group.
1938 @item method
1939 The select method.
1940 @item mailp
1941 Whether the group is a mail group.
1942 @item level
1943 The level of the group.
1944 @item score
1945 The score of the group.
1946 @item ticked
1947 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1948 @item total
1949 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1950 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1951 @item topic
1952 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1953 topic being inserted.
1954 @end table
1955
1956 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1957 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1958 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1959
1960 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1961 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1962 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1963 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1964 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1965
1966
1967 @node Group Maneuvering
1968 @section Group Maneuvering
1969 @cindex group movement
1970
1971 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1972 expected, hopefully.
1973
1974 @table @kbd
1975
1976 @item n
1977 @kindex n (Group)
1978 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1979 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1980 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1981
1982 @item p
1983 @itemx DEL
1984 @kindex DEL (Group)
1985 @kindex p (Group)
1986 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1987 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1988 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1989
1990 @item N
1991 @kindex N (Group)
1992 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1993 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1994
1995 @item P
1996 @kindex P (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1998 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1999
2000 @item M-n
2001 @kindex M-n (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2003 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2004 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2005
2006 @item M-p
2007 @kindex M-p (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2009 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2010 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2011 @end table
2012
2013 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2014
2015 @table @kbd
2016
2017 @item j
2018 @kindex j (Group)
2019 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2020 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2021 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2022 like living groups.
2023
2024 @item ,
2025 @kindex , (Group)
2026 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2027 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2028 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2029
2030 @item .
2031 @kindex . (Group)
2032 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2033 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2034 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2035 @end table
2036
2037 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2038 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2039 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2040 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2041 is @code{t}.
2042
2043
2044 @node Selecting a Group
2045 @section Selecting a Group
2046 @cindex group selection
2047
2048 @table @kbd
2049
2050 @item SPACE
2051 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2052 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2053 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2054 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2055 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2056 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2057 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2058 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2059 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2060 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2061
2062 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2063 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2064 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2065
2066 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2067 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2068 ones.
2069
2070 @item RET
2071 @kindex RET (Group)
2072 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2073 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2074 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2075 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2076 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2077 entry.
2078
2079 @item M-RET
2080 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2081 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2082 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2083 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2084 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2085 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2086 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2087 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2088 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2089 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2090
2091 @item M-SPACE
2092 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2093 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2094 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2095 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2096 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2097
2098 @item C-M-RET
2099 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2100 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2101 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2102 doing any processing of its contents
2103 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2104 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2105 manner will have no permanent effects.
2106
2107 @end table
2108
2109 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2110 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2111 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2112 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2113 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2114 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2115 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2116 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2117 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2118 most recently will be fetched.
2119
2120 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2121 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2122 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2123 newsgroups.
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2126 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2127 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2128 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2129 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2130 Which article this is is controlled by the
2131 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2132 variable is:
2133
2134 @table @code
2135
2136 @item unread
2137 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2138
2139 @item first
2140 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2141
2142 @item unseen
2143 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2144
2145 @item unseen-or-unread
2146 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2147 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2148 unread article.
2149
2150 @item best
2151 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2152
2153 @end table
2154
2155 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2156 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2157
2158 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2159 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2160 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2161 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2162 selected.
2163
2164
2165 @node Subscription Commands
2166 @section Subscription Commands
2167 @cindex subscription
2168
2169 @table @kbd
2170
2171 @item S t
2172 @itemx u
2173 @kindex S t (Group)
2174 @kindex u (Group)
2175 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2176 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2177 Toggle subscription to the current group
2178 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2179
2180 @item S s
2181 @itemx U
2182 @kindex S s (Group)
2183 @kindex U (Group)
2184 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2185 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2186 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2187 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2188
2189 @item S k
2190 @itemx C-k
2191 @kindex S k (Group)
2192 @kindex C-k (Group)
2193 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2194 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2195 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2196
2197 @item S y
2198 @itemx C-y
2199 @kindex S y (Group)
2200 @kindex C-y (Group)
2201 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2202 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2203
2204 @item C-x C-t
2205 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2206 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2207 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2208 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2209 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2210
2211 @item S w
2212 @itemx C-w
2213 @kindex S w (Group)
2214 @kindex C-w (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2216 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2217
2218 @item S z
2219 @kindex S z (Group)
2220 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2221 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2222
2223 @item S C-k
2224 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2226 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2227 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2228 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2229 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2230 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2231 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2232 @file{.newsrc} file.
2233
2234 @end table
2235
2236 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2237
2238
2239 @node Group Data
2240 @section Group Data
2241
2242 @table @kbd
2243
2244 @item c
2245 @kindex c (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2247 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2248 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2249 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2250 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2251 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2252 the group buffer.
2253
2254 @item C
2255 @kindex C (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2257 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2258 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2259
2260 @item M-c
2261 @kindex M-c (Group)
2262 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2263 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2264 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2265
2266 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2267 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2268 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2269 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2270 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2271 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2272 caution.
2273
2274 @end table
2275
2276
2277 @node Group Levels
2278 @section Group Levels
2279 @cindex group level
2280 @cindex level
2281
2282 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2283 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2284 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2285 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2286 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2287
2288 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2289
2290 @table @kbd
2291
2292 @item S l
2293 @kindex S l (Group)
2294 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2295 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2296 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2297 prompted for a level.
2298 @end table
2299
2300 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2301 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2302 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2303 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2304 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2305 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2306 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2307 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2308 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2309 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2310 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2311 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2312 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2313 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2314 reasons of efficiency.
2315
2316 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2317 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2318
2319 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2320 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2321 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2322 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2323 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2324 groups are hidden, in a way.
2325
2326 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2327 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2328 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2329 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2330 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2331 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2332
2333 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2334 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2335 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2336 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2337 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2338 list of killed groups.)
2339
2340 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2341 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2342 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2343
2344 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2345 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2346 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2347 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2348 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2349 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2350 relevant valid ranges.
2351
2352 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2353 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2354 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2355 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2356 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2357 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2358 rest.
2359
2360 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2361 one with the best level.
2362
2363 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2364 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2365 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2366 by default.
2367
2368 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2369 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2370 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2371 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2372 listed.
2373
2374 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2375 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2376 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2377 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2378
2379 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2380 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2381 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2382 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2383 to 5. The default is 6.
2384
2385
2386 @node Group Score
2387 @section Group Score
2388 @cindex group score
2389 @cindex group rank
2390 @cindex rank
2391
2392 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2393 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2394 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2395 reason?
2396
2397 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2398 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2399 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2400 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2401 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2402 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2403 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2404 least significant part.))
2405
2406 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2407 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2408 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2409 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2410 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2411 action after each summary exit, you can add
2412 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2413 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2414 slow things down somewhat.
2415
2416
2417 @node Marking Groups
2418 @section Marking Groups
2419 @cindex marking groups
2420
2421 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2422 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2423 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2424 bidding on those groups.
2425
2426 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2427 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2428 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2429
2430 @table @kbd
2431
2432 @item #
2433 @kindex # (Group)
2434 @itemx M m
2435 @kindex M m (Group)
2436 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2437 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2438
2439 @item M-#
2440 @kindex M-# (Group)
2441 @itemx M u
2442 @kindex M u (Group)
2443 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2444 Remove the mark from the current group
2445 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2446
2447 @item M U
2448 @kindex M U (Group)
2449 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2450 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2451
2452 @item M w
2453 @kindex M w (Group)
2454 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2455 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2456
2457 @item M b
2458 @kindex M b (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2460 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2461
2462 @item M r
2463 @kindex M r (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2465 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2466 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2467 @end table
2468
2469 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2470
2471 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2472 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2473 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2474 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2475 the command to be executed.
2476
2477
2478 @node Foreign Groups
2479 @section Foreign Groups
2480 @cindex foreign groups
2481
2482 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2483 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2484 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2485 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2486 consulted.
2487
2488 @table @kbd
2489
2490 @item G m
2491 @kindex G m (Group)
2492 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2493 @cindex making groups
2494 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2495 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2496 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2497
2498 @item G M
2499 @kindex G M (Group)
2500 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2501 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2502 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2503
2504 @item G r
2505 @kindex G r (Group)
2506 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2507 @cindex renaming groups
2508 Rename the current group to something else
2509 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2510 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2511 on some back ends.
2512
2513 @item G c
2514 @kindex G c (Group)
2515 @cindex customizing
2516 @findex gnus-group-customize
2517 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2518
2519 @item G e
2520 @kindex G e (Group)
2521 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2522 @cindex renaming groups
2523 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2524 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2525
2526 @item G p
2527 @kindex G p (Group)
2528 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2529 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2530 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2531
2532 @item G E
2533 @kindex G E (Group)
2534 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2535 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2536 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2537
2538 @item G d
2539 @kindex G d (Group)
2540 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2541 @cindex nndir
2542 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2543 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2544
2545 @item G h
2546 @kindex G h (Group)
2547 @cindex help group
2548 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2549 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2550
2551 @item G a
2552 @kindex G a (Group)
2553 @cindex (ding) archive
2554 @cindex archive group
2555 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2556 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2557 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2558 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2559 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2560 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2561 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2562
2563 @item G k
2564 @kindex G k (Group)
2565 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2566 @cindex nnkiboze
2567 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2568 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2569 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2570 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2571
2572 @item G D
2573 @kindex G D (Group)
2574 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2575 @cindex nneething
2576 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2577 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2578 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2579
2580 @item G f
2581 @kindex G f (Group)
2582 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2583 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2584 @cindex nndoc
2585 Make a group based on some file or other
2586 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2587 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2588 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2589 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2590 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2591 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2592 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2593 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2594 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2595
2596 @item G u
2597 @kindex G u (Group)
2598 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2599 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2600 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2601 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2602
2603 @item G w
2604 @kindex G w (Group)
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2606 @cindex Google
2607 @cindex nnweb
2608 @cindex gmane
2609 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2610 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2611 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2612 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2613 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2614 @xref{Web Searches}.
2615
2616 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2617 to a particular group by using a match string like
2618 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2619
2620 @item G R
2621 @kindex G R (Group)
2622 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2623 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2624 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2625 @xref{RSS}.
2626
2627 @item G DEL
2628 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2629 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2630 This function will delete the current group
2631 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2632 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2633 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2634 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2635 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2636
2637 @item G V
2638 @kindex G V (Group)
2639 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2640 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2641 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2642
2643 @item G v
2644 @kindex G v (Group)
2645 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2646 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2647 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2648 @end table
2649
2650 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2651 methods.
2652
2653 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2654 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2655 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2656 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2657 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2658 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2659 newsgroups.
2660
2661
2662 @node Group Parameters
2663 @section Group Parameters
2664 @cindex group parameters
2665
2666 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2667 Here's an example group parameter list:
2668
2669 @example
2670 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2671 (auto-expire . t))
2672 @end example
2673
2674 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2675 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2676 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2677 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2678
2679 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2680 is an alist of regexps and values.
2681
2682 The following group parameters can be used:
2683
2684 @table @code
2685 @item to-address
2686 @cindex to-address
2687 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2688
2689 @example
2690 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2691 @end example
2692
2693 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2694 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2695 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2696 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2697 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2698
2699 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2700 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2701 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2702 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2703 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2704 list address instead.
2705
2706 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2707
2708 @item to-list
2709 @cindex to-list
2710 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2711
2712 @example
2713 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2714 @end example
2715
2716 It is totally ignored
2717 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2718 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2719
2720 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2721 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2722 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2723 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2724 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2725
2726 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2727 @cindex mail list groups
2728 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2729 entering summary buffer.
2730
2731 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2732
2733 @anchor{subscribed}
2734 @item subscribed
2735 @cindex subscribed
2736 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2737 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2738 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2739 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2740 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2741 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2742 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2743 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2744
2745 @lisp
2746 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2747 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2748 @end lisp
2749
2750 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2751 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2752
2753 @item visible
2754 @cindex visible
2755 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2756 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2757 of whether it has any unread articles.
2758
2759 @item broken-reply-to
2760 @cindex broken-reply-to
2761 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2762 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2763 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2764 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2765 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2766 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2767
2768 @item to-group
2769 @cindex to-group
2770 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2771 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2772
2773 @item newsgroup
2774 @cindex newsgroup
2775 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2776 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2777 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2778 news group.
2779
2780 @item gcc-self
2781 @cindex gcc-self
2782 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2783 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2784 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2785 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2786 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2787 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2788 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2789
2790 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2791 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2792 doesn't accept articles.
2793
2794 @item auto-expire
2795 @cindex auto-expire
2796 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2797 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2798 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2799
2800 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2801
2802 @item total-expire
2803 @cindex total-expire
2804 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2805 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2806 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2807 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2808 expiry.
2809
2810 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2811
2812 @item expiry-wait
2813 @cindex expiry-wait
2814 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2815 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2816 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2817 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2818 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2819 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2820 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2821
2822 @item expiry-target
2823 @cindex expiry-target
2824 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2825 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2826
2827 @item score-file
2828 @cindex score file group parameter
2829 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2830 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2831 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2832
2833 @item adapt-file
2834 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2835 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2836 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2837 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2838
2839 @item admin-address
2840 @cindex admin-address
2841 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2842 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2843 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2844 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2845
2846 @item display
2847 @cindex display
2848 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2849 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2850
2851 @table @code
2852 @item all
2853 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2854
2855 @item an integer
2856 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2857 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2858
2859 @item default
2860 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2861 ticked articles.
2862
2863 @item an array
2864 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2865
2866 Here are some examples:
2867
2868 @table @code
2869 @item [unread]
2870 Display only unread articles.
2871
2872 @item [not expire]
2873 Display everything except expirable articles.
2874
2875 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2876 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2877 responded to.
2878 @end table
2879
2880 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2881 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2882 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2883 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2884 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2885
2886 @end table
2887
2888 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2889 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2890 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2891
2892 @item comment
2893 @cindex comment
2894 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2895 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2896 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2897
2898 @item charset
2899 @cindex charset
2900 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2901 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2902 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2903
2904 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2905
2906 @item ignored-charsets
2907 @cindex ignored-charset
2908 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2909 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2910 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2911
2912 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2913
2914 @item posting-style
2915 @cindex posting-style
2916 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2917 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2918 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2919 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2920 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2921
2922 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2923 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2924 like this in the group parameters:
2925
2926 @example
2927 (posting-style
2928 (name "Funky Name")
2929 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2930 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2931 @end example
2932
2933 @item post-method
2934 @cindex post-method
2935 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2936 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2937
2938 @item banner
2939 @cindex banner
2940 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2941 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2942 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2943 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2944 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2945
2946 @item sieve
2947 @cindex sieve
2948 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2949 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2950 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2951 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2952
2953 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2954 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2955 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2956 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2957
2958 @example
2959 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2960 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2961 @}
2962 @end example
2963
2964 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2965 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2966
2967 @item (agent parameters)
2968 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2969 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2970 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2971 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2972 minimize the configuration effort.
2973
2974 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2975 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2976 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2977 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2978 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2979 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2980 @code{eval}ed there.
2981
2982 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2983 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2984 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2985 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2986 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2987 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2988 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2989 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2990
2991 @lisp
2992 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2993 @end lisp
2994
2995 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2996 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2997 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
2998
2999 @example
3000 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3001 @end example
3002
3003 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3004 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3005 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3006 into the group parameters for the group.
3007
3008 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3009 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3010 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3011 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3012 @code{(ding)} form.
3013
3014 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3015 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3016 following is added to a group parameter
3017
3018 @lisp
3019 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3020 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3021 @end lisp
3022
3023 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3024 expired.
3025
3026 @end table
3027
3028 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3029 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3030 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3031 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3032 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3033
3034 @vindex gnus-parameters
3035 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3036 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3037 example:
3038
3039 @lisp
3040 (setq gnus-parameters
3041 '(("mail\\..*"
3042 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3043 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3044 (gnus-summary-line-format
3045 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3046 (gcc-self . t)
3047 (display . all))
3048
3049 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3050 (to-group . "\\1"))
3051
3052 ("mail\\.me"
3053 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3054
3055 ("list\\..*"
3056 (total-expire . t)
3057 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3058 @end lisp
3059
3060 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3061 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3062
3063 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3064 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3065 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3066 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3067 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3068 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3069 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3070 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3071 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3072 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3073 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3074 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3075
3076
3077 @node Listing Groups
3078 @section Listing Groups
3079 @cindex group listing
3080
3081 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3082
3083 @table @kbd
3084
3085 @item l
3086 @itemx A s
3087 @kindex A s (Group)
3088 @kindex l (Group)
3089 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3090 List all groups that have unread articles
3091 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3092 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3093 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3094 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3095 groups).
3096
3097 @item L
3098 @itemx A u
3099 @kindex A u (Group)
3100 @kindex L (Group)
3101 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3102 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3103 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3104 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3105 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3106 unsubscribed groups).
3107
3108 @item A l
3109 @kindex A l (Group)
3110 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3111 List all unread groups on a specific level
3112 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3113 with no unread articles.
3114
3115 @item A k
3116 @kindex A k (Group)
3117 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3118 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3119 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3120 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3121 from the server.
3122
3123 @item A z
3124 @kindex A z (Group)
3125 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3126 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3127
3128 @item A m
3129 @kindex A m (Group)
3130 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3131 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3132 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3133
3134 @item A M
3135 @kindex A M (Group)
3136 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3137 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3138
3139 @item A A
3140 @kindex A A (Group)
3141 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3142 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3143 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3144 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3145 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3146 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3147 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3148 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3149
3150 @item A a
3151 @kindex A a (Group)
3152 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3153 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3154 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3155
3156 @item A d
3157 @kindex A d (Group)
3158 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3159 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3160 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3161
3162 @item A c
3163 @kindex A c (Group)
3164 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3165 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3166
3167 @item A ?
3168 @kindex A ? (Group)
3169 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3170 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3171
3172 @item A /
3173 @kindex A / (Group)
3174 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3175 List groups limited within the current selection
3176 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3177
3178 @item A f
3179 @kindex A f (Group)
3180 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3181 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3182
3183 @item A p
3184 @kindex A p (Group)
3185 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3186 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3187
3188 @end table
3189
3190 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3191 @cindex visible group parameter
3192 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3193 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3194 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3195 get the same effect.
3196
3197 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3198 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3199 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3200 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3201 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3202
3203
3204 @node Sorting Groups
3205 @section Sorting Groups
3206 @cindex sorting groups
3207
3208 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3209 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3210 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3211 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3212 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3213 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3214 include:
3215
3216 @table @code
3217
3218 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3219 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3220 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3221
3222 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3224 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3225
3226 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3227 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3228 Sort by group level.
3229
3230 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3231 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3232 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3233
3234 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3235 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3236 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3237 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3238
3239 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3240 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3241 Sort by number of unread articles.
3242
3243 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3244 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3245 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3246
3247 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3248 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3249 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3250
3251
3252 @end table
3253
3254 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3255 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3256 the last one.
3257
3258
3259 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3260 some sorting criteria:
3261
3262 @table @kbd
3263 @item G S a
3264 @kindex G S a (Group)
3265 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3266 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3267 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3268
3269 @item G S u
3270 @kindex G S u (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3272 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3273 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3274
3275 @item G S l
3276 @kindex G S l (Group)
3277 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3278 Sort the group buffer by group level
3279 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3280
3281 @item G S v
3282 @kindex G S v (Group)
3283 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3284 Sort the group buffer by group score
3285 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3286
3287 @item G S r
3288 @kindex G S r (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3290 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3291 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3292
3293 @item G S m
3294 @kindex G S m (Group)
3295 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3296 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3297 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3298
3299 @item G S n
3300 @kindex G S n (Group)
3301 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3302 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3303 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3304
3305 @end table
3306
3307 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3308 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3309
3310 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3311 commands will sort in reverse order.
3312
3313 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3314
3315 @table @kbd
3316 @item G P a
3317 @kindex G P a (Group)
3318 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3319 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3320 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3321
3322 @item G P u
3323 @kindex G P u (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3325 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3326 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3327
3328 @item G P l
3329 @kindex G P l (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3331 Sort the groups by group level
3332 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3333
3334 @item G P v
3335 @kindex G P v (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3337 Sort the groups by group score
3338 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3339
3340 @item G P r
3341 @kindex G P r (Group)
3342 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3343 Sort the groups by group rank
3344 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3345
3346 @item G P m
3347 @kindex G P m (Group)
3348 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3349 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3350 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3351
3352 @item G P n
3353 @kindex G P n (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3355 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3356 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3357
3358 @item G P s
3359 @kindex G P s (Group)
3360 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3361 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3362
3363 @end table
3364
3365 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3366 move groups around.
3367
3368
3369 @node Group Maintenance
3370 @section Group Maintenance
3371 @cindex bogus groups
3372
3373 @table @kbd
3374 @item b
3375 @kindex b (Group)
3376 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3377 Find bogus groups and delete them
3378 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3379
3380 @item F
3381 @kindex F (Group)
3382 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3383 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3384 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3385 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3386 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3387 zombies.
3388
3389 @item C-c C-x
3390 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3391 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3392 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3393 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3394 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3395 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3396
3397 @item C-c C-M-x
3398 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3399 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3400 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3401 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3402
3403 @end table
3404
3405
3406 @node Browse Foreign Server
3407 @section Browse Foreign Server
3408 @cindex foreign servers
3409 @cindex browsing servers
3410
3411 @table @kbd
3412 @item B
3413 @kindex B (Group)
3414 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3415 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3416 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3417 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3418 @end table
3419
3420 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3421 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3422 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3423 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3424
3425 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3426
3427 @table @kbd
3428 @item n
3429 @kindex n (Browse)
3430 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3431 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3432
3433 @item p
3434 @kindex p (Browse)
3435 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3436 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3437
3438 @item SPACE
3439 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3440 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3441 Enter the current group and display the first article
3442 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3443
3444 @item RET
3445 @kindex RET (Browse)
3446 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3447 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3448
3449 @item u
3450 @kindex u (Browse)
3451 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3452 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3453 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3454
3455 @item l
3456 @itemx q
3457 @kindex q (Browse)
3458 @kindex l (Browse)
3459 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3460 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3461
3462 @item d
3463 @kindex d (Browse)
3464 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3465 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3466
3467 @item ?
3468 @kindex ? (Browse)
3469 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3470 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3471 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3472 @end table
3473
3474
3475 @node Exiting Gnus
3476 @section Exiting Gnus
3477 @cindex exiting Gnus
3478
3479 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3480
3481 @table @kbd
3482 @item z
3483 @kindex z (Group)
3484 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3485 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3486 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3487 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3488
3489 @item q
3490 @kindex q (Group)
3491 @findex gnus-group-exit
3492 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3493 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3494
3495 @item Q
3496 @kindex Q (Group)
3497 @findex gnus-group-quit
3498 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3499 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3500 @end table
3501
3502 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3503 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3504 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3505 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3506 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3507 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3508 exiting Gnus.
3509
3510 Note:
3511
3512 @quotation
3513 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3514 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3515 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3516 plastic chair.
3517 @end quotation
3518
3519
3520 @node Group Topics
3521 @section Group Topics
3522 @cindex topics
3523
3524 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3525 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3526 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3527 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3528 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3529 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3530
3531 @iftex
3532 @iflatex
3533 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3534 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3535 }
3536 @end iflatex
3537 @end iftex
3538
3539 Here's an example:
3540
3541 @example
3542 Gnus
3543 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3544 3: comp.emacs
3545 2: alt.religion.emacs
3546 Naughty Emacs
3547 452: alt.sex.emacs
3548 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3549 Misc
3550 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3551 13: comp.sources.unix
3552 @end example
3553
3554 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3555 @kindex t (Group)
3556 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3557 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3558 is a toggling command.)
3559
3560 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3561 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3562 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3563 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3564 Hot and bothered?
3565
3566 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3567 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3568 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3569
3570 @lisp
3571 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3572 @end lisp
3573
3574 @menu
3575 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3576 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3577 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3578 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3579 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3580 @end menu
3581
3582
3583 @node Topic Commands
3584 @subsection Topic Commands
3585 @cindex topic commands
3586
3587 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3588 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3589 definitions slightly.
3590
3591 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3592 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3593 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3594 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3595 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3596 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3597
3598 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3599 the way you like.
3600
3601 @table @kbd
3602
3603 @item T n
3604 @kindex T n (Topic)
3605 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3606 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3607 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3608
3609 @item T TAB
3610 @itemx TAB
3611 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3612 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3613 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3614 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3615 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3616 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3617
3618 @item M-TAB
3619 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3620 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3621 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3622 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3623
3624 @end table
3625
3626 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3627 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3628 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3629 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3630
3631 @table @kbd
3632
3633 @item C-k
3634 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3635 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3636 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3637 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3638
3639 @item C-y
3640 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3641 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3642 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3643 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3644 before all groups.
3645
3646 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3647 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3648 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3649 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3650 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3651
3652 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3653 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3654
3655 @end table
3656
3657 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3658 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3659 key.
3660
3661 @table @kbd
3662
3663 @item RET
3664 @kindex RET (Topic)
3665 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3666 @itemx SPACE
3667 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3668 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3669 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3670 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3671 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3672 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3673
3674 @end table
3675
3676 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3677
3678 @table @kbd
3679
3680 @item T m
3681 @kindex T m (Topic)
3682 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3683 Move the current group to some other topic
3684 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3685 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3686
3687 @item T j
3688 @kindex T j (Topic)
3689 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3690 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3691
3692 @item T c
3693 @kindex T c (Topic)
3694 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3695 Copy the current group to some other topic
3696 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3697 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3698
3699 @item T h
3700 @kindex T h (Topic)
3701 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3702 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3703 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3704
3705 @item T s
3706 @kindex T s (Topic)
3707 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3708 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3709 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3710
3711 @item T D
3712 @kindex T D (Topic)
3713 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3714 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3715 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3716 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3717 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3718 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3719 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3720 topic.
3721
3722 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3723 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3724
3725 @item T M
3726 @kindex T M (Topic)
3727 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3728 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3729 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3730
3731 @item T C
3732 @kindex T C (Topic)
3733 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3734 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3735 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3736
3737 @item T H
3738 @kindex T H (Topic)
3739 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3740 Toggle hiding empty topics
3741 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3742
3743 @item T #
3744 @kindex T # (Topic)
3745 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3746 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3747 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3748 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3749
3750 @item T M-#
3751 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3752 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3753 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3754 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3755 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3756
3757 @item C-c C-x
3758 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3759 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3760 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3761 expiry process (if any)
3762 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3763
3764 @item T r
3765 @kindex T r (Topic)
3766 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3767 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3768
3769 @item T DEL
3770 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3771 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3772 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3773
3774 @item A T
3775 @kindex A T (Topic)
3776 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3777 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3778 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3779
3780 @item T M-n
3781 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3782 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3783 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3784
3785 @item T M-p
3786 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3787 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3788 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3789
3790 @item G p
3791 @kindex G p (Topic)
3792 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3793 @cindex group parameters
3794 @cindex topic parameters
3795 @cindex parameters
3796 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3797 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3798
3799 @end table
3800
3801
3802 @node Topic Variables
3803 @subsection Topic Variables
3804 @cindex topic variables
3805
3806 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3807 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3808
3809 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3810 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3811 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3812 Valid elements are:
3813
3814 @table @samp
3815 @item i
3816 Indentation.
3817 @item n
3818 Topic name.
3819 @item v
3820 Visibility.
3821 @item l
3822 Level.
3823 @item g
3824 Number of groups in the topic.
3825 @item a
3826 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3827 @item A
3828 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3829 @end table
3830
3831 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3832 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3833 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3834 The default is 2.
3835
3836 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3837 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3838
3839 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3840 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3841 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3842
3843
3844 @node Topic Sorting
3845 @subsection Topic Sorting
3846 @cindex topic sorting
3847
3848 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3849 commands:
3850
3851
3852 @table @kbd
3853 @item T S a
3854 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3855 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3856 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3857 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3858
3859 @item T S u
3860 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3861 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3862 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3863 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3864
3865 @item T S l
3866 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3867 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3868 Sort the current topic by group level
3869 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3870
3871 @item T S v
3872 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3873 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3874 Sort the current topic by group score
3875 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3876
3877 @item T S r
3878 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3879 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3880 Sort the current topic by group rank
3881 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3882
3883 @item T S m
3884 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3885 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3886 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3887 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3888
3889 @item T S e
3890 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3891 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3892 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3893 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3894
3895 @item T S s
3896 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3897 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3898 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3899 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3900 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3901
3902 @end table
3903
3904 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3905 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3906 sorting.
3907
3908
3909 @node Topic Topology
3910 @subsection Topic Topology
3911 @cindex topic topology
3912 @cindex topology
3913
3914 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3915
3916 @example
3917 @group
3918 Gnus
3919 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3920 3: comp.emacs
3921 2: alt.religion.emacs
3922 Naughty Emacs
3923 452: alt.sex.emacs
3924 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3925 Misc
3926 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3927 13: comp.sources.unix
3928 @end group
3929 @end example
3930
3931 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3932 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3933 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3934 follows:
3935
3936 @lisp
3937 (("Gnus" visible)
3938 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3939 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3940 (("Misc" visible)))
3941 @end lisp
3942
3943 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3944 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3945 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3946 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3947 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3948 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3949
3950 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3951 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3952 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3953
3954
3955 @node Topic Parameters
3956 @subsection Topic Parameters
3957 @cindex topic parameters
3958
3959 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3960 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3961 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3962 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3963 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3964
3965 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3966 parameters:
3967
3968 @table @code
3969 @item subscribe
3970 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3971 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3972 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3973 topic.
3974
3975 @item subscribe-level
3976 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3977 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3978 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3983 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3984 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3985 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3986
3987 @example
3988 @group
3989 Gnus
3990 Emacs
3991 3: comp.emacs
3992 2: alt.religion.emacs
3993 452: alt.sex.emacs
3994 Relief
3995 452: alt.sex.emacs
3996 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3997 Misc
3998 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3999 13: comp.sources.unix
4000 452: alt.sex.emacs
4001 @end group
4002 @end example
4003
4004 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4005 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4006 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4007 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4008 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4009 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4010
4011 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4012 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4013 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4014 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4015 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4016
4017 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4018 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4019 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4020 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4021 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4022 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4023 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4024 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4025
4026
4027 @node Misc Group Stuff
4028 @section Misc Group Stuff
4029
4030 @menu
4031 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4032 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4033 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4034 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4035 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4036 @end menu
4037
4038 @table @kbd
4039
4040 @item ^
4041 @kindex ^ (Group)
4042 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4043 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4044 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4045
4046 @item a
4047 @kindex a (Group)
4048 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4049 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4050 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4051 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4052 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4053 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4054 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4055
4056 @item m
4057 @kindex m (Group)
4058 @findex gnus-group-mail
4059 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4060 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4061 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4062 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4063
4064 @item i
4065 @kindex i (Group)
4066 @findex gnus-group-news
4067 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4068 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4069 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4070
4071 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4072 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4073 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4074 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4075 for this to work though.
4076
4077 @end table
4078
4079 Variables for the group buffer:
4080
4081 @table @code
4082
4083 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4084 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4085 is called after the group buffer has been
4086 created.
4087
4088 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4089 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4090 is called after the group buffer is
4091 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4092 unnatural way.
4093
4094 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4095 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4096 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4097 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4098
4099 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4100 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4101 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4102 whether they are empty or not.
4103
4104 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4105 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4106 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4107 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4108
4109 For example:
4110 @lisp
4111 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4112 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4113 @end lisp
4114
4115 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4116 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4117 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4118 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4119 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4120 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4121 default is @code{nil}.
4122
4123 For example:
4124 @lisp
4125 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4126 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4127 @end lisp
4128
4129 @end table
4130
4131 @node Scanning New Messages
4132 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4133 @cindex new messages
4134 @cindex scanning new news
4135
4136 @table @kbd
4137
4138 @item g
4139 @kindex g (Group)
4140 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4141 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4142 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4143 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4144 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4145 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4146 back end(s).
4147
4148 @item M-g
4149 @kindex M-g (Group)
4150 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4151 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4152 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4153 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4154 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4155 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4156 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4157
4158 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4159 @cindex activating groups
4160 @item C-c M-g
4161 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4162 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4163
4164 @item R
4165 @kindex R (Group)
4166 @cindex restarting
4167 @findex gnus-group-restart
4168 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4169 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4170 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4171
4172 @end table
4173
4174 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4175 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4176
4177 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4178 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4179 news.
4180
4181
4182 @node Group Information
4183 @subsection Group Information
4184 @cindex group information
4185 @cindex information on groups
4186
4187 @table @kbd
4188
4189
4190 @item H f
4191 @kindex H f (Group)
4192 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4193 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4194 @cindex FAQ
4195 @cindex ange-ftp
4196 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4197 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4198 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4199 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4200 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4201 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4202 used for fetching the file.
4203
4204 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4205 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4206
4207 @item H c
4208 @kindex H c (Group)
4209 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4210 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4211 @cindex charter
4212 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4213 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4214 prefix argument.
4215
4216 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4217 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4218 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4219
4220 @item H C
4221 @kindex H C (Group)
4222 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4223 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4224 @cindex control message
4225 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4226 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4227 group if given a prefix argument.
4228
4229 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4230 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4231 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4232 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4233
4234 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4235 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4236 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4237
4238 @item H d
4239 @itemx C-c C-d
4240 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4241 @kindex H d (Group)
4242 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4243 @cindex describing groups
4244 @cindex group description
4245 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4246 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4247 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4248
4249 @item M-d
4250 @kindex M-d (Group)
4251 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4252 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4253 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4254
4255 @item H v
4256 @itemx V
4257 @kindex V (Group)
4258 @kindex H v (Group)
4259 @cindex version
4260 @findex gnus-version
4261 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4262
4263 @item ?
4264 @kindex ? (Group)
4265 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4266 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4267
4268 @item C-c C-i
4269 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4270 @cindex info
4271 @cindex manual
4272 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4273 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4274 @end table
4275
4276
4277 @node Group Timestamp
4278 @subsection Group Timestamp
4279 @cindex timestamps
4280 @cindex group timestamps
4281
4282 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4283 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4284 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4285
4286 @lisp
4287 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4288 @end lisp
4289
4290 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4291
4292 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4293 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4294
4295 @lisp
4296 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4297 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4298 @end lisp
4299
4300 This will result in lines looking like:
4301
4302 @example
4303 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4304 0: custom 19961002T012713
4305 @end example
4306
4307 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4308 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4309 something like:
4310
4311 @lisp
4312 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4313 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4314 @end lisp
4315
4316 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4317 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4318 trick:
4319
4320 @lisp
4321 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4322 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4323 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4324 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4325 (if time
4326 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4327 "")))
4328 @end lisp
4329
4330
4331 @node File Commands
4332 @subsection File Commands
4333 @cindex file commands
4334
4335 @table @kbd
4336
4337 @item r
4338 @kindex r (Group)
4339 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4340 @vindex gnus-init-file
4341 @cindex reading init file
4342 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4343 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4344
4345 @item s
4346 @kindex s (Group)
4347 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4348 @cindex saving .newsrc
4349 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4350 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4351 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4352
4353 @c @item Z
4354 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4355 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4356 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4357
4358 @end table
4359
4360
4361 @node Sieve Commands
4362 @subsection Sieve Commands
4363 @cindex group sieve commands
4364
4365 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4366 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4367 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4368 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4369 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4370
4371 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4372 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4373 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4374 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4375 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4376 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4377 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4378 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4379 regenerate the Sieve script.
4380
4381 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4382 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4383 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4384 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4385 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4386 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4387 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4388 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4389 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4390 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4391
4392 @example
4393 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4394 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4395 stop;
4396 @}
4397 @end example
4398
4399 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4400
4401 @table @kbd
4402
4403 @item D g
4404 @kindex D g (Group)
4405 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4406 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4407 @cindex generating sieve script
4408 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4409 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4410
4411 @item D u
4412 @kindex D u (Group)
4413 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4414 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4415 @cindex updating sieve script
4416 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4417 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4418 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4419
4420 @end table
4421
4422
4423 @node Summary Buffer
4424 @chapter Summary Buffer
4425 @cindex summary buffer
4426
4427 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4428 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4429
4430 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4431 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4432
4433 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4434
4435 @menu
4436 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4437 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4438 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4439 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4440 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4441 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4442 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4443 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4444 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4445 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4446 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4447 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4448 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4449 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4450 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4451 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4452 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4453 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4454 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4455 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4456 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4457 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4458 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4459 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4460 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4461 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4462 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4463 or reselecting the current group.
4464 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4465 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4466 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4467 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4468 @end menu
4469
4470
4471 @node Summary Buffer Format
4472 @section Summary Buffer Format
4473 @cindex summary buffer format
4474
4475 @iftex
4476 @iflatex
4477 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4478 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4479 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4480 }
4481 @end iflatex
4482 @end iftex
4483
4484 @menu
4485 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4486 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4487 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4488 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4489 @end menu
4490
4491 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4492 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4493 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4494 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4495 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4496 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4497 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4498 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4499 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4500 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4501 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4502
4503 @lisp
4504 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4505 'mail-extract-address-components)
4506 @end lisp
4507
4508 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4509 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4510 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4511 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4512
4513
4514 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4515 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4516
4517 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4518 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4519 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4520 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4521 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4522
4523 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4524 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4525 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4526 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4527 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4528 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4529
4530 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4531
4532 The following format specification characters and extended format
4533 specification(s) are understood:
4534
4535 @table @samp
4536 @item N
4537 Article number.
4538 @item S
4539 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4540 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4541 @item s
4542 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4543 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4544 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4545 @item F
4546 Full @code{From} header.
4547 @item n
4548 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4549 @item f
4550 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4551 From Newsgroups}).
4552 @item a
4553 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4554 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4555 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4556 may be more thorough.
4557 @item A
4558 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4559 the @code{a} spec.
4560 @item L
4561 Number of lines in the article.
4562 @item c
4563 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4564 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4565 @item k
4566 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4567 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4568 @item I
4569 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4570 @item B
4571 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4572 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4573
4574 @example
4575 >
4576 +->
4577 | +->
4578 | | \->
4579 | | \->
4580 | \->
4581 +->
4582 \->
4583 @end example
4584
4585 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4586 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4587 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4588 line-drawing glyphs.
4589 @table @code
4590 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4591 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4592 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4593 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4594
4595 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4596 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4597 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4598 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4599
4600 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4601 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4602 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4603 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4604
4605 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4606 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4607 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4608
4609 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4610 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4611 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4612
4613 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4614 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4615 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4616
4617 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4618 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4619 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4620
4621 @end table
4622
4623 @item T
4624 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4625 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4626 @item [
4627 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4628 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4629 @item ]
4630 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4631 for adopted articles.
4632 @item >
4633 One space for each thread level.
4634 @item <
4635 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4636 @item U
4637 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4638
4639 @item R
4640 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4641 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4642 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4643
4644 @item i
4645 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4646 @item z
4647 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4648 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4649 default level. If the difference between
4650 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4651 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4652 @item V
4653 Total thread score.
4654 @item x
4655 @code{Xref}.
4656 @item D
4657 @code{Date}.
4658 @item d
4659 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4660 @item o
4661 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4662 @item M
4663 @code{Message-ID}.
4664 @item r
4665 @code{References}.
4666 @item t
4667 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4668 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4669 @item e
4670 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4671 article has any children.
4672 @item P
4673 The line number.
4674 @item O
4675 Download mark.
4676 @item &user-date;
4677 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4678 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4679 @item u
4680 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4681 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4682 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4683 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4684 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4685 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4686 @end table
4687
4688 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4689 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4690 There can only be one such area.
4691
4692 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4693 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4694 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4695 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4696 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4697 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4698
4699 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4700 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4701
4702 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4703
4704
4705 @node To From Newsgroups
4706 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4707 @cindex To
4708 @cindex Newsgroups
4709
4710 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4711 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4712 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4713 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4714 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4715
4716 @enumerate
4717 @item
4718 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4719 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4720 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4721 instance:
4722
4723 @lisp
4724 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4725 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4726 @end lisp
4727
4728 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4729 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4730
4731 @item
4732 @findex gnus-extra-header
4733 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4734 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4735 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4736
4737 @example
4738 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4739 @end example
4740
4741 @item
4742 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4743 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4744 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4745 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4746 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4747 headers are used instead.
4748
4749 @end enumerate
4750
4751 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4752 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4753 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4754 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4755 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4756 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4757 regeneration.
4758
4759 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4760 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4761 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4762 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4763
4764 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4765 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4766
4767 @lisp
4768 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4769 '(To Newsgroups))
4770 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4771 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4772 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4773 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4774 "Your Name Here")
4775 @end lisp
4776
4777 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4778 to fit your needs.)
4779
4780 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4781 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4782 support:
4783
4784 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4785 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4786 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4787
4788 @example
4789 Newsgroups:full
4790 @end example
4791
4792 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4793 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4794
4795
4796 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4797 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4798
4799 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4800 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4801 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4802 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4803
4804 Here are the elements you can play with:
4805
4806 @table @samp
4807 @item G
4808 Group name.
4809 @item p
4810 Unprefixed group name.
4811 @item A
4812 Current article number.
4813 @item z
4814 Current article score.
4815 @item V
4816 Gnus version.
4817 @item U
4818 Number of unread articles in this group.
4819 @item e
4820 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4821 summary buffer.
4822 @item Z
4823 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4824 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4825 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4826 and no unselected ones.
4827 @item g
4828 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4829 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4830 @item S
4831 Subject of the current article.
4832 @item u
4833 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4834 @item s
4835 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4836 @item d
4837 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4838 @item t
4839 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4840 @item r
4841 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4842 @item E
4843 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4844 @end table
4845
4846
4847 @node Summary Highlighting
4848 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4849
4850 @table @code
4851
4852 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4853 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4854 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4855 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4856 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4857
4858 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4859 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4860 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4861 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4862
4863 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4864 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4865 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4866 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4867
4868 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4869 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4870 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4871 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4872 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4873 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4874 to something like
4875 @lisp
4876 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4877 ((> score default) . bold))
4878 @end lisp
4879 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4880 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4881 @end table
4882
4883
4884 @node Summary Maneuvering
4885 @section Summary Maneuvering
4886 @cindex summary movement
4887
4888 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4889 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4890
4891 None of these commands select articles.
4892
4893 @table @kbd
4894 @item G M-n
4895 @itemx M-n
4896 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4897 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4898 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4899 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4900 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4901
4902 @item G M-p
4903 @itemx M-p
4904 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4905 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4906 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4907 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4908 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4909
4910 @item G g
4911 @kindex G g (Summary)
4912 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4913 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4914 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4915 @end table
4916
4917 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4918 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4919 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4920 to the group buffer.
4921
4922 Variables related to summary movement:
4923
4924 @table @code
4925
4926 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4927 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4928 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4929 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4930 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4931 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4932 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4933 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4934 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4935 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4936 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4937 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4938 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4939 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4940
4941 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4942 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4943 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4944 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4945 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4946 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4947 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4948
4949 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4950
4951 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4952 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4953 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4954 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4955 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4956
4957 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4958 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4959 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4960 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4961 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4962 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4963 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4964 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4965 threads.
4966
4967 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4968 the given number of lines from the top.
4969
4970 @end table
4971
4972
4973 @node Choosing Articles
4974 @section Choosing Articles
4975 @cindex selecting articles
4976
4977 @menu
4978 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4979 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4980 @end menu
4981
4982
4983 @node Choosing Commands
4984 @subsection Choosing Commands
4985
4986 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4987 and they all select and display an article.
4988
4989 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4990 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4991
4992 @table @kbd
4993 @item SPACE
4994 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4995 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4996 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4997 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4998
4999 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5000 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5001 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5002
5003 @item G n
5004 @itemx n
5005 @kindex n (Summary)
5006 @kindex G n (Summary)
5007 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5008 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5009 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5010
5011 @item G p
5012 @itemx p
5013 @kindex p (Summary)
5014 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5015 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5016 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5017
5018 @item G N
5019 @itemx N
5020 @kindex N (Summary)
5021 @kindex G N (Summary)
5022 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5023 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5024
5025 @item G P
5026 @itemx P
5027 @kindex P (Summary)
5028 @kindex G P (Summary)
5029 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5030 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5031
5032 @item G C-n
5033 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5034 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5035 Go to the next article with the same subject
5036 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5037
5038 @item G C-p
5039 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5040 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5041 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5042 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5043
5044 @item G f
5045 @itemx .
5046 @kindex G f (Summary)
5047 @kindex . (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5049 Go to the first unread article
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5051
5052 @item G b
5053 @itemx ,
5054 @kindex G b (Summary)
5055 @kindex , (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5057 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5058 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5059 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5060
5061 @item G l
5062 @itemx l
5063 @kindex l (Summary)
5064 @kindex G l (Summary)
5065 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5066 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5067
5068 @item G o
5069 @kindex G o (Summary)
5070 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5071 @cindex history
5072 @cindex article history
5073 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5074 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5075 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5076 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5077 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5078 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5079
5080 @item G j
5081 @itemx j
5082 @kindex j (Summary)
5083 @kindex G j (Summary)
5084 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5085 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5086 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5087
5088 @end table
5089
5090
5091 @node Choosing Variables
5092 @subsection Choosing Variables
5093
5094 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5095
5096 @table @code
5097 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5098 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5099 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5100 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5101 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5102 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5103
5104 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5105 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5106 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5107 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5108 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5109 hook will do so.
5110
5111 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5112 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5113 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5114 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5115 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5116 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5117 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5118 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5119 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5120 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5121 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5122 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5123 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5124 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5125
5126 @end table
5127
5128
5129 @node Paging the Article
5130 @section Scrolling the Article
5131 @cindex article scrolling
5132
5133 @table @kbd
5134
5135 @item SPACE
5136 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5137 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5138 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5139 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5140 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5141
5142 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5143 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5144 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5145 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5146 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5147 what is considered uninteresting with
5148 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5149 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5150
5151 @item DEL
5152 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5153 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5154 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5155
5156 @item RET
5157 @kindex RET (Summary)
5158 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5159 Scroll the current article one line forward
5160 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5161
5162 @item M-RET
5163 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5164 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5165 Scroll the current article one line backward
5166 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5167
5168 @item A g
5169 @itemx g
5170 @kindex A g (Summary)
5171 @kindex g (Summary)
5172 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5173 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5174 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5175 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5176 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5177 the way it came from the server.
5178
5179 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5180 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5181 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5182
5183 @lisp
5184 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5185 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5186 (2 . big5)))
5187 @end lisp
5188
5189 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5190
5191 @item A <
5192 @itemx <
5193 @kindex < (Summary)
5194 @kindex A < (Summary)
5195 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5196 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5197 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5198
5199 @item A >
5200 @itemx >
5201 @kindex > (Summary)
5202 @kindex A > (Summary)
5203 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5204 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5205
5206 @item A s
5207 @itemx s
5208 @kindex A s (Summary)
5209 @kindex s (Summary)
5210 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5211 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5212 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5213
5214 @item h
5215 @kindex h (Summary)
5216 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5217 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5218
5219 @end table
5220
5221
5222 @node Reply Followup and Post
5223 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5224
5225 @menu
5226 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5227 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5228 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5229 * Canceling and Superseding::
5230 @end menu
5231
5232
5233 @node Summary Mail Commands
5234 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5235 @cindex mail
5236 @cindex composing mail
5237
5238 Commands for composing a mail message:
5239
5240 @table @kbd
5241
5242 @item S r
5243 @itemx r
5244 @kindex S r (Summary)
5245 @kindex r (Summary)
5246 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5247 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5248 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5249 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5250 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5251
5252 @item S R
5253 @itemx R
5254 @kindex R (Summary)
5255 @kindex S R (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5257 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5258 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5259 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5260 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5261
5262 @item S w
5263 @kindex S w (Summary)
5264 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5265 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5266 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5267 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5268 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5269 present, that's used instead.
5270
5271 @item S W
5272 @kindex S W (Summary)
5273 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5274 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5275 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5276 the process/prefix convention.
5277
5278 @item S v
5279 @kindex S v (Summary)
5280 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5281 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5282 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5283 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5284 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5285 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5286
5287 @item S V
5288 @kindex S V (Summary)
5289 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5290 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5291 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5292 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5293
5294 @item S B r
5295 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5296 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5297 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5298 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5299 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5300 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5301 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5302 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5303
5304 @item S B R
5305 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5306 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5307 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5308 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5309 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5310
5311 @item S o m
5312 @itemx C-c C-f
5313 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5314 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5315 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5316 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5317 Forward the current article to some other person
5318 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5319 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5320 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5321 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5322 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5323 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5324 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5325 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5326 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5327 section.
5328
5329 @item S m
5330 @itemx m
5331 @kindex m (Summary)
5332 @kindex S m (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5334 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5335 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5336 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5337 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5338
5339 @item S i
5340 @itemx i
5341 @kindex i (Summary)
5342 @kindex S i (Summary)
5343 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5344 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5345 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5346 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5347
5348 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5349 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5350 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5351 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5352 for this to work though.
5353
5354 @item S D b
5355 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5357 @cindex bouncing mail
5358 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5359 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5360 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5361 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5362 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5363 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5364 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5365 very well fail, though.
5366
5367 @item S D r
5368 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5369 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5370 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5371 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5372 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5373 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5374 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5375 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5376 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5377 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5378
5379 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5380 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5381 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5382 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5383 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5384
5385 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5386 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5387
5388 @item S D e
5389 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5390 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5391
5392 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5393 if it were a new message before resending.
5394
5395 @item S O m
5396 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5397 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5398 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5399 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5400 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5401
5402 @item S M-c
5403 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5404 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5405 @cindex crossposting
5406 @cindex excessive crossposting
5407 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5408 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5409
5410 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5411 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5412 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5413 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5414 command understands the process/prefix convention
5415 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5416
5417 @end table
5418
5419 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5420 Manual}, for more information.
5421
5422
5423 @node Summary Post Commands
5424 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5425 @cindex post
5426 @cindex composing news
5427
5428 Commands for posting a news article:
5429
5430 @table @kbd
5431 @item S p
5432 @itemx a
5433 @kindex a (Summary)
5434 @kindex S p (Summary)
5435 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5436 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5437 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5438 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5439 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5440
5441 @item S f
5442 @itemx f
5443 @kindex f (Summary)
5444 @kindex S f (Summary)
5445 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5446 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5447 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5448
5449 @item S F
5450 @itemx F
5451 @kindex S F (Summary)
5452 @kindex F (Summary)
5453 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5454 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5455 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5456 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5457 process/prefix convention.
5458
5459 @item S n
5460 @kindex S n (Summary)
5461 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5462 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5463 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5464
5465 @item S N
5466 @kindex S N (Summary)
5467 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5468 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5469 message through mail and include the original message
5470 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5471 the process/prefix convention.
5472
5473 @item S o p
5474 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5475 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5476 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5477 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5478 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5479 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5480 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5481 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5482 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5483 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5484 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5485 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5486 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5487
5488 @item S O p
5489 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5490 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5491 @cindex digests
5492 @cindex making digests
5493 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5494 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5495 process/prefix convention.
5496
5497 @item S u
5498 @kindex S u (Summary)
5499 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5500 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5501 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5502 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5503 @end table
5504
5505 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5506 Manual}, for more information.
5507
5508
5509 @node Summary Message Commands
5510 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5511
5512 @table @kbd
5513 @item S y
5514 @kindex S y (Summary)
5515 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5516 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5517 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5518 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5519 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5520
5521 @end table
5522
5523
5524 @node Canceling and Superseding
5525 @subsection Canceling Articles
5526 @cindex canceling articles
5527 @cindex superseding articles
5528
5529 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5530 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5531
5532 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5533
5534 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5535 @kindex C (Summary)
5536 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5537 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5538 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5539 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5540 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5541 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5542
5543 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5544 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5545 question.
5546
5547 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5548 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5549 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5550
5551 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5552 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5553 message, Message Manual}).
5554
5555 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5556 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5557 your original article.
5558
5559 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5560 @kindex S (Summary)
5561 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5562 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5563 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5564 usual way.
5565
5566 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5567 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5568 have posted almost the same article twice.
5569
5570 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5571 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5572 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5573 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5574 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5575 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5576 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5577 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5578 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5579 canceled/superseded.
5580
5581 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5582
5583 @node Delayed Articles
5584 @section Delayed Articles
5585 @cindex delayed sending
5586 @cindex send delayed
5587
5588 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5589 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5590 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5591 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5592
5593 @lisp
5594 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5595 @end lisp
5596
5597 @findex gnus-delay-article
5598 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5599 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5600 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5601 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5602
5603 @itemize @bullet
5604 @item
5605 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5606 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5607 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5608 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5609
5610 @item
5611 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5612 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5613 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5614
5615 @item
5616 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5617 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5618 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5619 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5620 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5621 that means a time tomorrow.
5622 @end itemize
5623
5624 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5625 couple of variables:
5626
5627 @table @code
5628 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5629 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5630 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5631 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5632
5633 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5634 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5635 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5636 formats described above.
5637
5638 @item gnus-delay-group
5639 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5640 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5641 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5642 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5643
5644 @item gnus-delay-header
5645 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5646 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5647 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5648 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5649 @end table
5650
5651 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5652 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5653 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5654 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5655 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5656
5657 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5658 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5659 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5660 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5661 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5662 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5663 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5664
5665 @table @code
5666 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5667 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5668 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5669 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5670 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5671 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5672 argument is ignored.
5673
5674 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5675 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5676 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5677 @end table
5678
5679
5680 @node Marking Articles
5681 @section Marking Articles
5682 @cindex article marking
5683 @cindex article ticking
5684 @cindex marks
5685
5686 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5687
5688 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5689 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5690 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5691
5692 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5693
5694 @ifinfo
5695 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5696 @end ifinfo
5697
5698 @menu
5699 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5700 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5701 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5702 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5703 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5704 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5705 @end menu
5706
5707
5708 @node Unread Articles
5709 @subsection Unread Articles
5710
5711 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5712 other.
5713
5714 @table @samp
5715 @item !
5716 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5717 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5718
5719 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5720 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5721 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5722 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5723 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5724 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5725 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5726
5727 @item ?
5728 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5729 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5730
5731 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5732 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5733 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5734 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5735 messages.
5736
5737 @item SPACE
5738 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5739 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5740
5741 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5742 @end table
5743
5744
5745 @node Read Articles
5746 @subsection Read Articles
5747 @cindex expirable mark
5748
5749 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5750
5751 @table @samp
5752
5753 @item r
5754 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5755 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5756 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5757
5758 @item R
5759 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5760 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5761
5762 @item O
5763 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5764 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5765 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5766
5767 @item K
5768 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5769 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5770
5771 @item X
5772 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5773 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5774
5775 @item Y
5776 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5777 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5778
5779 @item C
5780 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5781 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5782
5783 @item G
5784 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5785 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5786
5787 @item F
5788 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5789 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5790
5791 @item Q
5792 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5793 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5794 Threading}.
5795
5796 @item M
5797 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5798 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5799 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5800
5801 @end table
5802
5803 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5804 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5805
5806 One more special mark, though:
5807
5808 @table @samp
5809 @item E
5810 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5811 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5812
5813 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5814 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5815 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5816 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5817 any time.
5818 @end table
5819
5820
5821 @node Other Marks
5822 @subsection Other Marks
5823 @cindex process mark
5824 @cindex bookmarks
5825
5826 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5827 read or not.
5828
5829 @itemize @bullet
5830
5831 @item
5832 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5833 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5834 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5835 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5836 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5837
5838 @item
5839 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5840 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5841 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5842 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5843
5844 @item
5845 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5846 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5847 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5848
5849 @item
5850 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5851 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5852 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5853
5854 @item
5855 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5856 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5857 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5858 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5859
5860 @item
5861 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5862 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5863 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5864 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5865 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5866 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5867
5868 @item
5869 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5870 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5871 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5872 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5873
5874 @item
5875 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5876 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5877 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5878 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5879 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5880 use.)
5881
5882 @item
5883 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5884 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5885 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5886 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5887 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5888 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5889
5890 @item
5891 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5892 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5893 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5894 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5895 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5896 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5897 use.)
5898
5899 @item
5900 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5901 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5902 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5903 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5904 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5905
5906 @item
5907 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5908 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5909 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5910 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5911 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5912 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5913
5914 @end itemize
5915
5916 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5917 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5918 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5919
5920 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5921 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5922 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5923
5924
5925 @node Setting Marks
5926 @subsection Setting Marks
5927 @cindex setting marks
5928
5929 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5930
5931 @table @kbd
5932 @item M c
5933 @itemx M-u
5934 @kindex M c (Summary)
5935 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5936 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5937 @cindex mark as unread
5938 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5939 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5940 article as unread.
5941
5942 @item M t
5943 @itemx !
5944 @kindex ! (Summary)
5945 @kindex M t (Summary)
5946 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5947 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5948 @xref{Article Caching}.
5949
5950 @item M ?
5951 @itemx ?
5952 @kindex ? (Summary)
5953 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5954 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5955 Mark the current article as dormant
5956 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5957
5958 @item M d
5959 @itemx d
5960 @kindex M d (Summary)
5961 @kindex d (Summary)
5962 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5963 Mark the current article as read
5964 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5965
5966 @item D
5967 @kindex D (Summary)
5968 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5969 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5970 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5971
5972 @item M k
5973 @itemx k
5974 @kindex k (Summary)
5975 @kindex M k (Summary)
5976 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5977 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5978 and then select the next unread article
5979 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5980
5981 @item M K
5982 @itemx C-k
5983 @kindex M K (Summary)
5984 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5985 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5986 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5987 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5988
5989 @item M C
5990 @kindex M C (Summary)
5991 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5992 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5993 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5994
5995 @item M C-c
5996 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5997 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5998 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5999 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6000
6001 @item M H
6002 @kindex M H (Summary)
6003 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6004 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6005 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6006
6007 @item M h
6008 @kindex M h (Summary)
6009 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6010 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6011 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6012
6013 @item C-w
6014 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6015 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6016 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6017 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6018
6019 @item M V k
6020 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6021 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6022 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6023 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6024
6025 @item M e
6026 @itemx E
6027 @kindex M e (Summary)
6028 @kindex E (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6030 Mark the current article as expirable
6031 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6032
6033 @item M b
6034 @kindex M b (Summary)
6035 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6036 Set a bookmark in the current article
6037 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6038
6039 @item M B
6040 @kindex M B (Summary)
6041 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6042 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6043 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6044
6045 @item M V c
6046 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6047 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6048 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6049 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6050
6051 @item M V u
6052 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6054 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6055 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6056
6057 @item M V m
6058 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6059 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6060 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6061 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6062 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6063 @end table
6064
6065 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6066 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6067 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6068 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6069 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6070 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6071 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6072 The default is @code{t}.
6073
6074
6075 @node Generic Marking Commands
6076 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6077
6078 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6079 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6080 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6081 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6082 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6083 well.
6084
6085 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6086 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6087 command should do.
6088
6089 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6090 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6091 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6092 to list in this manual.
6093
6094 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6095 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6096 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6097 article, you could say something like:
6098
6099 @lisp
6100 @group
6101 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6102 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6103 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6104 @end group
6105 @end lisp
6106
6107 @noindent
6108 or
6109
6110 @lisp
6111 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6112 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6113 @end lisp
6114
6115
6116 @node Setting Process Marks
6117 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6118 @cindex setting process marks
6119
6120 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6121 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6122 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6123 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6124 commands into the cache. For more information,
6125 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6126
6127 @table @kbd
6128
6129 @item M P p
6130 @itemx #
6131 @kindex # (Summary)
6132 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6133 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6134 Mark the current article with the process mark
6135 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6136 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6137
6138 @item M P u
6139 @itemx M-#
6140 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6141 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6142 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6143 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6144
6145 @item M P U
6146 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6147 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6148 Remove the process mark from all articles
6149 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6150
6151 @item M P i
6152 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6153 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6154 Invert the list of process marked articles
6155 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6156
6157 @item M P R
6158 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6159 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6160 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6161 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6162
6163 @item M P G
6164 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6165 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6166 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6167 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6168
6169 @item M P r
6170 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6171 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6172 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6173
6174 @item M P g
6175 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6176 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6177 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6178
6179 @item M P t
6180 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6181 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6182 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6183 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6184
6185 @item M P T
6186 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6187 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6188 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6189 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6190
6191 @item M P v
6192 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6193 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6194 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6195 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6196
6197 @item M P s
6198 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6199 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6200 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6201
6202 @item M P S
6203 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6204 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6205 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6206 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6207
6208 @item M P a
6209 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6210 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6211 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6212
6213 @item M P b
6214 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6215 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6216 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6217 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6218
6219 @item M P k
6220 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6221 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6222 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6223 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6224
6225 @item M P y
6226 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6227 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6228 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6229 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6230
6231 @item M P w
6232 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6233 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6234 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6235 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6236
6237 @end table
6238
6239 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6240 set process marks based on article body contents.
6241
6242
6243 @node Limiting
6244 @section Limiting
6245 @cindex limiting
6246
6247 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6248 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6249 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6250 buffer.
6251
6252 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6253 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6254 additional articles.
6255
6256 @table @kbd
6257
6258 @item / /
6259 @itemx / s
6260 @kindex / / (Summary)
6261 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6262 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6263 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6264 matching articles.
6265
6266 @item / a
6267 @kindex / a (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6269 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6270 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6271 matching articles.
6272
6273 @item / x
6274 @kindex / x (Summary)
6275 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6276 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6277 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6278 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6279 matching articles.
6280
6281 @item / u
6282 @itemx x
6283 @kindex / u (Summary)
6284 @kindex x (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6286 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6287 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6288 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6289 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6290
6291 @item / m
6292 @kindex / m (Summary)
6293 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6294 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6295 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6296
6297 @item / t
6298 @kindex / t (Summary)
6299 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6300 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6301 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6302 articles younger than that number of days.
6303
6304 @item / n
6305 @kindex / n (Summary)
6306 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6307 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6308 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6309 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6310
6311 @item / w
6312 @kindex / w (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6314 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6315 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6316 the stack.
6317
6318 @item / .
6319 @kindex / . (Summary)
6320 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6321 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6323
6324 @item / v
6325 @kindex / v (Summary)
6326 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6327 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6328 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6329
6330 @item / p
6331 @kindex / p (Summary)
6332 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6333 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6334 group parameter predicate
6335 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6336 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6337
6338 @item / E
6339 @itemx M S
6340 @kindex M S (Summary)
6341 @kindex / E (Summary)
6342 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6343 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6344 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6345
6346 @item / D
6347 @kindex / D (Summary)
6348 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6349 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6350 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6351
6352 @item / *
6353 @kindex / * (Summary)
6354 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6355 Include all cached articles in the limit
6356 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6357
6358 @item / d
6359 @kindex / d (Summary)
6360 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6361 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6362 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6363
6364 @item / M
6365 @kindex / M (Summary)
6366 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6367 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6368
6369 @item / T
6370 @kindex / T (Summary)
6371 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6372 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6373
6374 @item / c
6375 @kindex / c (Summary)
6376 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6377 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6378 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6379
6380 @item / C
6381 @kindex / C (Summary)
6382 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6383 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6384 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6385 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6386
6387 @item / N
6388 @kindex / N (Summary)
6389 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6390 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6391 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6392
6393 @item / o
6394 @kindex / o (Summary)
6395 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6396 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6397 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6398
6399 @end table
6400
6401
6402 @node Threading
6403 @section Threading
6404 @cindex threading
6405 @cindex article threading
6406
6407 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6408 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6409 hierarchical fashion.
6410
6411 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6412 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6413 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6414 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6415 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6416 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6417 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6418
6419 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6420
6421 @table @dfn
6422 @item root
6423 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6424
6425 @item thread
6426 A tree-like article structure.
6427
6428 @item sub-thread
6429 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6430
6431 @item loose threads
6432 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6433 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6434 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6435 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6436 called loose threads.
6437
6438 @item thread gathering
6439 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6440
6441 @item sparse threads
6442 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6443 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6444
6445 @end table
6446
6447
6448 @menu
6449 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6450 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6451 @end menu
6452
6453
6454 @node Customizing Threading
6455 @subsection Customizing Threading
6456 @cindex customizing threading
6457
6458 @menu
6459 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6460 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6461 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6462 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6463 @end menu
6464
6465
6466 @node Loose Threads
6467 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6468 @cindex <
6469 @cindex >
6470 @cindex loose threads
6471
6472 @table @code
6473 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6474 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6475 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6476 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6477 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6478 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6479
6480 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6481 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6482 There are four possible values:
6483
6484 @iftex
6485 @iflatex
6486 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6487 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6488 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6489 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6490 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6491 }
6492 @end iflatex
6493 @end iftex
6494
6495 @cindex adopting articles
6496
6497 @table @code
6498
6499 @item adopt
6500 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6501 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6502 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6503 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6504
6505 @item dummy
6506 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6507 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6508 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6509 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6510 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6511 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6512 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6513 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6514 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6515 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6516
6517 @item empty
6518 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6519 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6520 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6521 Buffer Format}).)
6522
6523 @item none
6524 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6525 display them after one another.
6526
6527 @item nil
6528 Don't gather loose threads.
6529 @end table
6530
6531 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6532 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6533 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6534 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6535 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6536 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6537 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6538 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6539 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6540 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6541 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6542
6543 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6544 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6545 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6546 Matching}).
6547
6548 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6549 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6550 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6551 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6552 simplification is used.
6553
6554 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6555 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6556 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6557 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6558
6559 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6560 @lisp
6561 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6562 (concat
6563 "\\`\\[?\\("
6564 (mapconcat
6565 'identity
6566 '("looking"
6567 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6568 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6569 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6570 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6571 ;; ...
6572 )
6573 "\\|")
6574 "\\)\\s *\\("
6575 (mapconcat 'identity
6576 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6577 "\\|")
6578 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6579 @end lisp
6580
6581 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6582 subjects.
6583
6584 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6585 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6586 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6587 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6588 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6589 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6590
6591 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6592
6593 @table @code
6594 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6595 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6596 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6597
6598 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6599 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6600 Simplify fuzzily.
6601
6602 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6603 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6604 Remove excessive whitespace.
6605
6606 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6607 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6608 Remove all whitespace.
6609 @end table
6610
6611 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6612
6613
6614 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6615 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6616 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6617 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6618 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6619 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6620 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6621 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6622
6623 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6624 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6625 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6626 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6627 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6628 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6629 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6630 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6631 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6632 cholera:
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6636 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6637 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6638 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6639
6640 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6641 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6642 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6643 @end table
6644
6645 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6646 something like:
6647
6648 @lisp
6649 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6650 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6651 @end lisp
6652
6653 @end table
6654
6655
6656 @node Filling In Threads
6657 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6658
6659 @table @code
6660 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6661 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6662 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6663 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6664 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6665 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6666 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6667 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6668 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6669 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6670 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6671 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6672 do about that.
6673
6674 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6675 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6676 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6677
6678 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6679 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6680 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6681 newsgroups.
6682
6683 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6684 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6685 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6686 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6687 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6688 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6689 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6690 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6691 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6692 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6693 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6694 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6695 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6696 @code{nil} by default.
6697
6698 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6699 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6700 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6701 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6702 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6703 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6704 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6705
6706 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6707 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6708 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6709
6710 @end table
6711
6712
6713 @node More Threading
6714 @subsubsection More Threading
6715
6716 @table @code
6717 @item gnus-show-threads
6718 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6719 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6720 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6721 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6722 slower and more awkward.
6723
6724 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6725 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6726 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6727 generated.
6728
6729 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6730 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6731 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6732
6733 Here's an example:
6734
6735 @lisp
6736 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6737 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6738 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6739 @end lisp
6740
6741 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6742 unread, but you get my drift.)
6743
6744
6745 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6746 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6747 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6748 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6749 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6750 threads are expunged.
6751
6752 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6753 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6754 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6755 will be hidden.
6756
6757 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6758 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6759 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6760 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6761 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6762 result in a new thread.
6763
6764 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6765 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6766 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6767 The default is 4.
6768
6769 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6770 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6771 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6772 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6773 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6774 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6775 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6776 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6777 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6778 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6779 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6780
6781 @end table
6782
6783
6784 @node Low-Level Threading
6785 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6786
6787 @table @code
6788
6789 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6790 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6791 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6792
6793 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6794 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6795 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6796 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6797 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6798 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6799 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6800 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6801 meaningful. Here's one example:
6802
6803 @lisp
6804 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6805
6806 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6807 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6808 (when (string-match
6809 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6810 (mail-header-set-id
6811 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6812 header))))
6813 @end lisp
6814
6815 @end table
6816
6817
6818 @node Thread Commands
6819 @subsection Thread Commands
6820 @cindex thread commands
6821
6822 @table @kbd
6823
6824 @item T k
6825 @itemx C-M-k
6826 @kindex T k (Summary)
6827 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6828 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6829 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6830 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6831 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6832 articles instead.
6833
6834 @item T l
6835 @itemx C-M-l
6836 @kindex T l (Summary)
6837 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6838 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6839 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6840 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6841
6842 @item T i
6843 @kindex T i (Summary)
6844 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6845 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6846 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6847
6848 @item T #
6849 @kindex T # (Summary)
6850 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6851 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6852 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6853
6854 @item T M-#
6855 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6856 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6857 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6858 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6859
6860 @item T T
6861 @kindex T T (Summary)
6862 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6863 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6864
6865 @item T s
6866 @kindex T s (Summary)
6867 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6868 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6869 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6870
6871 @item T h
6872 @kindex T h (Summary)
6873 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6874 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6875
6876 @item T S
6877 @kindex T S (Summary)
6878 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6879 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6880
6881 @item T H
6882 @kindex T H (Summary)
6883 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6884 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6885
6886 @item T t
6887 @kindex T t (Summary)
6888 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6889 Re-thread the current article's thread
6890 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6891 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6892
6893 @item T ^
6894 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6895 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6896 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6897 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6898
6899 @end table
6900
6901 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6902 understand the numeric prefix.
6903
6904 @table @kbd
6905
6906 @item T n
6907 @kindex T n (Summary)
6908 @itemx C-M-f
6909 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6910 @itemx M-down
6911 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6912 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6913 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6914
6915 @item T p
6916 @kindex T p (Summary)
6917 @itemx C-M-b
6918 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6919 @itemx M-up
6920 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6921 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6922 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6923
6924 @item T d
6925 @kindex T d (Summary)
6926 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6927 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6928
6929 @item T u
6930 @kindex T u (Summary)
6931 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6932 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6933
6934 @item T o
6935 @kindex T o (Summary)
6936 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6937 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6938 @end table
6939
6940 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6941 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6942 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6943 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6944 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6945 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6946 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6947 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6948 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6949 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6950 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6951 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6952 Matching}).
6953
6954
6955 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6956 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6957
6958 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6959 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6960 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6961 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6962 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6963 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6964 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6965 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6966 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6967 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6968 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6969 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6970 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6971 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6972
6973 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6974 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6975 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6976 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6977 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6978 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6979 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6980 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6981
6982 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6983 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6984 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6985
6986 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6987 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6988 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6989 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6990 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6991 ascending article order.
6992
6993 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6994 by number, you could do something like:
6995
6996 @lisp
6997 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6998 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6999 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7000 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7001 @end lisp
7002
7003 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7004 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7005 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7006 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7007 which the articles arrived.
7008
7009 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7010 say something like:
7011
7012 @lisp
7013 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7014 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7015 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7016 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7017 @end lisp
7018
7019 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7020 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7021 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7022 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7023 tickles your fancy.
7024
7025 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7026 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7027 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7028 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7029 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7030 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7031 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7032 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7033 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7034 variable. It is very similar to the
7035 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7036 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7037 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7038 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7039 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7040 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7041 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7042
7043 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7044 say something like:
7045
7046 @lisp
7047 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7048 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7049 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7050 @end lisp
7051
7052
7053
7054 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7055 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7056 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7057 @cindex article pre-fetch
7058 @cindex pre-fetch
7059
7060 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7061 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7062 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7063 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7064 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7065
7066 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7067 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7068
7069 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7070 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7071 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7072 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7073 connection is blocked.
7074
7075 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7076 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7077 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7078 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7079
7080 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7081 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7082 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7083 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7084 extra connection.
7085
7086 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7087 you really want to.
7088
7089 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7090 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7091 happen automatically.
7092
7093 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7094 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7095 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7096 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7097 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7098 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7099 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7100
7101 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7102 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7103 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7104 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7105 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7106 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7107 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7108 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7109 article data structure as the only parameter.
7110
7111 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7112 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7113
7114 @lisp
7115 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7116 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7117 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7118 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7119 100)))
7120
7121 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7122 @end lisp
7123
7124 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7125 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7126 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7127
7128 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7129 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7130 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7131 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7132
7133 @table @code
7134 @item read
7135 Remove articles when they are read.
7136
7137 @item exit
7138 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7139 @end table
7140
7141 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7142
7143 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7144 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7145 @c from the next group.
7146
7147
7148 @node Article Caching
7149 @section Article Caching
7150 @cindex article caching
7151 @cindex caching
7152
7153 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7154 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7155 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7156 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7157 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7158
7159 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7160
7161 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7162 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7163 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7164 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7165 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7166 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7167 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7168 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7169
7170 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7171 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7172 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7173 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7174 as dormant, and don't worry.
7175
7176 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7177
7178 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7179 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7180 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7181 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7182 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7183 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7184 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7185 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7186 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7187 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7188
7189 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7190 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7191 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7192 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7193 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7194 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7195 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7196 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7197 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7198 not then be downloaded by this command.
7199
7200 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7201 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7202 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7203 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7204 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7205 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7206
7207 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7208 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7209 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7210 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7211 variables, the group is not cached.
7212
7213 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7214 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7215 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7216 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7217 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7218 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7219 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7220 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7221 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7222 file.
7223
7224 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7225 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7226 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7227 where, isn't that cool?
7228
7229 @node Persistent Articles
7230 @section Persistent Articles
7231 @cindex persistent articles
7232
7233 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7234 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7235 useful in my opinion.
7236
7237 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7238 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7239 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7240 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7241 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7242 the expiry going on at the news server.
7243
7244 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7245 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7246 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7247
7248 @table @kbd
7249
7250 @item *
7251 @kindex * (Summary)
7252 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7253 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7254
7255 @item M-*
7256 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7257 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7258 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7259 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7260 article.
7261 @end table
7262
7263 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7264
7265 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7266 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7267 interested in persistent articles:
7268
7269 @lisp
7270 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7271 @end lisp
7272
7273
7274 @node Article Backlog
7275 @section Article Backlog
7276 @cindex backlog
7277 @cindex article backlog
7278
7279 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7280 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7281 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7282 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7283 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7284 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7285 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7286 increase memory usage some.
7287
7288 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7289 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7290 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7291 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7292 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7293 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7294 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7295
7296 The default value is 20.
7297
7298
7299 @node Saving Articles
7300 @section Saving Articles
7301 @cindex saving articles
7302
7303 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7304 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7305 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7306 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7307 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7308
7309 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7310 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7311 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7312
7313 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7314 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7315 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7316
7317 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7318 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7319 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7320 deleted before saving.
7321
7322 @table @kbd
7323
7324 @item O o
7325 @itemx o
7326 @kindex O o (Summary)
7327 @kindex o (Summary)
7328 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7329 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7330 Save the current article using the default article saver
7331 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7332
7333 @item O m
7334 @kindex O m (Summary)
7335 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7336 Save the current article in mail format
7337 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7338
7339 @item O r
7340 @kindex O r (Summary)
7341 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7342 Save the current article in Rmail format
7343 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7344
7345 @item O f
7346 @kindex O f (Summary)
7347 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7348 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7349 Save the current article in plain file format
7350 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7351
7352 @item O F
7353 @kindex O F (Summary)
7354 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7355 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7356 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7357
7358 @item O b
7359 @kindex O b (Summary)
7360 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7361 Save the current article body in plain file format
7362 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7363
7364 @item O h
7365 @kindex O h (Summary)
7366 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7367 Save the current article in mh folder format
7368 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7369
7370 @item O v
7371 @kindex O v (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7373 Save the current article in a VM folder
7374 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7375
7376 @item O p
7377 @itemx |
7378 @kindex O p (Summary)
7379 @kindex | (Summary)
7380 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7381 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7382 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7383 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7384 complete headers in the piped output.
7385
7386 @item O P
7387 @kindex O P (Summary)
7388 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7389 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7390 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7391 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7392 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7393 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7394 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7395
7396 @end table
7397
7398 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7399 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7400 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7401 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7402 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7403 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7404 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7405 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7406 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7407 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7408 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7409 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7410 files.
7411
7412
7413 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7414 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7415 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7416 functions below, or you can create your own.
7417
7418 @table @code
7419
7420 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7421 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7422 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7423 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7424 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7425 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7426 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7427
7428 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7429 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7430 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7431 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7432 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7433 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7434
7435 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7436 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7437 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7438 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7439 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7440 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7441 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7442
7443 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7444 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7445 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7446 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7447 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7448 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7449
7450 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7451 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7452 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7453 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7454 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7455
7456 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7457 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7458 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7459 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7460 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7461 @cindex rcvstore
7462 @cindex MH folders
7463 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7464 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7465 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7466 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7467 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7468
7469 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7470 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7471 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7472 reader to use this setting.
7473 @end table
7474
7475 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7476 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7477 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7478 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7479 default.
7480
7481 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7482 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7483 available functions that generate names:
7484
7485 @table @code
7486
7487 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7488 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7489 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7490
7491 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7492 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7493 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7494
7495 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7496 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7497 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7498
7499 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7500 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7501 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7502
7503 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7504 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7505 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7506 @end table
7507
7508 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7509 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7510 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7511 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7512 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7513 like:
7514
7515 @lisp
7516 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7517 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7518 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7519 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7520 @end lisp
7521
7522 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7523 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7524 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7525 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7526 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7527 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7528 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7529 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7530 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7531
7532 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7533 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7534 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7535 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7536
7537 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7538 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7539 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7540 name.
7541
7542 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7543 lots of mail groups called things like
7544 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7545 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7546 following will do just that:
7547
7548 @lisp
7549 (defun my-save-name (group)
7550 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7551 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7552
7553 (setq gnus-split-methods
7554 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7555 (my-save-name)))
7556 @end lisp
7557
7558
7559 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7560 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7561 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7562 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7563 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7564 all the files in the top level directory
7565 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7566 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7567 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7568 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7569
7570 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7571 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7572 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7573 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7574 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7575 for kill files.
7576
7577 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7578 a spool, you could
7579
7580 @lisp
7581 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7582 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7583 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7584 @end lisp
7585
7586 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7587 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7588 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7589 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7590
7591
7592 @node Decoding Articles
7593 @section Decoding Articles
7594 @cindex decoding articles
7595
7596 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7597 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7598
7599 @menu
7600 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7601 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7602 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7603 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7604 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7605 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7606 @end menu
7607
7608 @cindex series
7609 @cindex article series
7610 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7611 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7612 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7613 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7614 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7615
7616 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7617 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7618 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7619
7620 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7621 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7622 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7623
7624 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7625 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7626 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7627
7628
7629 @node Uuencoded Articles
7630 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7631 @cindex uudecode
7632 @cindex uuencoded articles
7633
7634 @table @kbd
7635
7636 @item X u
7637 @kindex X u (Summary)
7638 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7639 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7640 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7641
7642 @item X U
7643 @kindex X U (Summary)
7644 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7645 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7646 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7647
7648 @item X v u
7649 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7650 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7651 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7652
7653 @item X v U
7654 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7655 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7656 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7657 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7658
7659 @end table
7660
7661 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7662 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7663 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7664 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7665 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7666
7667 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7668 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7669 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7670 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7671 @kbd{X u}.
7672
7673 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7674 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7675 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7676 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7677 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7678 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7679 off.
7680
7681
7682 @node Shell Archives
7683 @subsection Shell Archives
7684 @cindex unshar
7685 @cindex shell archives
7686 @cindex shared articles
7687
7688 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7689 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7690 some commands to deal with these:
7691
7692 @table @kbd
7693
7694 @item X s
7695 @kindex X s (Summary)
7696 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7697 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7698
7699 @item X S
7700 @kindex X S (Summary)
7701 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7702 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7703
7704 @item X v s
7705 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7706 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7707 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7708
7709 @item X v S
7710 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7711 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7712 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7713 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7714 @end table
7715
7716
7717 @node PostScript Files
7718 @subsection PostScript Files
7719 @cindex PostScript
7720
7721 @table @kbd
7722
7723 @item X p
7724 @kindex X p (Summary)
7725 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7726 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7727
7728 @item X P
7729 @kindex X P (Summary)
7730 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7731 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7732 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7733
7734 @item X v p
7735 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7736 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7737 View the current PostScript series
7738 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7739
7740 @item X v P
7741 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7742 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7743 View and save the current PostScript series
7744 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7745 @end table
7746
7747
7748 @node Other Files
7749 @subsection Other Files
7750
7751 @table @kbd
7752 @item X o
7753 @kindex X o (Summary)
7754 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7755 Save the current series
7756 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7757
7758 @item X b
7759 @kindex X b (Summary)
7760 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7761 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7762 doesn't really work yet.
7763 @end table
7764
7765
7766 @node Decoding Variables
7767 @subsection Decoding Variables
7768
7769 Adjective, not verb.
7770
7771 @menu
7772 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7773 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7774 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7775 @end menu
7776
7777
7778 @node Rule Variables
7779 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7780 @cindex rule variables
7781
7782 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7783 variables are of the form
7784
7785 @lisp
7786 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7787 '(regexp2 command2)
7788 ...)
7789 @end lisp
7790
7791 @table @code
7792
7793 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7794 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7795 @cindex sox
7796 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7797 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7798 say something like:
7799 @lisp
7800 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7801 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7802 @end lisp
7803
7804 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7805 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7806 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7807 user and default view rules.
7808
7809 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7810 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7811 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7812 archives.
7813 @end table
7814
7815
7816 @node Other Decode Variables
7817 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7818
7819 @table @code
7820 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7821
7822 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7823 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7824 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7825 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7826 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7827
7828 @table @code
7829
7830 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7831 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7832 View the file.
7833
7834 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7835 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7836 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7837 @end table
7838
7839 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7840 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7841 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7842 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7843 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7844 time.
7845
7846 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7847 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7848 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7849
7850 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7851 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7852 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7853 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7854 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7855 kludgey.
7856
7857 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7858 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7859 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7860
7861 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7862 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7863 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7864 looking for files to display.
7865
7866 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7867 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7868 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7869 after viewing it.
7870
7871 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7872 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7873 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7874 rules.
7875
7876 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7877 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7878 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7879 unpacking commands.
7880
7881 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7882 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7883 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7884 from articles.
7885
7886 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7887 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7888 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7889 decoded articles as unread.
7890
7891 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7892 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7893 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7894 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7895
7896 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7897 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7898 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7899
7900 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7901 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7902 @cindex metamail
7903 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7904 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7905 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7906 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7907
7908 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7909 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7910 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7911 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7912 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7913 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7914 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7915 simply dropped them.
7916
7917 @end table
7918
7919
7920 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7921 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7922
7923 @table @code
7924
7925 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7926 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7927 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7928 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7929 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7930 for you when you post the article.
7931
7932 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7933 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7934 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7935 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7936
7937 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7938 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7939 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7940 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7941 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7942 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7943 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7944
7945 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7946 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7947 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7948 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7949 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7950 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7951 Default is @code{t}.
7952
7953 @end table
7954
7955
7956 @node Viewing Files
7957 @subsection Viewing Files
7958 @cindex viewing files
7959 @cindex pseudo-articles
7960
7961 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7962 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7963 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7964 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7965 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7966 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7967 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7968
7969 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7970 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7971 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7972 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7973
7974 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7975 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7976 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7977
7978 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7979 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7980 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7981 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7982 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7983
7984 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7985 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7986 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7987 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7988 a list of parameters to that command.
7989
7990 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7991 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7992 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7993
7994 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7995 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7996 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7997
7998
7999 @node Article Treatment
8000 @section Article Treatment
8001
8002 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8003 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8004 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8005 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8006 these articles easier.
8007
8008 @menu
8009 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8010 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8011 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8012 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8013 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8014 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8015 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8016 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8017 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8018 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8019 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8020 @end menu
8021
8022
8023 @node Article Highlighting
8024 @subsection Article Highlighting
8025 @cindex highlighting
8026
8027 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8028 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8029
8030 @table @kbd
8031
8032 @item W H a
8033 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8034 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8035 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8036 Do much highlighting of the current article
8037 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8038 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8039
8040 @item W H h
8041 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8042 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8043 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8044 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8045 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8046 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8047 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8048 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8049 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8050 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8051 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8052 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8053
8054 @item W H c
8055 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8056 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8057 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8058
8059 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8060
8061 @table @code
8062 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8063
8064 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8065 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8066 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8067
8068 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8069 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8070 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8071
8072 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8073 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8074 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8075 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8076 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8077 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8078
8079 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8080 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8081 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8082
8083 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8084 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8085 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8086
8087 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8088 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8089 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8090 that it's a citation.
8091
8092 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8093 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8094 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8095
8096 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8097 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8098 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8099
8100 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8101 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8102 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8103 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8104
8105 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8106 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8107 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8108 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8109 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8110 is @code{t}.
8111
8112 @end table
8113
8114
8115 @item W H s
8116 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8117 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8118 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8119 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8120 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8121 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8122 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8123 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8124 default.
8125
8126 @end table
8127
8128 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8129
8130
8131 @node Article Fontisizing
8132 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8133 @cindex emphasis
8134 @cindex article emphasis
8135
8136 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8137 @kindex W e (Summary)
8138 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8139 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8140 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8141 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8142
8143 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8144 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8145 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8146 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8147 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8148 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8149 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8150 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8151 highlighting.
8152
8153 @lisp
8154 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8155 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8156 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8157 @end lisp
8158
8159 @cindex slash
8160 @cindex asterisk
8161 @cindex underline
8162 @cindex /
8163 @cindex *
8164
8165 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8166 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8167 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8168 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8169 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8170 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8171 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8172 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8173 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8174 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8175 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8176 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8177 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8178
8179 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8180 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8181 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8182 say something like:
8183
8184 @lisp
8185 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8186 @end lisp
8187
8188 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8189
8190 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8191 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8192 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8193 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8194
8195 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8196
8197
8198 @node Article Hiding
8199 @subsection Article Hiding
8200 @cindex article hiding
8201
8202 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8203 too much cruft in most articles.
8204
8205 @table @kbd
8206
8207 @item W W a
8208 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8209 @findex gnus-article-hide
8210 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8211 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8212 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8213
8214 @item W W h
8215 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8217 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8218 Headers}.
8219
8220 @item W W b
8221 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8223 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8224 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8225
8226 @item W W s
8227 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8228 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8229 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8230 Signature}.
8231
8232 @item W W l
8233 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8234 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8235 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8236 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8237 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8238 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8239 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8240 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8241
8242 @table @code
8243
8244 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8245 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8246 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8247 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8248
8249 @end table
8250
8251 @item W W P
8252 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8253 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8254 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8255 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8256
8257 @item W W B
8258 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8259 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8260 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8261 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8262 @cindex banner
8263 @cindex OneList
8264 @cindex stripping advertisements
8265 @cindex advertisements
8266 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8267 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8268 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8269 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8270 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8271 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8272 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8273 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8274 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8275 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8276 used.
8277
8278 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8279 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8280 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8281
8282 @table @code
8283
8284 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8285 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8286 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8287 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8288 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8289 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8290 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8291 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8292 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8293 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8294 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8295
8296 @lisp
8297 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8298 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8299 @end lisp
8300
8301 @end table
8302
8303 @item W W c
8304 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8305 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8306 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8307 customizing the hiding:
8308
8309 @table @code
8310
8311 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8312 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8313 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8314 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8315 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8316 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8317 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8318 specs are valid:
8319
8320 @table @samp
8321 @item b
8322 Starting point of the hidden text.
8323 @item e
8324 Ending point of the hidden text.
8325 @item l
8326 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8327 @item n
8328 Number of lines of hidden text.
8329 @end table
8330
8331 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8332 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8333 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8334 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8335 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8336
8337 @end table
8338
8339 @item W W C-c
8340 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8341 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8342
8343 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8344 following two variables:
8345
8346 @table @code
8347 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8348 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8349 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8350 50), hide the cited text.
8351
8352 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8353 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8354 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8355 is hidden.
8356 @end table
8357
8358 @item W W C
8359 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8360 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8361 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8362 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8363 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8364 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8365
8366 @end table
8367
8368 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8369 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8370 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8371
8372 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8373 citation customization.
8374
8375 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8376 automatically.
8377
8378
8379 @node Article Washing
8380 @subsection Article Washing
8381 @cindex washing
8382 @cindex article washing
8383
8384 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8385 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8386
8387 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8388 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8389 Cleaner, perhaps.
8390
8391 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8392 articles by default.
8393
8394 @table @kbd
8395
8396 @item C-u g
8397 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8398 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8399 the server.
8400
8401 @item g
8402 Force redisplaying of the current article
8403 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8404 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8405 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8406 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8407
8408 @item W l
8409 @kindex W l (Summary)
8410 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8411 Remove page breaks from the current article
8412 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8413 delimiters.
8414
8415 @item W r
8416 @kindex W r (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8418 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8419 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8420 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8421 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8422 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8423
8424 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8425 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8426 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8427 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8428
8429 @item W m
8430 @kindex W m (Summary)
8431 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8432 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8433
8434 @item W t
8435 @item t
8436 @kindex W t (Summary)
8437 @kindex t (Summary)
8438 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8439 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8440 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8441
8442 @item W v
8443 @kindex W v (Summary)
8444 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8445 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8446 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8447
8448 @item W o
8449 @kindex W o (Summary)
8450 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8451 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8452
8453 @item W d
8454 @kindex W d (Summary)
8455 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8456 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8457 @cindex Smartquotes
8458 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8459 @cindex Latin 1
8460 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8461 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8462 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8463 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8464 interactively.
8465
8466 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8467 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8468 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8469 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8470
8471 @item W Y f
8472 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8473 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8474 @cindex Outlook Express
8475 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8476 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8477 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8478
8479 @item W Y u
8480 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8481 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8482 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8483 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8484 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8485 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8486 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8487 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8488 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8489 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8490
8491 @item W Y a
8492 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8493 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8494 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8495 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8496
8497 @item W Y c
8498 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8499 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8500 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8501 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8502
8503 @item W w
8504 @kindex W w (Summary)
8505 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8506 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8507
8508 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8509 when filling.
8510
8511 @item W Q
8512 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8513 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8514 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8515
8516 @item W C
8517 @kindex W C (Summary)
8518 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8519 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8520 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8521
8522 @item W c
8523 @kindex W c (Summary)
8524 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8525 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8526 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8527 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8528 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8529
8530 @item W q
8531 @kindex W q (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8533 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8534 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8535 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8536 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8537 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8538 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8539 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8540 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8541
8542 @item W 6
8543 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8544 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8545 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8546 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8547 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8548 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8549 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8550 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8551
8552 @item W Z
8553 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8554 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8555 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8556 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8557 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8558
8559 @item W u
8560 @kindex W u (Summary)
8561 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8562 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8563 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8564 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8565 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8566
8567 @item W h
8568 @kindex W h (Summary)
8569 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8570 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8571 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8572 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8573
8574 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8575 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8576 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8577
8578 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8579 The default is to use the function specified by
8580 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8581 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8582 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8583 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8584 can use include:
8585
8586 @table @code
8587 @item w3
8588 Use Emacs/W3.
8589
8590 @item w3m
8591 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8592
8593 @item w3m-standalone
8594 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8595
8596 @item links
8597 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8598
8599 @item lynx
8600 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8601
8602 @item html2text
8603 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8604
8605 @end table
8606
8607 @item W b
8608 @kindex W b (Summary)
8609 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8610 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8611 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8612
8613 @item W B
8614 @kindex W B (Summary)
8615 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8616 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8617 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8618
8619 @item W p
8620 @kindex W p (Summary)
8621 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8622 Verify a signed control message
8623 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8624 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8625 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8626 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8627 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8628 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8629
8630 @item W s
8631 @kindex W s (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8633 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8634 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8635 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8636
8637 @item W a
8638 @kindex W a (Summary)
8639 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8640 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8641 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8642
8643 @item W E l
8644 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8645 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8646 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8647 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8648
8649 @item W E m
8650 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8651 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8652 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8653 lines with a single empty line.
8654 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8655
8656 @item W E t
8657 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8658 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8659 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8660 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8661
8662 @item W E a
8663 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8664 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8665 Do all the three commands above
8666 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8667
8668 @item W E A
8669 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8670 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8671 Remove all blank lines
8672 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8673
8674 @item W E s
8675 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8676 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8677 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8678 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8679
8680 @item W E e
8681 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8682 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8683 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8684 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8685
8686 @end table
8687
8688 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8689
8690
8691 @node Article Header
8692 @subsection Article Header
8693
8694 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8695
8696 @table @kbd
8697
8698 @item W G u
8699 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8700 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8701 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8702
8703 @item W G n
8704 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8705 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8706 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8707 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8708
8709 @item W G f
8710 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8711 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8712 Fold all the message headers
8713 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8714
8715 @item W E w
8716 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8717 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8718 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8719 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8720
8721 @end table
8722
8723
8724 @node Article Buttons
8725 @subsection Article Buttons
8726 @cindex buttons
8727
8728 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8729 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8730 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8731 button on these references.
8732
8733 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8734 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8735 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8736 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8737 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8738
8739 @table @code
8740
8741 @item gnus-button-alist
8742 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8743 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8744
8745 @lisp
8746 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8747 @end lisp
8748
8749 @table @var
8750
8751 @item regexp
8752 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8753 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8754 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8755 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8756 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8757
8758 @item button-par
8759 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8760 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8761 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8762
8763 @item use-p
8764 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8765 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8766 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8767 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8768 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8769
8770 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8771
8772 @item function
8773 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8774
8775 @item data-par
8776 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8777 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8778
8779 @end table
8780
8781 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8782
8783 @lisp
8784 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8785 @end lisp
8786
8787 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8788 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8789 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8790 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8791 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8792
8793 @lisp
8794 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8795 @end lisp
8796
8797 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8798 @end table
8799
8800 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8801
8802 @table @code
8803 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8804 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8805
8806 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8807
8808 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8809 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8810 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8811 default values of the variables above.
8812
8813 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8814
8815 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8816 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8817 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8818 argument with a string naming the man page.
8819
8820 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8821
8822 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8823 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8824 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8825
8826 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8827 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8828 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8829 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8830 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8831 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8832 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8833 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8834 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8835 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8836 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8837 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8838
8839 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8840 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8841 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8842 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8843 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8844 string is invalid.
8845
8846 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8847 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8848 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8849 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8850
8851 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8852
8853 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8854 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8855 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8856 argument, the string naming the URL.
8857
8858 @item gnus-ctan-url
8859 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8860 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8861 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8862
8863 @c Misc stuff
8864
8865 @item gnus-article-button-face
8866 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8867 Face used on buttons.
8868
8869 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8870 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8871 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8872
8873 @end table
8874
8875 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8876
8877
8878 @node Article Button Levels
8879 @subsection Article button levels
8880 @cindex button levels
8881 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8882 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8883 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8884 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8885 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8886 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8887 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8888 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8889
8890 @lisp
8891 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8892 (setq gnus-parameters
8893 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8894 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8895 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8896 @end lisp
8897
8898 @table @code
8899
8900 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8901 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8902 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8903 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8904 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8905 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8906
8907 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8908 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8909 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8910 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8911 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8912 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8913 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8914 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8915 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8916 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8917 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8918 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8919 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8920
8921 @item gnus-button-man-level
8922 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8923 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8924 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8925
8926 @item gnus-button-message-level
8927 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8928 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8929 Related variables and functions include
8930 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8931 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8932 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8933 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8934
8935 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8936 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8937 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8938 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8939 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8940 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8941 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8942
8943 @end table
8944
8945
8946 @node Article Date
8947 @subsection Article Date
8948
8949 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8950 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8951 when the article was sent.
8952
8953 @table @kbd
8954
8955 @item W T u
8956 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8957 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8958 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8959 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8960
8961 @item W T i
8962 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8963 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8964 @cindex ISO 8601
8965 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8966 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8967
8968 @item W T l
8969 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8970 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8971 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8972
8973 @item W T p
8974 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8975 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8976 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8977 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8978
8979 @item W T s
8980 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8981 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8982 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8983 @findex format-time-string
8984 Display the date using a user-defined format
8985 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8986 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8987 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8988 for a list of possible format specs.
8989
8990 @item W T e
8991 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8992 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8993 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8994 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8995 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8996 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8997
8998 @example
8999 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9000 @end example
9001
9002 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9003 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9004 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9005 replace it.
9006
9007 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9008 into wonderful absurdities.
9009
9010 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9011
9012 @lisp
9013 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9014 @end lisp
9015
9016 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9017 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9018 command.
9019
9020 @item W T o
9021 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9022 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9023 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9024 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9025 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9026 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9027 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9028
9029 @end table
9030
9031 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9032 preferred format automatically.
9033
9034
9035 @node Article Display
9036 @subsection Article Display
9037 @cindex picons
9038 @cindex x-face
9039 @cindex smileys
9040
9041 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9042 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9043
9044 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9045 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9046
9047 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9048 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9049
9050 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9051 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9052
9053 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9054 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9055
9056 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9057 they'll be removed.
9058
9059 @table @kbd
9060 @item W D x
9061 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9062 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9063 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9064 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9065
9066 @item W D d
9067 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9069 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9070 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9071
9072 @item W D s
9073 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9074 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9075 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9076
9077 @item W D f
9078 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9079 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9080 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9081
9082 @item W D m
9083 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9084 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9085 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9086 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9087
9088 @item W D n
9089 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9090 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9091 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9092 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9093
9094 @item W D D
9095 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9096 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9097 Remove all images from the article buffer
9098 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9099
9100 @end table
9101
9102
9103
9104 @node Article Signature
9105 @subsection Article Signature
9106 @cindex signatures
9107 @cindex article signature
9108
9109 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9110 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9111 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9112 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9113 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9114 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9115 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9116 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9117 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9118
9119 @lisp
9120 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9121 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9122 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9123 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9124 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9125 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9126 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9127 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9128 @end lisp
9129
9130 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9131 positives.
9132
9133 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9134 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9135 signature when displaying articles.
9136
9137 @enumerate
9138 @item
9139 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9140 that integer.
9141 @item
9142 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9143 than that number.
9144 @item
9145 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9146 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9147 @item
9148 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9149 in question is not a signature.
9150 @end enumerate
9151
9152 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9153 listed above. Here's an example:
9154
9155 @lisp
9156 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9157 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9158 @end lisp
9159
9160 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9161 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9162 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9163 signature after all.
9164
9165
9166 @node Article Miscellanea
9167 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9168
9169 @table @kbd
9170 @item A t
9171 @kindex A t (Summary)
9172 @findex gnus-article-babel
9173 Translate the article from one language to another
9174 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9175
9176 @end table
9177
9178
9179 @node MIME Commands
9180 @section MIME Commands
9181 @cindex MIME decoding
9182 @cindex attachments
9183 @cindex viewing attachments
9184
9185 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9186 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9187
9188 @table @kbd
9189 @item b
9190 @itemx K v
9191 @kindex b (Summary)
9192 @kindex K v (Summary)
9193 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9194
9195 @item K o
9196 @kindex K o (Summary)
9197 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9198
9199 @item K c
9200 @kindex K c (Summary)
9201 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9202
9203 @item K e
9204 @kindex K e (Summary)
9205 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9206
9207 @item K i
9208 @kindex K i (Summary)
9209 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9210
9211 @item K |
9212 @kindex K | (Summary)
9213 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9214 @end table
9215
9216 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9217 the same manner:
9218
9219 @table @kbd
9220 @item K b
9221 @kindex K b (Summary)
9222 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9223 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9224 parts.
9225
9226 @item K m
9227 @kindex K m (Summary)
9228 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9229 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9230 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9231 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9232 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9233
9234 @item X m
9235 @kindex X m (Summary)
9236 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9237 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9238 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9239 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9240
9241 @item M-t
9242 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9243 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9244 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9245 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9246
9247 @item W M w
9248 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9249 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9250 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9251 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9252
9253 @item W M c
9254 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9255 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9256 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9257 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9258
9259 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9260 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9261 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9262 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9263 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9264 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9265
9266 @item W M v
9267 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9268 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9269 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9270 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9271
9272 @end table
9273
9274 Relevant variables:
9275
9276 @table @code
9277 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9278 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9279 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9280 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9281 @code{nil}.
9282
9283 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9284
9285 @lisp
9286 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9287 '("text/x-vcard"))
9288 @end lisp
9289
9290 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9291 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9292 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9293 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9294 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9295 default is @code{nil}.
9296
9297 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9298 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9299 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9300 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9301 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9302 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9303 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9304
9305 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9306 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9307 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9308 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9309 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9310 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9311 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9312 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9313
9314 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9315 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9316 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9317 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9318 displayed. This variable overrides
9319 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9320 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9321 is @code{nil}.
9322
9323 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9324 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9325 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9326
9327 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9328 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9329 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9330 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9331 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9332
9333 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9334 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9335 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9336 default value is @code{nil}.
9337
9338 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9339 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9340 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9341 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9342 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9343 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9344 save all jpegs into some directory).
9345
9346 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9347
9348 @lisp
9349 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9350 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9351 (with-temp-buffer
9352 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9353 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9354 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9355 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9356 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9357 @end lisp
9358
9359 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9360 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9361 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9362
9363 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9364 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9365 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9366
9367 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9368 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9369 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9370
9371 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9372 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} in @ref{Display Customization,
9373 Display Customization, , emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}. Images or
9374 other material inside a "multipart/related" part might be overlooked
9375 when this variable is @code{nil}.
9376
9377 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9378 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9379 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9380 overrides @code{nil} values of
9381 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9382 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9383
9384 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9385 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9386 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9387 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9388
9389 Ready-made functions include@*
9390 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9391 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9392 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9393 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9394 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9395 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9396 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9397 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9398 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9399 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9400 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9401 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9402
9403 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9404 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9405
9406 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9407 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9408 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9409
9410 @lisp
9411 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9412 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9413 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9414 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9415 @end lisp
9416
9417 @noindent
9418 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9419
9420 @end table
9421
9422
9423 @node Charsets
9424 @section Charsets
9425 @cindex charsets
9426
9427 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9428 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9429 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9430 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9431 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9432 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9433 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9434
9435 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9436 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9437 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9438 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9439
9440 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9441 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9442 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9443 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9444 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9445 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9446 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9447 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9448 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9449
9450 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9451 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9452 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9453 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9454 quoted-printable header encoding.
9455
9456 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9457 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9458 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9459
9460 @table @var
9461 @item test
9462 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9463 variable to query,
9464 @item header
9465 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9466 means encode all charsets),
9467 @item body-list
9468 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9469 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9470 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9471 @end table
9472
9473 @cindex Russian
9474 @cindex koi8-r
9475 @cindex koi8-u
9476 @cindex iso-8859-5
9477 @cindex coding system aliases
9478 @cindex preferred charset
9479
9480 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9481 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9482 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9483
9484 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9485
9486 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9487 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9488
9489 @lisp
9490 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9491 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9492 @end lisp
9493
9494 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9495 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9496
9497 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9498
9499 @lisp
9500 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9501 @end lisp
9502
9503 This will almost do the right thing.
9504
9505 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9506 something like
9507
9508 @lisp
9509 (codepage-setup 1251)
9510 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9511 @end lisp
9512
9513
9514 @node Article Commands
9515 @section Article Commands
9516
9517 @table @kbd
9518
9519 @item A P
9520 @cindex PostScript
9521 @cindex printing
9522 @kindex A P (Summary)
9523 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9524 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9525 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9526 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9527 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9528 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9529
9530 @end table
9531
9532
9533 @node Summary Sorting
9534 @section Summary Sorting
9535 @cindex summary sorting
9536
9537 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9538 can't really see why you'd want that.
9539
9540 @table @kbd
9541
9542 @item C-c C-s C-n
9543 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9544 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9545 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9546
9547 @item C-c C-s C-a
9548 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9549 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9550 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9551
9552 @item C-c C-s C-s
9553 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9554 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9555 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9556
9557 @item C-c C-s C-d
9558 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9559 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9560 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9561
9562 @item C-c C-s C-l
9563 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9564 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9565 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9566
9567 @item C-c C-s C-c
9568 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9569 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9570 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9571
9572 @item C-c C-s C-i
9573 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9574 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9575 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9576
9577 @item C-c C-s C-r
9578 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9579 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9580 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9581
9582 @item C-c C-s C-o
9583 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9584 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9585 Sort using the default sorting method
9586 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9587 @end table
9588
9589 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9590 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9591 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9592 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9593 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9594 Commands}).
9595
9596
9597 @node Finding the Parent
9598 @section Finding the Parent
9599 @cindex parent articles
9600 @cindex referring articles
9601
9602 @table @kbd
9603 @item ^
9604 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9605 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9606 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9607 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9608 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9609 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9610 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9611 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9612 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9613 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9614
9615 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9616 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9617 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9618 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9619 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9620 article.
9621
9622 @item A R (Summary)
9623 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9624 @kindex A R (Summary)
9625 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9626 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9627
9628 @item A T (Summary)
9629 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9630 @kindex A T (Summary)
9631 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9632 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9633 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9634 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9635 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9636 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9637 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9638
9639 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9640 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9641 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9642 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9643 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9644 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9645
9646 @item M-^ (Summary)
9647 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9648 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9649 @cindex Message-ID
9650 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9651 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9652 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9653 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9654 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9655 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9656
9657 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9658 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9659 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9660 @end table
9661
9662 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9663 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9664 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9665 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9666 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9667 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9668 necessary.
9669
9670 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9671 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9672 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9673 match.
9674
9675 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9676 then ask Google if that fails:
9677
9678 @lisp
9679 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9680 '(current
9681 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9682 @end lisp
9683
9684 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9685 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9686 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9687 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9688 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9689 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9690 not support this at all.
9691
9692
9693 @node Alternative Approaches
9694 @section Alternative Approaches
9695
9696 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9697 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9698
9699 @menu
9700 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9701 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9702 @end menu
9703
9704
9705 @node Pick and Read
9706 @subsection Pick and Read
9707 @cindex pick and read
9708
9709 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9710 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9711 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9712 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9713
9714 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9715 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9716 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9717 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9718 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9719 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9720
9721 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9722
9723 @table @kbd
9724 @item .
9725 @kindex . (Pick)
9726 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9727 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9728 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9729 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9730 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9731 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9732 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9733 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9734
9735 @item SPACE
9736 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9737 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9738 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9739 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9740
9741 @item u
9742 @kindex u (Pick)
9743 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9744 Unpick the thread or article
9745 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9746 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9747 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9748 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9749 the thread or article at that line.
9750
9751 @item RET
9752 @kindex RET (Pick)
9753 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9754 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9755 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9756 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9757 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9758 will still be visible when you are reading.
9759
9760 @end table
9761
9762 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9763 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9764 which is mapped to the same function
9765 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9766
9767 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9768
9769 @lisp
9770 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9771 @end lisp
9772
9773 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9774 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9775
9776 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9777 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9778 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9779
9780 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9781 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9782 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9783 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9784 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9785 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9786 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9787
9788
9789 @node Binary Groups
9790 @subsection Binary Groups
9791 @cindex binary groups
9792
9793 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9794 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9795 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9796 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9797 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9798 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9799 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9800
9801 @kindex g (Binary)
9802 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9803 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9804 command, when you have turned on this mode
9805 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9806
9807 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9808 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9809
9810
9811 @node Tree Display
9812 @section Tree Display
9813 @cindex trees
9814
9815 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9816 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9817 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9818 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9819 in the tree buffer.
9820
9821 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9822
9823 @table @code
9824 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9825 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9826 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9827
9828 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9829 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9830 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9831 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9832 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9833
9834 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9835 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9836 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9837 default is @code{modeline}.
9838
9839 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9840 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9841 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9842 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9843 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9844 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9845 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9846
9847 Valid specs are:
9848
9849 @table @samp
9850 @item n
9851 The name of the poster.
9852 @item f
9853 The @code{From} header.
9854 @item N
9855 The number of the article.
9856 @item [
9857 The opening bracket.
9858 @item ]
9859 The closing bracket.
9860 @item s
9861 The subject.
9862 @end table
9863
9864 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9865
9866 Variables related to the display are:
9867
9868 @table @code
9869 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9870 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9871 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9872 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9873 @example
9874 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9875 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9876 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9877 @end example
9878 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9879
9880 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9881 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9882 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9883 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9884
9885 @end table
9886
9887 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9888 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9889 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9890 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9891 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9892 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9893 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9894 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9895 other windows displayed next to it.
9896
9897 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9898 at all times:
9899
9900 @lisp
9901 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9902 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9903 @end lisp
9904
9905 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9906 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9907 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9908 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9909 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9910 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9911 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9912
9913 @end table
9914
9915 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9916
9917 @example
9918 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9919 | \[Jan]
9920 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9921 | \(***)-[Eri]
9922 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9923 \[Bjo]
9924 \[Gun]
9925 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9926 @end example
9927
9928 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9929
9930 @example
9931 @group
9932 @{***@}
9933 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9934 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9935 |--\-----\-----\ |
9936 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9937 | | |--\
9938 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9939 |
9940 [Paa]
9941 @end group
9942 @end example
9943
9944 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9945 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9946 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9947
9948 @lisp
9949 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9950 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9951 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9952 (gnus-add-configuration
9953 '(article
9954 (vertical 1.0
9955 (horizontal 0.25
9956 (summary 0.75 point)
9957 (tree 1.0))
9958 (article 1.0))))
9959 @end lisp
9960
9961 @xref{Window Layout}.
9962
9963
9964 @node Mail Group Commands
9965 @section Mail Group Commands
9966 @cindex mail group commands
9967
9968 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9969 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9970
9971 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9972 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9973
9974 @table @kbd
9975
9976 @item B e
9977 @kindex B e (Summary)
9978 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9979 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9980 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9981 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9982 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9983
9984 @item B C-M-e
9985 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9986 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9987 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9988 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9989 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9990 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9991
9992 @item B DEL
9993 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9994 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9995 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9996 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9997 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9998 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9999
10000 @item B m
10001 @kindex B m (Summary)
10002 @cindex move mail
10003 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10004 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10005 Move the article from one mail group to another
10006 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10007 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10008
10009 @item B c
10010 @kindex B c (Summary)
10011 @cindex copy mail
10012 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10013 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10014 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10015 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10016 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10017
10018 @item B B
10019 @kindex B B (Summary)
10020 @cindex crosspost mail
10021 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10022 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10023 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10024 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10025 be properly updated.
10026
10027 @item B i
10028 @kindex B i (Summary)
10029 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10030 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10031 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10032 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10033
10034 @item B I
10035 @kindex B I (Summary)
10036 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10037 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10038 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10039 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10040
10041 @item B r
10042 @kindex B r (Summary)
10043 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10044 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10045 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10046 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10047 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10048 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10049 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10050 (which is the default).
10051
10052 @item B w
10053 @itemx e
10054 @kindex B w (Summary)
10055 @kindex e (Summary)
10056 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10057 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10058 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10059 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10060 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10061 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10062 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10063
10064 @item B q
10065 @kindex B q (Summary)
10066 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10067 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10068 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10069 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10070
10071 @item B t
10072 @kindex B t (Summary)
10073 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10074 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10075 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10076
10077 @item B p
10078 @kindex B p (Summary)
10079 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10080 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10081 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10082 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10083 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10084 article from your news server (or rather, from
10085 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10086 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10087 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10088 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10089 just not have arrived yet.
10090
10091 @item K E
10092 @kindex K E (Summary)
10093 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10094 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10095 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10096 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10097 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10098
10099 @end table
10100
10101 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10102 @cindex moving articles
10103 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10104 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10105 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10106 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10107 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10108 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10109 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10110
10111 @lisp
10112 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10113 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10114 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10115 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10116 @end lisp
10117
10118
10119 @node Various Summary Stuff
10120 @section Various Summary Stuff
10121
10122 @menu
10123 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10124 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10125 * Summary Generation Commands::
10126 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10127 @end menu
10128
10129 @table @code
10130 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10131 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10132 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10133 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10134 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10135 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10136
10137 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10138 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10139 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10140 current article.
10141
10142 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10143 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10144 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10145
10146 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10147 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10148 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10149 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10150 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10151 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10152 have been set.
10153
10154 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10155 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10156 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10157 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10158 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10159
10160 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10161 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10162 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10163 generated.
10164
10165 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10166 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10167 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10168 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10169 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10170 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10171 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10172 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10173 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10174 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10175
10176 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10177 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10178 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10179 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10180 list of articles to be selected.
10181
10182 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10183 the list in one particular group:
10184
10185 @lisp
10186 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10187 (if (string= group "some.group")
10188 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10189 articles))
10190 @end lisp
10191
10192 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10193 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10194 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10195 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10196 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10197 buffer is active.
10198
10199 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10200 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10201 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10202 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10203 variable will be used instead.
10204
10205 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10206 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10207 buffers. For example:
10208
10209 @lisp
10210 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10211 '(message-use-followup-to
10212 (gnus-visible-headers .
10213 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10214 @end lisp
10215
10216 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10217 @end table
10218
10219
10220 @node Summary Group Information
10221 @subsection Summary Group Information
10222
10223 @table @kbd
10224
10225 @item H f
10226 @kindex H f (Summary)
10227 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10228 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10229 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10230 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10231 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10232 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10233 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10234 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10235 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10236
10237 @item H d
10238 @kindex H d (Summary)
10239 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10240 Give a brief description of the current group
10241 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10242 rereading the description from the server.
10243
10244 @item H h
10245 @kindex H h (Summary)
10246 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10247 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10248 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10249
10250 @item H i
10251 @kindex H i (Summary)
10252 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10253 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10254 @end table
10255
10256
10257 @node Searching for Articles
10258 @subsection Searching for Articles
10259
10260 @table @kbd
10261
10262 @item M-s
10263 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10264 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10265 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10266 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10267
10268 @item M-r
10269 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10270 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10271 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10272 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10273
10274 @item &
10275 @kindex & (Summary)
10276 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10277 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10278 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10279 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10280 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10281 search backward instead.
10282
10283 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10284 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10285
10286 @item M-&
10287 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10288 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10289 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10290 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10291 @end table
10292
10293 @node Summary Generation Commands
10294 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10295
10296 @table @kbd
10297
10298 @item Y g
10299 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10300 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10301 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10302
10303 @item Y c
10304 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10305 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10306 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10307 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10308
10309 @item Y d
10310 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10311 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10312 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10313 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10314
10315 @end table
10316
10317
10318 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10319 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10320
10321 @table @kbd
10322
10323 @item A D
10324 @itemx C-d
10325 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10326 @kindex A D (Summary)
10327 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10328 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10329 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10330 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10331 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10332 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10333 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10334 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10335 fashion.
10336
10337 @item C-M-d
10338 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10339 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10340 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10341 several documents into one biiig group
10342 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10343 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10344 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10345 command understands the process/prefix convention
10346 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10347
10348 @item C-t
10349 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10350 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10351 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10352 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10353 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10354 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10355
10356 @item =
10357 @kindex = (Summary)
10358 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10359 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10360 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10361
10362 @item C-M-e
10363 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10364 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10365 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10366 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10367
10368 @item C-M-a
10369 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10370 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10371 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10372 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10373
10374 @end table
10375
10376
10377 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10378 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10379 @cindex summary exit
10380 @cindex exiting groups
10381
10382 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10383 group and return you to the group buffer.
10384
10385 @table @kbd
10386
10387 @item Z Z
10388 @itemx Z Q
10389 @itemx q
10390 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10391 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10392 @kindex q (Summary)
10393 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10394 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10395 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10396 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10397 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10398 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10399 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10400 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10401 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10402 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10403 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10404 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10405
10406 @item Z E
10407 @itemx Q
10408 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10409 @kindex Q (Summary)
10410 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10411 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10412 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10413
10414 @item Z c
10415 @itemx c
10416 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10417 @kindex c (Summary)
10418 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10419 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10420 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10421 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10422
10423 @item Z C
10424 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10425 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10426 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10427 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10428
10429 @item Z n
10430 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10431 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10432 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10433 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10434
10435 @item Z R
10436 @itemx C-x C-s
10437 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10438 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10439 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10440 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10441 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10442 all articles, both read and unread.
10443
10444 @item Z G
10445 @itemx M-g
10446 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10447 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10448 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10449 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10450 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10451 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10452 articles, both read and unread.
10453
10454 @item Z N
10455 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10456 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10457 Exit the group and go to the next group
10458 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10459
10460 @item Z P
10461 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10462 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10463 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10464 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10465
10466 @item Z s
10467 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10468 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10469 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10470 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10471 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10472 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10473 @end table
10474
10475 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10476 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10477 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10478 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10479
10480 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10481 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10482 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10483 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10484 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10485 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10486 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10487 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10488 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10489 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10490 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10491 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10492
10493 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10494
10495 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10496 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10497 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10498 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10499 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10500 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10501 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10502 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10503 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10504
10505
10506 @node Crosspost Handling
10507 @section Crosspost Handling
10508
10509 @cindex velveeta
10510 @cindex spamming
10511 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10512 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10513 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10514 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10515 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10516 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10517 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10518
10519 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10520 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10521 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10522 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10523 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10524
10525 @cindex cross-posting
10526 @cindex Xref
10527 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10528 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10529 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10530 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10531 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10532 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10533 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10534 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10535 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10536 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10537 the cross reference mechanism.
10538
10539 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10540 @cindex overview.fmt
10541 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10542 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10543 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10544 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10545 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10546 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10547 overview files.
10548
10549 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10550 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10551 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10552 considerably.
10553
10554 C'est la vie.
10555
10556 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10557
10558
10559 @node Duplicate Suppression
10560 @section Duplicate Suppression
10561
10562 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10563 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10564 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10565 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10566 reasons.
10567
10568 @enumerate
10569 @item
10570 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10571 is evil and not very common.
10572
10573 @item
10574 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10575 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10576
10577 @item
10578 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10579 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10580
10581 @item
10582 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10583 @end enumerate
10584
10585 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10586 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10587
10588 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10589 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10590 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10591 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10592 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10593 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10594 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10595 once.
10596
10597 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10598 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10599 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10600 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10601 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10602 saw the article in.
10603
10604 @table @code
10605 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10606 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10607 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10608
10609 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10610 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10611 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10612 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10613 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10614 session are suppressed.
10615
10616 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10617 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10618 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10619 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10620
10621 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10622 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10623 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10624 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10625 @end table
10626
10627 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10628 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10629 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10630 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10631 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10632 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10633 to you to figure out, I think.
10634
10635 @node Security
10636 @section Security
10637
10638 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10639 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10640 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10641 things to work:
10642
10643 @enumerate
10644 @item
10645 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10646 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10647 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10648 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10649
10650 @item
10651 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10652 or newer is recommended.
10653
10654 @end enumerate
10655
10656 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10657 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10658
10659 @table @code
10660 @item mm-verify-option
10661 @vindex mm-verify-option
10662 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10663 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10664 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10665
10666 @item mm-decrypt-option
10667 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10668 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10669 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10670 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10671
10672 @item mml1991-use
10673 @vindex mml1991-use
10674 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10675 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10676 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10677 deprecated.
10678
10679 @item mml2015-use
10680 @vindex mml2015-use
10681 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10682 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10683 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10684 deprecated.
10685
10686 @end table
10687
10688 @cindex snarfing keys
10689 @cindex importing PGP keys
10690 @cindex PGP key ring import
10691 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10692 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10693 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10694 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10695 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10696 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10697 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10698 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10699 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10700
10701 @example
10702 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10703 @end example
10704 @noindent
10705 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10706 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10707
10708 @node Mailing List
10709 @section Mailing List
10710 @cindex mailing list
10711 @cindex RFC 2396
10712
10713 @kindex A M (summary)
10714 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10715 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10716 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10717 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10718 summary buffer.
10719
10720 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10721
10722 @table @kbd
10723
10724 @item C-c C-n h
10725 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10726 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10727 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10728
10729 @item C-c C-n s
10730 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10731 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10732 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10733
10734 @item C-c C-n u
10735 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10736 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10737 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10738 field exists.
10739
10740 @item C-c C-n p
10741 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10742 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10743 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10744
10745 @item C-c C-n o
10746 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10747 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10748 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10749
10750 @item C-c C-n a
10751 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10752 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10753 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10754
10755 @end table
10756
10757
10758 @node Article Buffer
10759 @chapter Article Buffer
10760 @cindex article buffer
10761
10762 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10763 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10764 tell Gnus otherwise.
10765
10766 @menu
10767 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10768 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10769 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10770 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10771 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10772 @end menu
10773
10774
10775 @node Hiding Headers
10776 @section Hiding Headers
10777 @cindex hiding headers
10778 @cindex deleting headers
10779
10780 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10781 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10782
10783 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10784 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10785 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10786 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10787 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10788 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10789 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10790 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10791 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10792
10793 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10794
10795 @table @code
10796
10797 @item gnus-visible-headers
10798 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10799 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10800 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10801 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10802
10803 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10804 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10805
10806 @lisp
10807 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10808 @end lisp
10809
10810 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10811 remain visible.
10812
10813 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10814 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10815 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10816 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10817 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10818 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10819
10820 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10821 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10822
10823 @lisp
10824 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10825 @end lisp
10826
10827 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10828 be removed.
10829
10830 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10831 variable will have no effect.
10832
10833 @end table
10834
10835 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10836 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10837 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10838 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10839 the headers are to be displayed.
10840
10841 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10842 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10843
10844 @lisp
10845 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10846 @end lisp
10847
10848 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10849 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10850
10851 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10852 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10853 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10854 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10855 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10856 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10857 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10858 from sight.
10859
10860 These conditions are:
10861 @table @code
10862 @item empty
10863 Remove all empty headers.
10864 @item followup-to
10865 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10866 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10867 @item reply-to
10868 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10869 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10870 parameter is set.
10871 @item newsgroups
10872 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10873 name.
10874 @item to-address
10875 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10876 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10877 @item to-list
10878 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10879 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10880 @item cc-list
10881 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10882 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10883 @item date
10884 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10885 old.
10886 @item long-to
10887 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10888 @item many-to
10889 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10890 @end table
10891
10892 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10893
10894 @lisp
10895 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10896 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10897 @end lisp
10898
10899 This is also the default value for this variable.
10900
10901
10902 @node Using MIME
10903 @section Using MIME
10904 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10905
10906 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10907 while people stand around yawning.
10908
10909 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10910 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10911
10912 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10913 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10914 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10915
10916 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10917 @findex gnus-display-mime
10918 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10919 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10920 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10921 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10922
10923 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10924 @acronym{MIME} button:
10925
10926 @table @kbd
10927 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10928 @item RET (Article)
10929 @kindex RET (Article)
10930 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10931 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10932 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10933 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10934 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10935 object is displayed inline.
10936
10937 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10938 @item M-RET (Article)
10939 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10940 @itemx v (Article)
10941 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10942 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10943
10944 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10945 @item t (Article)
10946 @kindex t (Article)
10947 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10948 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10949
10950 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10951 @item C (Article)
10952 @kindex C (Article)
10953 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10954 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10955
10956 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10957 @item o (Article)
10958 @kindex o (Article)
10959 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10960 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10961
10962 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10963 @item C-o (Article)
10964 @kindex C-o (Article)
10965 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10966 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10967 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10968 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10969 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10970 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10971
10972 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10973 @item d (Article)
10974 @kindex d (Article)
10975 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10976 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10977 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10978
10979 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10980 @item c (Article)
10981 @kindex c (Article)
10982 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10983 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10984 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10985 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10986 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10987
10988 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10989 @item p (Article)
10990 @kindex p (Article)
10991 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10992 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10993 @file{.mailcap} file.
10994
10995 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10996 @item i (Article)
10997 @kindex i (Article)
10998 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10999 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11000 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11001 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11002 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11003 Article}).
11004
11005 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11006 @item E (Article)
11007 @kindex E (Article)
11008 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11009 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11010 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11011
11012 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11013 @item e (Article)
11014 @kindex e (Article)
11015 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11016 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11017
11018 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11019 @item | (Article)
11020 @kindex | (Article)
11021 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11022
11023 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11024 @item . (Article)
11025 @kindex . (Article)
11026 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11027 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11028
11029 @end table
11030
11031 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11032 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11033 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11034
11035 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11036 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11037 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11038 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11039 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11040 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11041 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11042 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11043 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11044
11045 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11046
11047 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11048
11049
11050 @node Customizing Articles
11051 @section Customizing Articles
11052 @cindex article customization
11053
11054 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11055 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11056 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11057 called automatically when you select the articles.
11058
11059 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11060 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11061 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11062 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11063
11064 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11065 for sensible values.
11066
11067 @enumerate
11068 @item
11069 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11070
11071 @item
11072 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11073
11074 @item
11075 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11076
11077 @item
11078 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11079
11080 @item
11081 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11082 than this number.
11083
11084 @item
11085 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11086 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11087 regexps in the list.
11088
11089 @item
11090 A list where the first element is not a string:
11091
11092 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11093 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11094 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11095
11096 @lisp
11097 (or last
11098 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11099 @end lisp
11100
11101 @end enumerate
11102
11103 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11104 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11105 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11106 considered to contain just a single part.
11107
11108 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11109 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11110 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11111 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11112 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11113 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11114 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11115
11116 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11117 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11118 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11119 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11120
11121 @table @code
11122 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11123 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11124
11125 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11126
11127 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11128 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11129 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11130 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11131 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11132 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11133 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11134 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11135 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11136 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11137
11138 @xref{Article Washing}.
11139
11140 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11141 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11142 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11143 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11144 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11145 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11146 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11147
11148 @xref{Article Date}.
11149
11150 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11151 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11152 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11153
11154 @xref{Picons}.
11155
11156 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11157
11158 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11159
11160 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11161 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11162 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11163
11164 @xref{Smileys}.
11165
11166 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11167
11168 @xref{X-Face}.
11169
11170 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11171
11172 @xref{Face}.
11173
11174 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11175 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11176 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11177 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11178 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11179 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11180 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11181 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11182 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11183 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11184
11185 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11186
11187 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11188 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11189 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11190
11191 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11192
11193 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11194 @item gnus-treat-translate
11195 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11196
11197 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11198 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11199 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11200 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11201
11202 @xref{Article Header}.
11203
11204
11205 @end table
11206
11207 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11208 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11209 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11210 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11211 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11212 everything.
11213
11214
11215 @node Article Keymap
11216 @section Article Keymap
11217
11218 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11219 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11220 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11221 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11222 buffer.
11223
11224 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11225
11226 @table @kbd
11227
11228 @item SPACE
11229 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11230 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11231 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11232 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11233
11234 @item DEL
11235 @kindex DEL (Article)
11236 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11237 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11238 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11239
11240 @item C-c ^
11241 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11242 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11243 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11244 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11245 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11246
11247 @item C-c C-m
11248 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11249 @findex gnus-article-mail
11250 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11251 given a prefix, include the mail.
11252
11253 @item s
11254 @kindex s (Article)
11255 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11256 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11257 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11258
11259 @item ?
11260 @kindex ? (Article)
11261 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11262 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11263 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11264
11265 @item TAB
11266 @kindex TAB (Article)
11267 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11268 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11269 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11270
11271 @item M-TAB
11272 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11273 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11274 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11275
11276 @item R
11277 @kindex R (Article)
11278 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11279 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11280 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11281 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11282 region.
11283
11284 @item F
11285 @kindex F (Article)
11286 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11287 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11288 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11289 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11290 region.
11291
11292
11293 @end table
11294
11295
11296 @node Misc Article
11297 @section Misc Article
11298
11299 @table @code
11300
11301 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11302 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11303 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11304 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11305 article buffer.
11306
11307 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11308 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11309 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11310 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11311 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11312
11313 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11314 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11315 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11316 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11317 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11318 the contents of the article buffer.
11319
11320 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11321 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11322 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11323
11324 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11325 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11326 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11327 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11328
11329 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11330 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11331 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11332 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11333
11334 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11335 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11336 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11337 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11338 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11339 with two extensions:
11340
11341 @table @samp
11342
11343 @item w
11344 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11345 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11346 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11347
11348 @table @samp
11349
11350 @item c
11351 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11352
11353 @item h
11354 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11355
11356 @item p
11357 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11358 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11359 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11360
11361 @item s
11362 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11363
11364 @item o
11365 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11366
11367 @item e
11368 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11369
11370 @end table
11371
11372 @item m
11373 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11374
11375 @end table
11376
11377 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11378
11379 @item gnus-break-pages
11380 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11381 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11382 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11383 paging will not be done.
11384
11385 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11386 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11387 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11388 (formfeed).
11389
11390 @cindex IDNA
11391 @cindex internationalized domain names
11392 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11393 @item gnus-use-idna
11394 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11395 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11396 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11397 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11398 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11399
11400 @end table
11401
11402
11403 @node Composing Messages
11404 @chapter Composing Messages
11405 @cindex composing messages
11406 @cindex messages
11407 @cindex mail
11408 @cindex sending mail
11409 @cindex reply
11410 @cindex followup
11411 @cindex post
11412 @cindex using gpg
11413 @cindex using s/mime
11414 @cindex using smime
11415
11416 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11417 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11418 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11419 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11420 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11421 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11422
11423 @menu
11424 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11425 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11426 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11427 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11428 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11429 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11430 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11431 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11432 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11433 @end menu
11434
11435 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11436 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11437
11438
11439 @node Mail
11440 @section Mail
11441
11442 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11443
11444 @table @code
11445 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11446 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11447 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11448 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11449 @code{nil} include all headers.
11450
11451 @item gnus-add-to-list
11452 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11453 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11454 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11455
11456 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11457 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11458 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11459 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11460 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11461 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11462 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11463 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11464
11465 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11466 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11467
11468 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11469 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11470 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11471 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11472 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11473
11474 @end table
11475
11476
11477 @node Posting Server
11478 @section Posting Server
11479
11480 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11481 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11482
11483 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11484
11485 It can be quite complicated.
11486
11487 @vindex gnus-post-method
11488 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11489 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11490 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11491 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11492 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11493 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11494 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11495 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11496 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11497
11498 @lisp
11499 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11500 @end lisp
11501
11502 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11503 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11504 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11505 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11506
11507 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11508 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11509
11510 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11511 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11512 for posting.
11513
11514 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11515 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11516
11517 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11518 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11519 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11520 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11521 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11522 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11523 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11524 package correctly. An example:
11525
11526 @lisp
11527 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11528 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11529 @end lisp
11530
11531 To the thing similar to this, there is
11532 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11533 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11534 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11535
11536 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11537 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11538 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11539
11540 @node POP before SMTP
11541 @section POP before SMTP
11542 @cindex pop before smtp
11543 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11544 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11545
11546 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11547 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11548 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11549 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11550 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11551
11552 @lisp
11553 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11554 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11555 @end lisp
11556
11557 @noindent
11558 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11559 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11560 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11561 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11562 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11563 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11564 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11565 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11566
11567 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11568 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11569 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11570 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11571 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11572 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11573
11574 @lisp
11575 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11576 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11577 :password "secret"))
11578 @end lisp
11579
11580 @noindent
11581 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11582 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11583
11584 @lisp
11585 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11586 (lambda ()
11587 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11588 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11589 :password "secret")))
11590 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11591 @end lisp
11592
11593 @node Mail and Post
11594 @section Mail and Post
11595
11596 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11597 posting:
11598
11599 @table @code
11600 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11601 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11602 @cindex mailing lists
11603
11604 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11605 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11606 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11607 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11608 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11609 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11610 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11611 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11612 still a pain, though.
11613
11614 @item gnus-user-agent
11615 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11616 @cindex User-Agent
11617
11618 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11619 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11620 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11621 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11622 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11623 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11624 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11625
11626 @end table
11627
11628 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11629 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11630 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11631
11632 @cindex ispell
11633 @findex ispell-message
11634 @lisp
11635 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11636 @end lisp
11637
11638 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11639 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11640
11641 @lisp
11642 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11643 (lambda ()
11644 (cond
11645 ((string-match
11646 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11647 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11648 (t
11649 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11650 @end lisp
11651
11652 Modify to suit your needs.
11653
11654
11655 @node Archived Messages
11656 @section Archived Messages
11657 @cindex archived messages
11658 @cindex sent messages
11659
11660 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11661 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11662 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11663 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11664 is the default.
11665
11666 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11667 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11668 Group Commands}).
11669
11670 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11671 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11672 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11673
11674 @lisp
11675 (nnfolder "archive"
11676 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11677 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11678 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11679 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11680 @end lisp
11681
11682 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11683 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11684 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11685 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11686
11687 @lisp
11688 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11689 '(nnfolder "archive"
11690 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11691 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11692 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11693 @end lisp
11694
11695 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11696 @cindex Gcc
11697 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11698 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11699 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11700
11701 This variable can be used to do the following:
11702
11703 @table @asis
11704 @item a string
11705 Messages will be saved in that group.
11706
11707 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11708 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11709 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11710 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11711 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11712 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11713 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11714 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11715 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11716
11717 @item a list of strings
11718 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11719
11720 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11721 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11722
11723 @item @code{nil}
11724 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11725 @end table
11726
11727 Let's illustrate:
11728
11729 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11730 @lisp
11731 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11732 @end lisp
11733
11734 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11735 @lisp
11736 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11737 @end lisp
11738
11739 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11740 @lisp
11741 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11742 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11743 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11744 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11745 @end lisp
11746
11747 More complex stuff:
11748 @lisp
11749 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11750 '((if (message-news-p)
11751 "misc-news"
11752 "misc-mail")))
11753 @end lisp
11754
11755 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11756 messages in one file per month:
11757
11758 @lisp
11759 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11760 '((if (message-news-p)
11761 "misc-news"
11762 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11763 @end lisp
11764
11765 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11766 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11767
11768 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11769 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11770 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11771 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11772 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11773 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11774 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11775 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11776 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11777 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11778
11779 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11780 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11781 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11782 this will disable archiving.
11783
11784 @table @code
11785 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11786 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11787 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11788 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11789 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11790 group names.
11791
11792 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11793 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11794 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11795 of names).
11796
11797 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11798 but the latter is the preferred method.
11799
11800 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11801 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11802 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11803
11804 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11805 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11806 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11807 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11808 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11809 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11810 changed in the future.
11811
11812 @end table
11813
11814
11815 @node Posting Styles
11816 @section Posting Styles
11817 @cindex posting styles
11818 @cindex styles
11819
11820 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11821
11822 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11823 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11824 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11825 on?
11826
11827 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11828 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11829 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11830 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11831 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11832 variable:
11833
11834 @lisp
11835 ((".*"
11836 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11837 (organization "What me?"))
11838 ("^comp"
11839 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11840 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11841 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11842 @end lisp
11843
11844 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11845 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11846 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11847 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11848 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11849 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11850 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11851 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11852
11853 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11854 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11855 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11856 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11857 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11858 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11859 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11860 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11861 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11862 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11863 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11864 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11865 said to @dfn{match}.
11866
11867 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11868 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11869 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11870 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11871 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11872 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11873 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11874 name can be one of:
11875
11876 @itemize @bullet
11877 @item @code{signature}
11878 @item @code{signature-file}
11879 @item @code{x-face-file}
11880 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11881 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11882 @item @code{body}
11883 @end itemize
11884
11885 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11886 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11887 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11888 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11889 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11890
11891 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11892 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11893 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11894 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11895 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11896 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11897 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11898 references chars lines xref extra.
11899
11900 @vindex message-reply-headers
11901
11902 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11903 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11904 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11905
11906 @findex message-mail-p
11907 @findex message-news-p
11908
11909 So here's a new example:
11910
11911 @lisp
11912 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11913 '((".*"
11914 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11915 (name "User Name")
11916 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11917 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11918 ("^rec.humor"
11919 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11920 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11921 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11922 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11923 (signature my-news-signature))
11924 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11925 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11926 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11927 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11928 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11929 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11930 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11931 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11932 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11933 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11934 ("nnml:.*"
11935 (From (save-excursion
11936 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11937 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11938 ("^nn.+:"
11939 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11940 @end lisp
11941
11942 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11943 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11944 if you fill many roles.
11945
11946
11947 @node Drafts
11948 @section Drafts
11949 @cindex drafts
11950
11951 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11952 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11953 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11954 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11955 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11956
11957 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11958 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11959 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11960 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11961 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11962 group.)
11963
11964 @cindex nndraft
11965 @vindex nndraft-directory
11966 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11967 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11968 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11969 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11970 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11971 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11972
11973 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11974 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11975 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11976 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11977 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11978 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11979 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11980 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11981 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11982
11983 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11984 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11985 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11986 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11987 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11988 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11989 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11990 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11991 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11992 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11993 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11994 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11995 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11996 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11997 @c
11998 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11999 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12000 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12001
12002 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12003 @kindex D e (Draft)
12004 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12005 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12006 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12007
12008 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12009 Articles}).
12010
12011 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12012 @kindex D s (Draft)
12013 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12014 @kindex D S (Draft)
12015 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12016 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12017 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12018 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12019 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12020 in the buffer.
12021
12022 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12023 @kindex D t (Draft)
12024 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12025 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12026 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12027
12028
12029 @node Rejected Articles
12030 @section Rejected Articles
12031 @cindex rejected articles
12032
12033 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12034 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12035 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12036 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12037
12038 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12039 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12040 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12041 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12042 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12043
12044 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12045 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12046 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12047
12048 @node Signing and encrypting
12049 @section Signing and encrypting
12050 @cindex using gpg
12051 @cindex using s/mime
12052 @cindex using smime
12053
12054 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12055 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12056 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12057 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12058
12059 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12060 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12061 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12062 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12063 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12064 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12065 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12066 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12067 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12068 automatically encrypted messages.
12069
12070 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12071 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12072 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12073
12074 @table @kbd
12075
12076 @item C-c C-m s s
12077 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12078 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12079
12080 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12081
12082 @item C-c C-m s o
12083 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12084 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12085
12086 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12087
12088 @item C-c C-m s p
12089 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12090 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12091
12092 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12093
12094 @item C-c C-m c s
12095 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12096 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12097
12098 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12099
12100 @item C-c C-m c o
12101 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12102 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12103
12104 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12105
12106 @item C-c C-m c p
12107 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12108 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12109
12110 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12111
12112 @item C-c C-m C-n
12113 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12114 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12115 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12116
12117 @end table
12118
12119 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12120
12121 @node Select Methods
12122 @chapter Select Methods
12123 @cindex foreign groups
12124 @cindex select methods
12125
12126 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12127 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12128 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12129 personal mail group.
12130
12131 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12132 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12133 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12134 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12135 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12136 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12137
12138 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12139 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12140
12141 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12142 group as.
12143
12144 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12145 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12146 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12147 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12148 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12149
12150 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12151
12152 @menu
12153 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12154 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12155 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12156 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12157 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12158 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12159 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12160 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12161 @end menu
12162
12163
12164 @node Server Buffer
12165 @section Server Buffer
12166
12167 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12168 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12169 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12170 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12171 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12172 back end represents a virtual server.
12173
12174 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12175 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12176 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12177 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12178
12179 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12180 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12181 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12182 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12183 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12184 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12185 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12186
12187 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12188 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12189
12190 @menu
12191 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12192 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12193 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12194 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12195 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12196 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12197 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12198 @end menu
12199
12200 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12201 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12202
12203
12204 @node Server Buffer Format
12205 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12206 @cindex server buffer format
12207
12208 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12209 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12210 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12211 variable, with some simple extensions:
12212
12213 @table @samp
12214
12215 @item h
12216 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12217
12218 @item n
12219 The name of this server.
12220
12221 @item w
12222 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12223
12224 @item s
12225 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12226
12227 @item a
12228 Whether this server is agentized.
12229 @end table
12230
12231 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12232 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12233 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12234 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12235
12236 @table @samp
12237 @item S
12238 Server name.
12239
12240 @item M
12241 Server method.
12242 @end table
12243
12244 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12245
12246
12247 @node Server Commands
12248 @subsection Server Commands
12249 @cindex server commands
12250
12251 @table @kbd
12252
12253 @item a
12254 @kindex a (Server)
12255 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12256 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12257
12258 @item e
12259 @kindex e (Server)
12260 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12261 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12262
12263 @item SPACE
12264 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12265 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12266 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12267
12268 @item q
12269 @kindex q (Server)
12270 @findex gnus-server-exit
12271 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12272
12273 @item k
12274 @kindex k (Server)
12275 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12276 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12277
12278 @item y
12279 @kindex y (Server)
12280 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12281 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12282
12283 @item c
12284 @kindex c (Server)
12285 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12286 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12287
12288 @item l
12289 @kindex l (Server)
12290 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12291 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12292
12293 @item s
12294 @kindex s (Server)
12295 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12296 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12297 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12298 servers.
12299
12300 @item g
12301 @kindex g (Server)
12302 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12303 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12304 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12305 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12306
12307 @end table
12308
12309
12310 @node Example Methods
12311 @subsection Example Methods
12312
12313 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12314
12315 @lisp
12316 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12317 @end lisp
12318
12319 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12320
12321 @lisp
12322 (nnspool "")
12323 @end lisp
12324
12325 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12326 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12327 will.
12328
12329 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12330 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12331
12332 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12333 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12334 look like then:
12335
12336 @lisp
12337 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12338 @end lisp
12339
12340 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12341 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12342
12343 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12344 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12345 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12346 your private mail:
12347
12348 @lisp
12349 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12350 @end lisp
12351
12352 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12353 that.)
12354
12355 Here's the method for a public spool:
12356
12357 @lisp
12358 (nnmh "public"
12359 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12360 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12361 @end lisp
12362
12363 @cindex proxy
12364 @cindex firewall
12365
12366 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12367 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12368 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12369 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12370 should probably look something like this:
12371
12372 @lisp
12373 (nntp "firewall"
12374 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12375 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12376 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12377 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12378 @end lisp
12379
12380 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12381 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12382 configuration to the example above:
12383
12384 @lisp
12385 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12386 @end lisp
12387
12388 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12389
12390 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12391 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12392 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12393
12394 @lisp
12395 (nntp "outside"
12396 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12397 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12398 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12399 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12400 @end lisp
12401
12402 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12403 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12404 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12405 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12406
12407
12408 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12409 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12410
12411 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12412 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12413
12414 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12415 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12416 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12417
12418 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12419
12420 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12421 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12422 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12423 will contain the following:
12424
12425 @lisp
12426 (nnml "cache")
12427 @end lisp
12428
12429 Change that to:
12430
12431 @lisp
12432 (nnml "cache"
12433 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12434 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12435 @end lisp
12436
12437 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12438 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12439 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12440
12441
12442 @node Server Variables
12443 @subsection Server Variables
12444 @cindex server variables
12445 @cindex server parameters
12446
12447 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12448 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12449 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12450 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12451 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12452
12453 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12454 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12455 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12456 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12457 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12458 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12459 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12460 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12461 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12462
12463 @lisp
12464 (nnml "public"
12465 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12466 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12467 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12468 @end lisp
12469
12470 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12471
12472 @node Servers and Methods
12473 @subsection Servers and Methods
12474
12475 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12476 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12477 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12478 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12479 over.
12480
12481
12482 @node Unavailable Servers
12483 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12484
12485 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12486 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12487 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12488 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12489 actually the case or not.
12490
12491 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12492 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12493 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12494 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12495 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12496 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12497 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12498 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12499
12500 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12501 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12502
12503 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12504 with the following commands:
12505
12506 @table @kbd
12507
12508 @item O
12509 @kindex O (Server)
12510 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12511 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12512 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12513
12514 @item C
12515 @kindex C (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12517 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12518 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12519
12520 @item D
12521 @kindex D (Server)
12522 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12523 Mark the current server as unreachable
12524 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12525
12526 @item M-o
12527 @kindex M-o (Server)
12528 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12529 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12530 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12531
12532 @item M-c
12533 @kindex M-c (Server)
12534 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12535 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12536 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12537
12538 @item R
12539 @kindex R (Server)
12540 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12541 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12542 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12543
12544 @item L
12545 @kindex L (Server)
12546 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12547 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12548
12549 @end table
12550
12551
12552 @node Getting News
12553 @section Getting News
12554 @cindex reading news
12555 @cindex news back ends
12556
12557 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12558 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12559 or it can read from a local spool.
12560
12561 @menu
12562 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12563 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12564 @end menu
12565
12566
12567 @node NNTP
12568 @subsection NNTP
12569 @cindex nntp
12570
12571 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12572 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12573 server as the, uhm, address.
12574
12575 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12576 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12577 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12578 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12579
12580 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12581 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12582 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12583
12584 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12585 server:
12586
12587 @table @code
12588
12589 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12590 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12591 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12592 @cindex authinfo
12593 @cindex authentification
12594 @cindex nntp authentification
12595 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12596 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12597 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12598 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12599 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12600 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12601 present in this hook.
12602
12603 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12604 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12605 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12606 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12607 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12608 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12609 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12610 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12611 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12612 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12613 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12614 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12615
12616 @enumerate
12617 @item
12618 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12619
12620 @item
12621 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12622
12623 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12624 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12625 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12626 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12627 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12628 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12629 @samp{force} is explained below.
12630
12631 @end enumerate
12632
12633 Here's an example file:
12634
12635 @example
12636 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12637 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12638 @end example
12639
12640 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12641 have to be first, for instance.
12642
12643 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12644 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12645 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12646 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12647 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12648 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12649 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12650
12651 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12652 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12653
12654 @example
12655 default force yes
12656 @end example
12657
12658 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12659 previously mentioned.
12660
12661 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12662
12663 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12664 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12665 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12666 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12667 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12668
12669 @lisp
12670 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12671 '(("innd" (ding))))
12672 @end lisp
12673
12674 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12675
12676 The default value is
12677
12678 @lisp
12679 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12680 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12681 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12682 @end lisp
12683
12684 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12685 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12686
12687 @item nntp-maximum-request
12688 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12689 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12690 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12691 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12692 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12693 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12694 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12695
12696 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12697 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12698 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12699 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12700 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12701 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12702 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12703 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12704 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12705 no timeouts are done.
12706
12707 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12708 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12709 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12710 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12711 can be used.
12712
12713 @item nntp-xover-commands
12714 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12715 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12716 @cindex XOVER
12717 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12718 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12719 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12720
12721 @item nntp-nov-gap
12722 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12723 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12724 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12725 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12726 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12727 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12728 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12729 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12730 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12731 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12732 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12733
12734 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12735 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12736 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12737
12738 @item nntp-record-commands
12739 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12740 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12741 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12742 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12743 that doesn't seem to work.
12744
12745 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12746 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12747 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12748 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12749 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12750 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12751 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12752 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12753
12754 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12755 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12756 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12757 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12758 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12759 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12760 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12761
12762 @lisp
12763 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12764 @end lisp
12765
12766 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12767 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12768
12769 @end table
12770
12771 @menu
12772 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12773 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12774 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12775 @end menu
12776
12777
12778 @node Direct Functions
12779 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12780 @cindex direct connection functions
12781
12782 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12783 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12784 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12785 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12786
12787 @table @code
12788 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12789 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12790 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12791 remote system.
12792
12793 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12794 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12795 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12796 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12797 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12798
12799 @lisp
12800 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12801 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12802 ;;
12803 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12804 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12805 (nntp-port-number )
12806 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12807 @end lisp
12808
12809 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12810 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12811 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12812 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12813 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12814 then define a server as follows:
12815
12816 @lisp
12817 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12818 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12819 ;;
12820 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12821 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12822 (nntp-port-number 563)
12823 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12824 @end lisp
12825
12826 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12827 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12828 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12829 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12830 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12831 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12832 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12833 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12834
12835 @lisp
12836 (nntp "socksified"
12837 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12838 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12839 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12840 @end lisp
12841
12842 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12843 session, which is not a good idea.
12844 @end table
12845
12846
12847 @node Indirect Functions
12848 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12849 @cindex indirect connection functions
12850
12851 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12852 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12853 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12854 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12855 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12856 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12857
12858 @table @code
12859 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12860 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12861 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12862 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12863 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12864
12865 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12866
12867 @table @code
12868 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12869 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12870 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12871 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12872
12873 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12874 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12875 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12876 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12877 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12878 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12879 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12880 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12881 host.
12882 @end table
12883
12884 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12885 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12886 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12887 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12888
12889 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12890
12891 @table @code
12892 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12893 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12894 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12895 @samp{telnet}.
12896
12897 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12898 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12899 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12900 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12901
12902 @item nntp-via-user-password
12903 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12904 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12905
12906 @item nntp-via-envuser
12907 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12908 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12909 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12910 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12911
12912 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12913 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12914 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12915 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12916
12917 @end table
12918
12919 @end table
12920
12921
12922 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12923 functions:
12924
12925 @table @code
12926
12927 @item nntp-via-user-name
12928 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12929 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12930
12931 @item nntp-via-address
12932 @vindex nntp-via-address
12933 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12934
12935 @end table
12936
12937
12938 @node Common Variables
12939 @subsubsection Common Variables
12940
12941 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12942 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12943 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
12944 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
12945 variables individually).
12946
12947 @table @code
12948
12949 @item nntp-pre-command
12950 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12951 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12952 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12953 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
12954 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12955
12956 @item nntp-address
12957 @vindex nntp-address
12958 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12959
12960 @item nntp-port-number
12961 @vindex nntp-port-number
12962 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12963 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12964 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12965 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12966 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12967 not work with named ports.
12968
12969 @item nntp-end-of-line
12970 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12971 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12972 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12973 using a non native connection function.
12974
12975 @item nntp-telnet-command
12976 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12977 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12978 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12979 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12980 @samp{telnet}.
12981
12982 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12983 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12984 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12985 is @samp{("-8")}.
12986
12987 @end table
12988
12989
12990 @node News Spool
12991 @subsection News Spool
12992 @cindex nnspool
12993 @cindex news spool
12994
12995 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
12996 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
12997 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
12998 instance.
12999
13000 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13001 anything else) as the address.
13002
13003 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13004 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13005 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13006 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13007
13008 @table @code
13009
13010 @item nnspool-inews-program
13011 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13012 Program used to post an article.
13013
13014 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13015 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13016 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13017
13018 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13019 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13020 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13021 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13022
13023 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13024 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13025 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13026 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13027
13028 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13029 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13030 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13031
13032 @item nnspool-active-file
13033 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13034 The name of the active file.
13035
13036 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13037 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13038 The name of the group descriptions file.
13039
13040 @item nnspool-history-file
13041 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13042 The name of the news history file.
13043
13044 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13045 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13046 The name of the active date file.
13047
13048 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13049 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13050 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13051 that it finds.
13052
13053 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13054 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13055 @cindex sed
13056 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13057 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13058 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13059 there.
13060
13061 @end table
13062
13063
13064 @node Getting Mail
13065 @section Getting Mail
13066 @cindex reading mail
13067 @cindex mail
13068
13069 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13070 course.
13071
13072 @menu
13073 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13074 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13075 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13076 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13077 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13078 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13079 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13080 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13081 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13082 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13083 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13084 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13085 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13086 @end menu
13087
13088
13089 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13090 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13091
13092 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13093 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13094 of a culture shock.
13095
13096 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13097 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13098
13099 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13100 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13101 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13102 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13103
13104 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13105
13106 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13107 deleted? How awful!
13108
13109 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13110 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13111 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13112 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13113 Mail}.
13114
13115 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13116 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13117 they want to treat a message.
13118
13119 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13120 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13121 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13122 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13123 archived somewhere else.
13124
13125 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13126 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13127 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13128 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13129 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13130
13131 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13132 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13133 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13134
13135 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13136 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13137 differently.
13138
13139 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13140 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13141 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13142 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13143 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13144
13145 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13146 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13147 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13148 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13149 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13150 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13151 You Do.)
13152
13153
13154 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13155 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13156
13157 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13158 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13159 and things will happen automatically.
13160
13161 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13162 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13163
13164 @lisp
13165 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13166 @end lisp
13167
13168 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13169 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13170 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13171 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13172 like any other group.
13173
13174 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13175
13176 @lisp
13177 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13178 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13179 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13180 ("other" "")))
13181 @end lisp
13182
13183 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13184 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13185 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13186 last group.
13187
13188 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13189 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13190 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13191
13192
13193 @node Splitting Mail
13194 @subsection Splitting Mail
13195 @cindex splitting mail
13196 @cindex mail splitting
13197 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13198
13199 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13200 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13201 to be split into groups.
13202
13203 @lisp
13204 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13205 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13206 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13207 ("mail.other" "")))
13208 @end lisp
13209
13210 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13211 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13212 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13213 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13214 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13215 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13216 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13217
13218 @lisp
13219 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13220 @end lisp
13221
13222 @noindent
13223 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13224 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13225
13226 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13227 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13228 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13229 mail belongs in that group.
13230
13231 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13232 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13233 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13234 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13235 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13236 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13237 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13238 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13239 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13240 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13241
13242 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13243 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13244 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13245 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13246 thinks should carry this mail message.
13247
13248 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13249 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13250 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13251 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13252
13253 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13254 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13255 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13256 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13257 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13258
13259 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13260 @cindex crosspost
13261 @cindex links
13262 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13263 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13264 links. If that's the case for you, set
13265 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13266 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13267
13268 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13269 @findex nnmail-split-history
13270 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13271 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13272 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13273 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13274 Group Commands}).
13275
13276 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13277 Header lines longer than the value of
13278 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13279 function.
13280
13281 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13282 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13283 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13284 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13285 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13286 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13287 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13288 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13289
13290 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13291 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13292 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13293 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13294 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13295 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13296 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13297 other kinds of entries.)
13298
13299 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13300 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13301 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13302 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13303 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13304 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13305 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13306 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13307 month's rent money.
13308
13309
13310 @node Mail Sources
13311 @subsection Mail Sources
13312
13313 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13314 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13315 maildir, for instance.
13316
13317 @menu
13318 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13319 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13320 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13321 @end menu
13322
13323
13324 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13325 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13326 @cindex POP
13327 @cindex mail server
13328 @cindex procmail
13329 @cindex mail spool
13330 @cindex mail source
13331
13332 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13333 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13334
13335 Here's an example:
13336
13337 @lisp
13338 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13339 @end lisp
13340
13341 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13342 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13343 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13344 default values.
13345
13346 The following mail source types are available:
13347
13348 @table @code
13349 @item file
13350 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13351
13352 Keywords:
13353
13354 @table @code
13355 @item :path
13356 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13357 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13358 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13359
13360 @item :prescript
13361 @itemx :postscript
13362 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13363 @end table
13364
13365 An example file mail source:
13366
13367 @lisp
13368 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13369 @end lisp
13370
13371 Or using the default file name:
13372
13373 @lisp
13374 (file)
13375 @end lisp
13376
13377 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13378 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13379 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13380 mail spool while moving the mail.
13381
13382 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13383
13384 @lisp
13385 (setq mail-sources
13386 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13387 @end lisp
13388
13389 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13390
13391 @example
13392 #!/bin/sh
13393 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13394 # flu@@iki.fi
13395
13396 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13397 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13398 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13399 @end example
13400
13401 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13402
13403
13404 @item directory
13405 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13406 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13407 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13408 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13409 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13410 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13411 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13412 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13413 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13414 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13415
13416 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13417 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13418 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13419 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13420
13421 Keywords:
13422
13423 @table @code
13424 @item :path
13425 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13426 value.
13427
13428 @item :suffix
13429 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13430 @samp{.spool}.
13431
13432 @item :predicate
13433 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13434 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13435 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13436 predicate are considered.
13437
13438 @item :prescript
13439 @itemx :postscript
13440 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13441
13442 @end table
13443
13444 An example directory mail source:
13445
13446 @lisp
13447 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13448 :suffix ".prcml")
13449 @end lisp
13450
13451 @item pop
13452 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13453
13454 Keywords:
13455
13456 @table @code
13457 @item :server
13458 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13459 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13460
13461 @item :port
13462 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13463 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13464 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13465 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13466 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13467
13468 @item :user
13469 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13470 name.
13471
13472 @item :password
13473 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13474 the user is prompted.
13475
13476 @item :program
13477 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13478 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13479
13480 @example
13481 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13482 @end example
13483
13484 The valid format specifier characters are:
13485
13486 @table @samp
13487 @item t
13488 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13489 included in this string.
13490
13491 @item s
13492 The name of the server.
13493
13494 @item P
13495 The port number of the server.
13496
13497 @item u
13498 The user name to use.
13499
13500 @item p
13501 The password to use.
13502 @end table
13503
13504 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13505 corresponding keywords.
13506
13507 @item :prescript
13508 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13509 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13510
13511 @item :postscript
13512 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13513 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13514
13515 @item :function
13516 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13517 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13518 mail should be moved to.
13519
13520 @item :authentication
13521 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13522 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13523 @code{password}.
13524
13525 @end table
13526
13527 @vindex pop3-movemail
13528 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13529 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13530 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13531 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13532 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13533 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13534 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13535 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13536 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13537
13538 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13539 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13540
13541 @lisp
13542 (pop)
13543 @end lisp
13544
13545 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13546
13547 @lisp
13548 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13549 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13550 @end lisp
13551
13552 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13553
13554 @lisp
13555 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13556 @end lisp
13557
13558 @item maildir
13559 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13560 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13561 contains exactly one mail.
13562
13563 Keywords:
13564
13565 @table @code
13566 @item :path
13567 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13568 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13569 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13570 @item :subdirs
13571 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13572 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13573
13574 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13575 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13576 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13577 @c below.
13578
13579 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13580 from locking problems).
13581
13582 @end table
13583
13584 Two example maildir mail sources:
13585
13586 @lisp
13587 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13588 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13589 @end lisp
13590
13591 @lisp
13592 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13593 :subdirs ("new"))
13594 @end lisp
13595
13596 @item imap
13597 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13598 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13599 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13600 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13601 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13602
13603 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13604 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13605
13606 Keywords:
13607
13608 @table @code
13609 @item :server
13610 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13611 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13612
13613 @item :port
13614 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13615 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13616
13617 @item :user
13618 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13619 name.
13620
13621 @item :password
13622 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13623 prompted.
13624
13625 @item :stream
13626 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13627 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13628 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13629 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13630
13631 @item :authentication
13632 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13633 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13634 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13635 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13636
13637 @item :program
13638 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13639 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13640 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13641
13642 @example
13643 ssh %s imapd
13644 @end example
13645
13646 The valid format specifier characters are:
13647
13648 @table @samp
13649 @item s
13650 The name of the server.
13651
13652 @item l
13653 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13654
13655 @item p
13656 The port number of the server.
13657 @end table
13658
13659 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13660 corresponding keywords.
13661
13662 @item :mailbox
13663 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13664 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13665
13666 @item :predicate
13667 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13668 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13669 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13670 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13671 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13672 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13673
13674 @item :fetchflag
13675 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13676 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13677 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13678 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13679
13680 @item :dontexpunge
13681 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13682 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13683
13684 @end table
13685
13686 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13687
13688 @lisp
13689 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13690 :stream kerberos4
13691 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13692 @end lisp
13693
13694 @item webmail
13695 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13696 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13697 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13698
13699 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13700 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13701
13702 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13703
13704 Keywords:
13705
13706 @table @code
13707 @item :subtype
13708 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13709 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13710
13711 @item :user
13712 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13713 name.
13714
13715 @item :password
13716 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13717 prompted.
13718
13719 @item :dontexpunge
13720 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13721 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13722
13723 @end table
13724
13725 An example webmail source:
13726
13727 @lisp
13728 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13729 :user "user-name"
13730 :password "secret")
13731 @end lisp
13732 @end table
13733
13734 @table @dfn
13735 @item Common Keywords
13736 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13737
13738 Keywords:
13739
13740 @table @code
13741 @item :plugged
13742 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13743 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13744 example:
13745
13746 @lisp
13747 (setq mail-sources
13748 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13749 :suffix ""
13750 :plugged t)))
13751 @end lisp
13752
13753 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13754 useful when you use local mail and news.
13755
13756 @end table
13757 @end table
13758
13759 @subsubsection Function Interface
13760
13761 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13762 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13763 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13764 consider the following mail-source setting:
13765
13766 @lisp
13767 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13768 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13769 @end lisp
13770
13771 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13772 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13773 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13774 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13775 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13776
13777 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13778
13779
13780 @node Mail Source Customization
13781 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13782
13783 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13784 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13785 variables.
13786
13787 @table @code
13788 @item mail-source-crash-box
13789 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13790 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13791 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13792
13793 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13794 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13795 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13796 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13797 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13798 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13799 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13800 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13801
13802 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13803 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13804 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13805 files. This variable only applies when
13806 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13807
13808 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13809 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13810 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13811
13812 @item mail-source-directory
13813 @vindex mail-source-directory
13814 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13815 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13816 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13817 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13818
13819 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13820 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13821 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13822 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13823 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13824 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13825 number.
13826
13827 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13828 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13829 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13830
13831 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13832 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13833 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13834 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13835
13836 @end table
13837
13838
13839 @node Fetching Mail
13840 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13841
13842 @vindex mail-sources
13843 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13844 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13845 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13846 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13847
13848 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13849 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13850 themselves.
13851
13852 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13853 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13854
13855 @lisp
13856 (setq mail-sources
13857 '((file)
13858 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13859 :password "secret")))
13860 @end lisp
13861
13862 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13863
13864 @lisp
13865 (setq mail-sources
13866 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13867 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13868 :user "user-name"
13869 :port "pop3"
13870 :password "secret")))
13871 @end lisp
13872
13873
13874 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13875 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13876 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13877 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13878 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13879 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13880
13881
13882
13883 @node Mail Back End Variables
13884 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13885
13886 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13887 mail back ends.
13888
13889 @table @code
13890 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13891 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13892 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13893 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13894
13895 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13896 @item nnmail-split-hook
13897 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13898 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13899 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13900 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13901 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13902 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13903 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13904 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13905 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13906 to this hook.
13907
13908 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13909 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13910 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13911 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13912 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13913 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13914 starting to handle the new mail) and
13915 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13916 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13917 default file modes the new mail files get:
13918
13919 @lisp
13920 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13921 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13922
13923 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13924 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13925 @end lisp
13926
13927 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13928 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13929 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13930 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13931 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13932 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13933 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13934
13935 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13936 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13937 @findex delete-file
13938 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13939
13940 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13941 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13942 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13943 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13944 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13945
13946 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13947 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13948 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13949 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13950 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13951
13952 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13953 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13954 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13955
13956 @end table
13957
13958
13959 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13960 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13961 @cindex mail splitting
13962 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13963
13964 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13965 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13966 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13967 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13968 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13969 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13970
13971 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13972
13973 @lisp
13974 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13975 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13976 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13977 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13978 "mail.misc"))
13979 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13980 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13981 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13982 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13983 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13984 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13985 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13986 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13987 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13988 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13989 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13990 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
13991 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13992 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
13993 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
13994 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
13995 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
13996 "misc.misc")
13997 @end lisp
13998
13999 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14000 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14001 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14002
14003 @table @code
14004
14005 @item group
14006 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14007 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14008
14009 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
14010 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
14011 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
14012 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
14013 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
14014 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
14015 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
14016
14017 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14018 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14019 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14020 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14021 stored in one or more groups.
14022
14023 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14024 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14025 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14026
14027 @item junk
14028 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14029 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14030
14031 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14032 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14033 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14034 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14035
14036 @cindex body split
14037 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14038 body of the messages:
14039
14040 @lisp
14041 (defun split-on-body ()
14042 (save-excursion
14043 (save-restriction
14044 (widen)
14045 (goto-char (point-min))
14046 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14047 "string.group"))))
14048 @end lisp
14049
14050 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14051 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14052 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14053 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14054 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14055 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14056 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14057
14058 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14059 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14060 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14061 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14062 should return a split.
14063
14064 @item nil
14065 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14066
14067 @end table
14068
14069 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14070 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14071 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14072 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14073 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14074
14075 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14076 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14077 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14078 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14079 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14080 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14081 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14082
14083 @table @code
14084 @item from
14085 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14086 @item to
14087 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14088 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14089 @item any
14090 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14091 @end table
14092
14093 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14094 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14095 when all this splitting is performed.
14096
14097 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14098 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14099 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14100
14101 @example
14102 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14103 @end example
14104
14105 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14106 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14107
14108 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14109 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14110 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14111 groupings 1 through 9.
14112
14113 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14114 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14115 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14116 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14117 groups when users send to an address using different case
14118 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14119 is @code{t}.
14120
14121 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14122 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14123 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14124
14125 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14126 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14127 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14128 surrounded by anything.
14129
14130 @example
14131 (any "joe" "joemail")
14132 @end example
14133
14134 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14135 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14136 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to @code{t},
14137 however, the match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word
14138 boundary is removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14139
14140 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14141 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14142 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14143 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14144 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14145 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14146 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14147 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14148 it once per thread.
14149
14150 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14151 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14152 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14153 using the colon feature, like so:
14154 @lisp
14155 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14156 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14157 nnmail-split-fancy
14158 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14159 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14160 ))
14161 @end lisp
14162
14163 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14164 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14165 in the file specified by the variable
14166 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14167 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14168 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14169 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14170 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14171 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14172 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14173 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14174 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14175 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14176 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14177 300 kBytes in size.)
14178 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14179 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14180 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14181 messages goes into the new group.
14182
14183 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14184 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14185 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14186 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14187 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14188 ``outgoing'' group.
14189
14190
14191 @node Group Mail Splitting
14192 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14193 @cindex mail splitting
14194 @cindex group mail splitting
14195
14196 @findex gnus-group-split
14197 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14198 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14199 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14200 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14201 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14202 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14203 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14204 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14205
14206 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14207 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14208 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14209 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14210
14211 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14212 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14213 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14214 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14215 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14216 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14217 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14218
14219 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14220 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14221 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14222 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14223 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14224 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14225 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14226
14227 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14228 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14229 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14230 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14231 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14232 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14233 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14234 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14235 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14236 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14237 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14238 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14239 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14240
14241 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14242 been defined:
14243
14244 @example
14245 nnml:mail.bar:
14246 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14247 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14248 nnml:mail.foo:
14249 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14250 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14251 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14252 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14253 nnml:mail.others:
14254 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14255 @end example
14256
14257 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14258 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14259 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14260
14261 @lisp
14262 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14263 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14264 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14265 "mail.others")
14266 @end lisp
14267
14268 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14269 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14270 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14271 splits like this:
14272
14273 @lisp
14274 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14275 @end lisp
14276
14277 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14278 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14279 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14280 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14281 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14282 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14283 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14284 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14285 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14286
14287 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14288 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14289 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14290 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14291 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14292 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14293 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14294 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14295 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14296
14297 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14298 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14299 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14300 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14301 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14302 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14303
14304 @lisp
14305 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14306 @end lisp
14307
14308 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14309 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14310 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14311 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14312 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14313 value.
14314
14315 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14316 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14317 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14318 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14319
14320 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14321 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14322 @cindex incorporating old mail
14323 @cindex import old mail
14324
14325 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14326 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14327 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14328 your mail groups.
14329
14330 Doing so can be quite easy.
14331
14332 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14333 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14334 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14335 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14336 your @code{nnml} groups.
14337
14338 Here's how:
14339
14340 @enumerate
14341 @item
14342 Go to the group buffer.
14343
14344 @item
14345 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14346 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14347
14348 @item
14349 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14350
14351 @item
14352 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14353 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14354
14355 @item
14356 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14357 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14358 @end enumerate
14359
14360 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14361 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14362 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14363 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14364 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14365
14366 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14367 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14368 using the new mail back end.
14369
14370
14371 @node Expiring Mail
14372 @subsection Expiring Mail
14373 @cindex article expiry
14374
14375 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14376 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14377 different approach to mail reading.
14378
14379 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14380 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14381 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14382 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14383 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14384 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14385 course.
14386
14387 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14388 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14389 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14390 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14391 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14392 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14393 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14394 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14395 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14396
14397 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14398 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14399 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14400 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14401 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14402 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14403 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14404 expirable.
14405
14406 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14407 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14408 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14409 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14410 into its own group.)
14411
14412 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14413 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14414 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14415 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14416 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14417 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14418 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14419 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14420 scoring.
14421
14422 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14423 Groups that match the regular expression
14424 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14425 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14426 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14427
14428 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14429 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14430 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14431 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14432 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14433
14434 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14435 @lisp
14436 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14437 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14438 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14439 @end lisp
14440
14441 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14442 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14443 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14444 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14445 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14446
14447 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14448 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14449
14450 @lisp
14451 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14452 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14453 @end lisp
14454
14455 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14456 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14457
14458 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14459 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14460 don't really mix very well.
14461
14462 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14463 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14464 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14465 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14466 days.
14467
14468 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14469 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14470 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14471 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14472 everywhere else:
14473
14474 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14475 @lisp
14476 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14477 (lambda (group)
14478 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14479 31)
14480 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14481 1)
14482 ((string= group "important")
14483 'never)
14484 (t
14485 6))))
14486 @end lisp
14487
14488 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14489 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14490
14491 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14492 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14493 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14494 @code{never}.
14495
14496 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14497 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14498
14499 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14500 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14501 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14502 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14503 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14504 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14505 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14506 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14507 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14508 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14509 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14510 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14511 name or @code{delete}.
14512
14513 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14514 @lisp
14515 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14516 @end lisp
14517
14518 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14519 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14520 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14521 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14522 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14523
14524 @lisp
14525 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14526 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14527 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14528 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14529 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14530 @end lisp
14531
14532 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14533 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14534 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14535 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14536 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14537 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14538
14539 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14540 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14541 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14542 easier for procmail users.
14543
14544 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14545 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14546 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14547 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14548 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14549 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14550 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14551 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14552 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14553 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14554 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14555 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14556 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14557 with! So there!
14558
14559 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14560
14561 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14562 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14563 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14564 auto-expire turned on.
14565
14566
14567 @node Washing Mail
14568 @subsection Washing Mail
14569 @cindex mail washing
14570 @cindex list server brain damage
14571 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14572
14573 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14574 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14575 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14576 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14577 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14578 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14579
14580 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14581 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14582 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14583 laugh.
14584
14585 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14586 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14587 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14588 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14589
14590 @table @code
14591 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14592 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14593 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14594 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14595 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14596
14597 @table @code
14598 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14599 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14600 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14601 Emacs running on MS machines.
14602
14603 @end table
14604
14605 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14606 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14607 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14608 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14609
14610 @table @code
14611 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14612 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14613 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14614 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14615
14616 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14617 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14618 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14619 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14620 into a feature by documenting it.)
14621
14622 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14623 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14624 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14625 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14626 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14627 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14628 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14629 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14630
14631 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14632 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14633
14634 @lisp
14635 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14636 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14637 @end lisp
14638
14639 This can also be done non-destructively with
14640 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14641
14642 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14643 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14644 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14645
14646 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14647 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14648 @cindex Eudora
14649 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14650 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14651 @code{References} headers.
14652
14653 @end table
14654
14655 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14656 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14657 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14658 include:
14659
14660 @table @code
14661 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14662 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14663 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14664
14665 @end table
14666 @end table
14667
14668
14669 @node Duplicates
14670 @subsection Duplicates
14671
14672 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14673 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14674 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14675 @cindex duplicate mails
14676 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14677 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14678 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14679 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14680 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14681 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14682 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14683 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14684 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14685 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14686 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14687 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14688 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14689
14690 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14691 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14692 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14693 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14694
14695 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14696 @code{nil}.
14697
14698 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14699 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14700 methods:
14701
14702 @lisp
14703 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14704 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14705 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14706 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14707 (any mail "mail.misc")
14708 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14709 [...] ))
14710 @end lisp
14711 @noindent
14712 Or something like:
14713 @lisp
14714 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14715 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14716 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14717 [...]))
14718 @end lisp
14719
14720 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14721 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14722 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14723 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14724 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14725
14726
14727 @node Not Reading Mail
14728 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14729
14730 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14731 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14732 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14733
14734 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14735 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14736 mail, which should help.
14737
14738 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14739 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14740 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14741 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14742 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14743 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14744 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14745 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14746 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14747 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14748 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14749
14750 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14751 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14752 incoming mail.
14753
14754
14755 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14756 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14757
14758 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14759 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14760 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14761
14762 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14763 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14764 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14765 Spool}).
14766
14767 @menu
14768 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14769 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14770 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14771 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14772 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14773 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14774 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14775 @end menu
14776
14777
14778 @node Unix Mail Box
14779 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14780 @cindex nnmbox
14781 @cindex unix mail box
14782
14783 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14784 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14785 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14786 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14787 which group it belongs in.
14788
14789 Virtual server settings:
14790
14791 @table @code
14792 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14793 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14794 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14795 @file{~/mbox}.
14796
14797 @item nnmbox-active-file
14798 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14799 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14800 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14801
14802 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14803 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14804 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14805 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14806 @end table
14807
14808
14809 @node Rmail Babyl
14810 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14811 @cindex nnbabyl
14812 @cindex Rmail mbox
14813
14814 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14815 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14816 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14817 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14818 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14819
14820 Virtual server settings:
14821
14822 @table @code
14823 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14824 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14825 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14826
14827 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14828 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14829 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14830 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14831
14832 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14833 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14834 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14835 @code{t}
14836 @end table
14837
14838
14839 @node Mail Spool
14840 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14841 @cindex nnml
14842 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14843
14844 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14845 format. It should be used with some caution.
14846
14847 @vindex nnml-directory
14848 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14849 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14850 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14851 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14852
14853 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14854 care of all that.
14855
14856 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14857 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14858 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14859 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14860 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14861 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14862 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14863 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14864
14865 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14866 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14867 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14868 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14869
14870 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14871 @cindex marks
14872 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14873 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14874 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14875 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14876 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14877 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14878 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14879 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14880 directory).
14881
14882 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14883 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14884 them next time it starts.
14885
14886 Virtual server settings:
14887
14888 @table @code
14889 @item nnml-directory
14890 @vindex nnml-directory
14891 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14892 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14893 is @file{~/Mail}).
14894
14895 @item nnml-active-file
14896 @vindex nnml-active-file
14897 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14898 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14899
14900 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14901 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14902 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14903 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14904
14905 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14906 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14907 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14908 @code{t}.
14909
14910 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14911 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14912 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14913 default is @code{nil}.
14914
14915 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14916 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14917 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14918
14919 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14920 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14921 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14922
14923 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14924 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14925 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14926 default is @code{nil}.
14927
14928 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14929 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14930 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14931
14932 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14933 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14934 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14935 files.
14936
14937 @end table
14938
14939 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14940 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14941 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14942 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14943 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14944 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14945 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14946 Commands}).
14947
14948
14949 @node MH Spool
14950 @subsubsection MH Spool
14951 @cindex nnmh
14952 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14953
14954 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14955 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14956 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14957 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14958 for.
14959
14960 Virtual server settings:
14961
14962 @table @code
14963 @item nnmh-directory
14964 @vindex nnmh-directory
14965 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14966 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14967 @file{~/Mail})
14968
14969 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14970 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14971 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14972 @code{t}.
14973
14974 @item nnmh-be-safe
14975 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14976 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14977 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14978 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14979 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14980 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14981 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14982 @end table
14983
14984
14985 @node Maildir
14986 @subsubsection Maildir
14987 @cindex nnmaildir
14988 @cindex maildir
14989
14990 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
14991 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
14992 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
14993 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
14994 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
14995 within a maildir.
14996
14997 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
14998 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
14999 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15000 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15001 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15002 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15003 that appear as group in Gnus.
15004
15005 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15006 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15007 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15008
15009 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15010 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15011 another, and you will keep your marks.
15012
15013 Virtual server settings:
15014
15015 @table @code
15016 @item directory
15017 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15018 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15019 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15020 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15021 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15022 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15023 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15024 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15025 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15026 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15027
15028 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15029 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15030 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15031 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15032 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15033 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15034 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15035 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15036 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15037 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15038 value.
15039
15040 @item target-prefix
15041 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15042 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15043 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15044 closed.
15045
15046 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15047 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15048 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15049 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15050 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15051 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15052 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15053 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15054 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15055
15056 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15057 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15058 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15059 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15060 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15061
15062 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15063 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15064 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15065 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15066 @code{force} argument.
15067
15068 @item directory-files
15069 This should be a function with the same interface as
15070 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15071 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15072 parameter is optional; the default is
15073 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15074 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15075 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15076 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15077 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15078 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15079
15080 @item get-new-mail
15081 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15082 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15083 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15084 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15085 value is @code{nil}.
15086
15087 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15088 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15089 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15090 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15091 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15092 @end table
15093
15094 @subsubsection Group parameters
15095
15096 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15097 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15098 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15099 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15100 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15101 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15102 another back end.
15103
15104 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15105 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15106 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15107 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15108 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15109 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15110 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15111 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15112 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15113
15114 @table @code
15115 @item expire-age
15116 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15117 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15118 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15119 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15120 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15121 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15122 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15123 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15124 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15125 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15126 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15127 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15128 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15129
15130 @item expire-group
15131 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15132 @example
15133 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15134 @end example
15135 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15136 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15137 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15138 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15139 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15140 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15141 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15142 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15143 article. So that form can refer to
15144 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15145 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15146 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15147 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15148
15149 @item read-only
15150 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15151 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15152 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15153 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15154 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15155 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15156 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15157 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15158 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15159 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15160 contain extra copies of the articles.
15161
15162 @item directory-files
15163 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15164 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15165 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15166 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15167
15168 @item distrust-Lines:
15169 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15170 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15171 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15172
15173 @item always-marks
15174 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15175 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15176 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15177 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15178 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15179 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15180
15181 @item never-marks
15182 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15183 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15184 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15185 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15186 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15187 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15188 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15189
15190 @item nov-cache-size
15191 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15192 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15193 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15194 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15195 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15196 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15197 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15198 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15199 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15200 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15201 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15202 @end table
15203
15204 @subsubsection Article identification
15205 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15206 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15207 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15208 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15209 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15210 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15211 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15212 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15213 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15214 request the article in the summary buffer.
15215
15216 @subsubsection NOV data
15217 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15218 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15219 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15220 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15221 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15222 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15223 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15224 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15225 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15226 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15227 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15228
15229 @subsubsection Article marks
15230 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15231 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15232 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15233 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15234 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15235 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15236 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15237 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15238
15239 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15240 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15241 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15242 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15243 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15244 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15245 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15246 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15247 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15248
15249
15250 @node Mail Folders
15251 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15252 @cindex nnfolder
15253 @cindex mbox folders
15254 @cindex mail folders
15255
15256 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15257 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15258 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15259 numbers and arrival dates.
15260
15261 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15262 @cindex marks
15263 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15264 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15265 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15266 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15267 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15268 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15269 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15270 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15271 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15272 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15273
15274 Virtual server settings:
15275
15276 @table @code
15277 @item nnfolder-directory
15278 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15279 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15280 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15281 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15282
15283 @item nnfolder-active-file
15284 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15285 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15286
15287 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15288 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15289 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15290 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15291
15292 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15293 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15294 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15295 default is @code{t}
15296
15297 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15298 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15299 @cindex backup files
15300 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15301 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15302 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15303 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15304
15305 @lisp
15306 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15307 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15308
15309 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15310 @end lisp
15311
15312 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15313 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15314 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15315 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15316 extract some information from it before removing it.
15317
15318 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15319 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15320 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15321 default is @code{nil}.
15322
15323 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15324 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15325 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15326
15327 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15328 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15329 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15330 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15331
15332 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15333 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15334 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15335 default is @code{nil}.
15336
15337 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15338 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15339 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15340
15341 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15342 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15343 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15344 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15345
15346 @end table
15347
15348
15349 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15350 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15351 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15352 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15353 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15354 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15355 though.
15356
15357 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15358 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15359
15360 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15361 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15362 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15363 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15364 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15365
15366 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15367 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15368 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15369 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15370 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15371 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15372 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15373 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15374 via NFS).
15375
15376 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15377 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15378 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15379 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15380
15381 @table @code
15382 @item nnmbox
15383
15384 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15385 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15386 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15387 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15388 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15389 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15390 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15391 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15392 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15393 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15394 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15395 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15396 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15397 what's where.
15398
15399 @item nnbabyl
15400
15401 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15402 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15403 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15404 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15405 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15406 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15407 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15408 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15409 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15410 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15411 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15412 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15413 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15414 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15415
15416 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15417 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15418 look at your mail.
15419
15420 @item nnml
15421
15422 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15423 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15424 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15425 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15426 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15427 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15428 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15429 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15430 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15431 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15432 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15433 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15434 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15435 provided by the active file and overviews.
15436
15437 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15438 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15439 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15440 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15441 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15442 wins big.
15443
15444 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15445 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15446 tiny files.
15447
15448 @item nnmh
15449
15450 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15451 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15452 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15453 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15454 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15455 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15456 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15457
15458 @item nnfolder
15459
15460 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15461 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15462 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15463 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15464 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15465 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15466 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15467 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15468 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15469
15470 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15471 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15472 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15473 friendly mail back end all over.
15474
15475 @item nnmaildir
15476
15477 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15478 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15479 mail back ends.
15480
15481 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15482 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15483 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15484 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15485 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15486 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15487 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15488 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15489 file system.
15490
15491 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15492 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15493 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15494 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15495 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15496 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15497 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15498 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15499 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15500 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15501 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15502
15503 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15504 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15505 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15506 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15507 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15508 @code{nnmaildir}.
15509
15510 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15511 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15512 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15513 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15514 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15515 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15516 removed in the future.
15517
15518 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15519 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15520 on your file system.
15521
15522 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15523 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15524
15525 @end table
15526
15527
15528 @node Browsing the Web
15529 @section Browsing the Web
15530 @cindex web
15531 @cindex browsing the web
15532 @cindex www
15533 @cindex http
15534
15535 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15536 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15537 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15538 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15539 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15540 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15541 even know what a news group is.
15542
15543 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15544 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15545 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15546 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15547 you mad in the end.
15548
15549 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15550 to do it instead?
15551
15552 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15553 interfaces to these sources.
15554
15555 @menu
15556 * Archiving Mail::
15557 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15558 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15559 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15560 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15561 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15562 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15563 @end menu
15564
15565 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15566 alternatives to work.
15567
15568 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15569 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15570 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15571 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15572 though, you should be ok.
15573
15574 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15575 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15576 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15577 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15578 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15579
15580 @node Archiving Mail
15581 @subsection Archiving Mail
15582 @cindex archiving mail
15583 @cindex backup of mail
15584
15585 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15586 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15587 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15588 marks is fairly simple.
15589
15590 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15591 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15592 though.)
15593
15594 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15595 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15596 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15597 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15598 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15599 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15600 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15601 before you restore the data.
15602
15603 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15604 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15605 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15606 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15607 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15608 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15609 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15610 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15611 is unnecessary in that case.
15612
15613 @node Web Searches
15614 @subsection Web Searches
15615 @cindex nnweb
15616 @cindex Google
15617 @cindex dejanews
15618 @cindex gmane
15619 @cindex Usenet searches
15620 @cindex searching the Usenet
15621
15622 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15623 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15624 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15625 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15626 searches without having to use a browser.
15627
15628 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15629 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15630 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15631 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15632 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15633
15634 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15635 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15636 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15637 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15638 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15639 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15640 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15641 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15642 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15643 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15644 group as read.
15645
15646 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15647 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15648 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15649 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15650 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15651 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15652
15653 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15654 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15655 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15656
15657 Virtual server variables:
15658
15659 @table @code
15660 @item nnweb-type
15661 @vindex nnweb-type
15662 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15663 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15664 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15665
15666 @item nnweb-search
15667 @vindex nnweb-search
15668 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15669
15670 @item nnweb-max-hits
15671 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15672 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15673 999.
15674
15675 @item nnweb-type-definition
15676 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15677 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15678 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15679 present:
15680
15681 @table @code
15682 @item article
15683 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15684 understands.
15685
15686 @item map
15687 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15688
15689 @item search
15690 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15691
15692 @item address
15693 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15694 to.
15695
15696 @item id
15697 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15698 @end table
15699
15700 @end table
15701
15702
15703 @node Slashdot
15704 @subsection Slashdot
15705 @cindex Slashdot
15706 @cindex nnslashdot
15707
15708 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15709 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15710 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15711
15712 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15713 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15714
15715 @lisp
15716 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15717 '((nnslashdot "")))
15718 @end lisp
15719
15720 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15721 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15722 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15723 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15724 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15725 Methods}).
15726
15727 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15728 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15729
15730 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15731 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15732 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15733 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15734 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15735 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15736 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15737
15738 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15739
15740 @table @code
15741 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15742 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15743 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15744 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15745 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15746 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15747 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15748
15749 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15750 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15751 The login name to use when posting.
15752
15753 @item nnslashdot-password
15754 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15755 The password to use when posting.
15756
15757 @item nnslashdot-directory
15758 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15759 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15760 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15761
15762 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15763 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15764 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15765 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15766 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15767
15768 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15769 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15770 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15771
15772 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15773 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15774 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15775 article. The default is
15776 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15777
15778 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15779 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15780 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15781
15782 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15783 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15784 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15785 updated. The default is 0.
15786
15787 @end table
15788
15789
15790
15791 @node Ultimate
15792 @subsection Ultimate
15793 @cindex nnultimate
15794 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15795
15796 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15797 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15798 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15799 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15800
15801 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15802 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15803 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15804 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15805 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15806 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15807 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15808
15809 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15810
15811 @table @code
15812 @item nnultimate-directory
15813 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15814 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15815 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15816 @end table
15817
15818
15819 @node Web Archive
15820 @subsection Web Archive
15821 @cindex nnwarchive
15822 @cindex Web Archive
15823
15824 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15825 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15826 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15827 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15828 groups updated.
15829
15830 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15831 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15832 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15833 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15834 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15835 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15836 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15837 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15838
15839 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15840
15841 @table @code
15842 @item nnwarchive-directory
15843 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15844 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15845 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15846
15847 @item nnwarchive-login
15848 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15849 The account name on the web server.
15850
15851 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15852 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15853 The password for your account on the web server.
15854 @end table
15855
15856 @node RSS
15857 @subsection RSS
15858 @cindex nnrss
15859 @cindex RSS
15860
15861 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15862 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15863 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15864 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15865 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15866
15867 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15868 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15869
15870 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
15871 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
15872 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
15873 group names.
15874
15875 @kindex G R (Group)
15876 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
15877 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
15878 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
15879 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
15880
15881 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15882 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15883 subscribe to groups.
15884
15885 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
15886 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
15887 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
15888 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
15889 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
15890 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
15891 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
15892 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
15893
15894 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
15895 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
15896 and a @samp{text/html} part.
15897
15898 @cindex OPML
15899 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
15900 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
15901 Markup Language).
15902
15903 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
15904 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
15905 file.
15906 @end defun
15907
15908 @defun nnrss-opml-export
15909 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
15910 @acronym{OPML} format.
15911 @end defun
15912
15913 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15914
15915 @table @code
15916 @item nnrss-directory
15917 @vindex nnrss-directory
15918 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15919 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15920
15921 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
15922 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
15923 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
15924 data files. The default is the value of
15925 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
15926 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
15927
15928 @item nnrss-use-local
15929 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15930 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15931 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15932 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15933 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15934 download script using @command{wget}.
15935
15936 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
15937 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
15938 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
15939 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
15940 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
15941 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
15942 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
15943 @samp{text/html} parts.
15944 @end table
15945
15946 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15947 the summary buffer.
15948
15949 @lisp
15950 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15951 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15952
15953 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15954 (let ((descr
15955 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15956 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15957 @end lisp
15958
15959 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15960 summary buffer.
15961
15962 @lisp
15963 (require 'browse-url)
15964
15965 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15966 (interactive "p")
15967 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15968 (mail-header-extra
15969 (gnus-data-header
15970 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15971 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15972 (if url
15973 (progn
15974 (browse-url (cdr url))
15975 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15976 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15977
15978 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15979 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15980 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15981 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15982 @end lisp
15983
15984 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
15985 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
15986 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
15987 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
15988 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
15989 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
15990 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
15991 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
15992 @code{nnrss} groups:
15993
15994 @lisp
15995 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
15996 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
15997 '(add-to-list
15998 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
15999 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16000 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16001
16002 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16003 (add-to-list
16004 'gnus-parameters
16005 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16006 @end lisp
16007
16008
16009 @node Customizing W3
16010 @subsection Customizing W3
16011 @cindex W3
16012 @cindex html
16013 @cindex url
16014 @cindex Netscape
16015
16016 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16017 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16018 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16019 users.
16020
16021 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16022 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16023 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16024
16025 @lisp
16026 (eval-after-load "w3"
16027 '(progn
16028 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16029 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16030 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16031 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16032 (browse-url url)
16033 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16034 @end lisp
16035
16036 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16037 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16038 follow the link.
16039
16040
16041 @node IMAP
16042 @section IMAP
16043 @cindex nnimap
16044 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16045
16046 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16047 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16048 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16049 specify the network address of the server.
16050
16051 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16052 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16053 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16054 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16055 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16056 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16057
16058 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16059 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16060 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16061 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16062
16063 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16064 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16065 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16066 usage explained in this section.
16067
16068 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16069 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16070 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16071 see below.)
16072
16073 @lisp
16074 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16075 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16076 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16077 (nnimap "dolk"
16078 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16079 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16080 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16081 (nnimap "barbar"
16082 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16083 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16084 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16085 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16086 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16087 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16088 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16089 (nnimap-stream network))
16090 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16091 (nnimap "vic20"
16092 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16093 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16094 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16095 @end lisp
16096
16097 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16098 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16099 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16100 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16101
16102 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16103 server:
16104
16105 @table @code
16106
16107 @item nnimap-address
16108 @vindex nnimap-address
16109
16110 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16111 server name if not specified.
16112
16113 @item nnimap-server-port
16114 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16115 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16116
16117 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16118
16119 @lisp
16120 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16121 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16122 @end lisp
16123
16124 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16125 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16126 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16127 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16128 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16129 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16130 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16131
16132 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16133 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16134 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16135 mailbox.
16136
16137 Example server specification:
16138
16139 @lisp
16140 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16141 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16142 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16143 @end lisp
16144
16145 @item nnimap-stream
16146 @vindex nnimap-stream
16147 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16148 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16149 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16150 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16151 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16152
16153 Example server specification:
16154
16155 @lisp
16156 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16157 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16158 @end lisp
16159
16160 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16161
16162 @itemize @bullet
16163 @item
16164 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16165 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16166 @item
16167 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16168 @item
16169 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16170 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16171 @samp{starttls}.
16172 @item
16173 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16174 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16175 @item
16176 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16177 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16178 @item
16179 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16180 @item
16181 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16182 @end itemize
16183
16184 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16185 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16186 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16187 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16188 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16189 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16190 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16191 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16192 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16193 program.
16194
16195 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16196 needed. It is available from
16197 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16198
16199 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16200 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16201 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16202 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16203 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16204 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16205 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16206 tried.
16207
16208 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16209 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16210 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16211 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16212 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16213 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16214 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16215 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16216
16217 @vindex imap-shell-program
16218 @vindex imap-shell-host
16219 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16220 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16221
16222 @item nnimap-authenticator
16223 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16224
16225 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16226 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16227
16228 Example server specification:
16229
16230 @lisp
16231 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16232 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16233 @end lisp
16234
16235 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16236
16237 @itemize @bullet
16238 @item
16239 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16240 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16241 @item
16242 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16243 @code{imtest}.
16244 @item
16245 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16246 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16247 @item
16248 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16249 @item
16250 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16251 @item
16252 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16253 @end itemize
16254
16255 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16256 @cindex expunging
16257 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16258 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16259 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16260 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16261 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16262 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16263 similar).
16264
16265 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16266 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16267 running in circles yet?
16268
16269 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16270 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16271 variable.
16272
16273 The possible options are:
16274
16275 @table @code
16276
16277 @item always
16278 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16279 closing a mailbox.
16280 @item never
16281 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16282 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16283 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16284 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16285 @item ask
16286 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16287 articles or not.
16288
16289 @end table
16290
16291 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16292 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16293
16294 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16295 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16296 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16297 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16298 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16299 has only one.)
16300
16301 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16302 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16303
16304 @lisp
16305 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16306 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16307 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16308 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16309 @end lisp
16310
16311 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16312 as ticked for other users.
16313
16314 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16315 @cindex expunging
16316 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16317
16318 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16319 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16320 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16321 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16322
16323 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16324 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16325 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16326 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16327
16328 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16329 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16330
16331 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16332 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16333 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16334 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16335
16336 @example
16337 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16338 @end example
16339
16340 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16341 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16342 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16343 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16344 @code{port imap}.
16345
16346 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16347 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16348
16349 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16350 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16351 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16352
16353 @end table
16354
16355 @menu
16356 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16357 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16358 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16359 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16360 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16361 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16362 @end menu
16363
16364
16365
16366 @node Splitting in IMAP
16367 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16368 @cindex splitting imap mail
16369
16370 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16371 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16372 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16373 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16374 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16375
16376 And it does.
16377
16378 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16379 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16380 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16381
16382 Here are the variables of interest:
16383
16384 @table @code
16385
16386 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16387 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16388 @cindex crosspost
16389 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16390
16391 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16392 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16393 found will be used.
16394
16395 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16396
16397 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16398 @cindex splitting, inbox
16399 @cindex inbox
16400 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16401
16402 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16403 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16404 splitting is disabled!
16405
16406 @lisp
16407 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16408 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16409 @end lisp
16410
16411 No nnmail equivalent.
16412
16413 @item nnimap-split-rule
16414 @cindex splitting, rules
16415 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16416
16417 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16418 this variable.
16419
16420 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16421 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16422 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16423 Neither did I, we need examples.
16424
16425 @lisp
16426 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16427 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16428 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16429 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16430 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16431 @end lisp
16432
16433 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16434 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16435 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16436
16437 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16438 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16439 instance:
16440
16441 @lisp
16442 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16443 @end lisp
16444
16445 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16446 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16447
16448 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16449 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16450 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16451 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16452
16453 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16454 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16455 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16456 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16457 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16458 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16459
16460 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16461 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16462 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16463
16464 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16465 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16466 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16467
16468 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16469
16470 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16471 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16472 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16473
16474 @lisp
16475 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16476 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16477 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16478 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16479 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16480 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16481 @end lisp
16482
16483 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16484 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16485 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16486 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16487 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16488 group/function elements.
16489
16490 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16491
16492 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16493 @cindex splitting
16494 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16495
16496 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16497 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16498
16499 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16500 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16501 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16502 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16503
16504 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16505 @cindex splitting, fancy
16506 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16507 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16508
16509 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16510 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16511 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16512
16513 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16514 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16515 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16516 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16517
16518 Example:
16519
16520 @lisp
16521 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16522 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16523 @end lisp
16524
16525 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16526
16527 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16528 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16529 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16530
16531 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16532 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16533 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16534 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16535
16536 @end table
16537
16538 @node Expiring in IMAP
16539 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16540 @cindex expiring imap mail
16541
16542 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16543 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16544 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16545 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16546 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16547 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16548 process.
16549
16550 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16551 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16552 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16553 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16554 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16555 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16556 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16557 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16558
16559 @table @code
16560
16561 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16562 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16563
16564 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16565 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16566
16567 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16568
16569 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16570 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16571 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16572 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16573
16574 @end table
16575
16576 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16577 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16578 @cindex editing imap acls
16579 @cindex Access Control Lists
16580 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16581 @kindex G l (Group)
16582 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16583
16584 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16585 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16586 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16587 doesn't.
16588
16589 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16590 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16591 editing window with detailed instructions.
16592
16593 Some possible uses:
16594
16595 @itemize @bullet
16596 @item
16597 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16598 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16599 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16600 @item
16601 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16602 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16603 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16604 INBOX.mailbox).
16605 @end itemize
16606
16607 @node Expunging mailboxes
16608 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16609 @cindex expunging
16610
16611 @cindex expunge
16612 @cindex manual expunging
16613 @kindex G x (Group)
16614 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16615
16616 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16617 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16618 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16619
16620 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16621 delete them.
16622
16623 @node A note on namespaces
16624 @subsection A note on namespaces
16625 @cindex IMAP namespace
16626 @cindex namespaces
16627
16628 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16629 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16630
16631 @display
16632 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16633
16634 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16635 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16636 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16637 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16638
16639 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16640 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16641 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16642 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16643 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16644 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16645 @end display
16646
16647 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16648 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16649 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16650
16651 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16652 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16653 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16654 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16655 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16656 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16657 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16658 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16659 Gnus.
16660
16661 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16662 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16663 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16664
16665 @node Debugging IMAP
16666 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16667 @cindex IMAP debugging
16668 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16669
16670 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16671 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16672 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16673 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16674
16675 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16676 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16677 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16678 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16679 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16680 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16681 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16682
16683
16684 @vindex imap-log
16685 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16686 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16687 follows:
16688
16689 @lisp
16690 (setq imap-log t)
16691 @end lisp
16692
16693 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16694 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16695 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16696 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16697 data.
16698
16699 @node Other Sources
16700 @section Other Sources
16701
16702 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16703 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16704 newsgroups.
16705
16706 @menu
16707 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16708 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16709 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16710 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16711 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16712 @end menu
16713
16714
16715 @node Directory Groups
16716 @subsection Directory Groups
16717 @cindex nndir
16718 @cindex directory groups
16719
16720 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16721 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16722 names, of course.
16723
16724 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16725 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16726 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16727 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16728
16729 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16730 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16731 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16732 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16733 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16734
16735 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16736
16737 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16738 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16739 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16740 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16741
16742
16743 @node Anything Groups
16744 @subsection Anything Groups
16745 @cindex nneething
16746
16747 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16748 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16749 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16750 true.
16751
16752 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16753 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16754 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16755 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16756 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16757 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16758 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16759 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16760 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16761 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16762 elements.
16763
16764 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16765 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16766 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16767 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16768
16769 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16770 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16771 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16772 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16773
16774 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16775 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16776 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16777 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16778 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16779 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16780 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16781 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16782
16783 Some variables:
16784
16785 @table @code
16786 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16787 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16788 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16789 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16790
16791 @item nneething-exclude-files
16792 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16793 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16794 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16795
16796 @item nneething-include-files
16797 @vindex nneething-include-files
16798 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16799 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16800
16801 @item nneething-map-file
16802 @vindex nneething-map-file
16803 Name of the map files.
16804 @end table
16805
16806
16807 @node Document Groups
16808 @subsection Document Groups
16809 @cindex nndoc
16810 @cindex documentation group
16811 @cindex help group
16812
16813 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16814 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16815
16816 @table @code
16817 @cindex Babyl
16818 @cindex Rmail mbox
16819 @item babyl
16820 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16821
16822 @cindex mbox
16823 @cindex Unix mbox
16824 @item mbox
16825 The standard Unix mbox file.
16826
16827 @cindex MMDF mail box
16828 @item mmdf
16829 The MMDF mail box format.
16830
16831 @item news
16832 Several news articles appended into a file.
16833
16834 @cindex rnews batch files
16835 @item rnews
16836 The rnews batch transport format.
16837
16838 @item nsmail
16839 Netscape mail boxes.
16840
16841 @item mime-parts
16842 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16843
16844 @item standard-digest
16845 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16846
16847 @item mime-digest
16848 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16849
16850 @item lanl-gov-announce
16851 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16852
16853 @cindex forwarded messages
16854 @item rfc822-forward
16855 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16856
16857 @item outlook
16858 The Outlook mail box.
16859
16860 @item oe-dbx
16861 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16862
16863 @item exim-bounce
16864 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16865
16866 @item forward
16867 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16868
16869 @item rfc934
16870 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16871
16872 @item mailman
16873 A mailman digest.
16874
16875 @item clari-briefs
16876 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16877
16878 @item slack-digest
16879 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16880
16881 @item mail-in-mail
16882 The last resort.
16883 @end table
16884
16885 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16886 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16887 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16888 file is.
16889
16890 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16891 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16892 group. And that's it.
16893
16894 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16895 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16896 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16897 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16898 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16899 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16900 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16901 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16902 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16903 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16904
16905 Virtual server variables:
16906
16907 @table @code
16908 @item nndoc-article-type
16909 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16910 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16911 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16912 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16913 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16914 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16915
16916 @item nndoc-post-type
16917 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16918 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16919 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16920 and @code{news}.
16921 @end table
16922
16923 @menu
16924 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16925 @end menu
16926
16927
16928 @node Document Server Internals
16929 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16930
16931 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16932 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16933 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16934 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16935
16936 First, here's an example document type definition:
16937
16938 @example
16939 (mmdf
16940 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16941 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16942 @end example
16943
16944 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16945 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16946 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16947 types can be defined with very few settings:
16948
16949 @table @code
16950 @item first-article
16951 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16952 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16953 totally ignored.
16954
16955 @item article-begin
16956 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16957 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
16958 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
16959 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
16960
16961 @item article-begin-function
16962 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
16963 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
16964
16965 @item head-begin
16966 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16967 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
16968 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
16969
16970 @item head-begin-function
16971 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16972 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
16973
16974 @item head-end
16975 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16976 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16977
16978 @item body-begin
16979 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16980 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
16981 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
16982
16983 @item body-begin-function
16984 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16985 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
16986
16987 @item body-end
16988 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
16989 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
16990 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
16991
16992 @item body-end-function
16993 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16994 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
16995
16996 @item file-begin
16997 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
16998 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
16999
17000 @item file-end
17001 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17002 regexp will be totally ignored.
17003
17004 @end table
17005
17006 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17007 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17008 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17009 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17010 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17011
17012 @table @code
17013 @item prepare-body-function
17014 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17015 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17016 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17017
17018 @item article-transform-function
17019 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17020 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17021 body of the article.
17022
17023 @item generate-head-function
17024 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17025 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17026 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17027 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17028
17029 @item generate-article-function
17030 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17031 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17032 parameter when requesting all articles.
17033
17034 @item dissection-function
17035 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17036 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17037 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17038 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17039 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17040 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17041
17042 @end table
17043
17044 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17045 digests:
17046
17047 @example
17048 (standard-digest
17049 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17050 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17051 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17052 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17053 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17054 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17055 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17056 (subtype digest guess))
17057 @end example
17058
17059 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17060 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17061 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17062 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17063 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17064
17065 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17066 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17067 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17068 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17069 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17070 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17071 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17072 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17073 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17074 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17075 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17076 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17077
17078
17079 @node SOUP
17080 @subsection SOUP
17081 @cindex SOUP
17082 @cindex offline
17083
17084 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17085 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17086 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17087
17088 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17089 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17090 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17091 newsreaders.
17092
17093 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17094 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17095 that interested in doing things properly.
17096
17097 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17098 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17099 fiddly.
17100
17101 First some terminology:
17102
17103 @table @dfn
17104
17105 @item server
17106 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17107 get news and/or mail from.
17108
17109 @item home machine
17110 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17111 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17112
17113 @item packet
17114 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17115 of packets:
17116
17117 @table @dfn
17118 @item message packets
17119 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17120 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17121 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17122
17123 @item response packets
17124 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17125 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17126 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17127
17128 @end table
17129
17130 @end table
17131
17132
17133 @enumerate
17134
17135 @item
17136 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17137 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17138 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17139 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17140
17141 @item
17142 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17143
17144 @item
17145 You put the packet in your home directory.
17146
17147 @item
17148 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17149 the native or secondary server.
17150
17151 @item
17152 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17153 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17154
17155 @item
17156 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17157 packet.
17158
17159 @item
17160 You transfer this packet to the server.
17161
17162 @item
17163 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17164
17165 @item
17166 You then repeat until you die.
17167
17168 @end enumerate
17169
17170 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17171 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17172
17173 @menu
17174 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17175 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17176 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17177 @end menu
17178
17179
17180 @node SOUP Commands
17181 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17182
17183 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17184
17185 @table @kbd
17186 @item G s b
17187 @kindex G s b (Group)
17188 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17189 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17190 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17191 process/prefix convention.
17192
17193 @item G s w
17194 @kindex G s w (Group)
17195 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17196 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17197
17198 @item G s s
17199 @kindex G s s (Group)
17200 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17201 Send all replies from the replies packet
17202 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17203
17204 @item G s p
17205 @kindex G s p (Group)
17206 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17207 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17208
17209 @item G s r
17210 @kindex G s r (Group)
17211 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17212 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17213
17214 @item O s
17215 @kindex O s (Summary)
17216 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17217 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17218 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17219 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17220
17221 @end table
17222
17223
17224 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17225 thingies:
17226
17227 @table @code
17228
17229 @item gnus-soup-directory
17230 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17231 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17232 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17233
17234 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17235 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17236 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17237 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17238
17239 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17240 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17241 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17242 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17243
17244 @item gnus-soup-packer
17245 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17246 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17247 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17248
17249 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17250 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17251 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17252 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17253
17254 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17255 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17256 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17257
17258 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17259 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17260 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17261 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17262
17263 @end table
17264
17265
17266 @node SOUP Groups
17267 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17268 @cindex nnsoup
17269
17270 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17271 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17272 you can read them at leisure.
17273
17274 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17275
17276 @table @code
17277
17278 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17279 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17280 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17281 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17282
17283 @item nnsoup-directory
17284 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17285 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17286 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17287
17288 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17289 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17290 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17291 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17292
17293 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17294 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17295 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17296 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17297 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17298
17299 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17300 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17301 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17302 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17303
17304 @item nnsoup-active-file
17305 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17306 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17307 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17308 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17309 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17310
17311 @item nnsoup-packer
17312 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17313 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17314 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17315
17316 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17317 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17318 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17319 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17320
17321 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17322 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17323 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17324 @file{~/}.
17325
17326 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17327 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17328 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17329 @samp{Soupout}.
17330
17331 @item nnsoup-always-save
17332 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17333 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17334
17335 @end table
17336
17337
17338 @node SOUP Replies
17339 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17340
17341 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17342 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17343 more for that to happen.
17344
17345 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17346 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17347 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17348 @sc{soup} system.
17349
17350 In specific, this is what it does:
17351
17352 @lisp
17353 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17354 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17355 @end lisp
17356
17357 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17358 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17359 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17360
17361
17362 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17363 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17364 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17365 @cindex gateways
17366
17367 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17368 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17369 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17370
17371 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17372 used to post with.
17373
17374 Server variables:
17375
17376 @table @code
17377 @item nngateway-address
17378 @vindex nngateway-address
17379 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17380
17381 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17382 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17383 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17384 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17385 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17386 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17387 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17388 gateway address.
17389
17390 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17391 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17392 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17393
17394 @example
17395 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17396 @end example
17397
17398 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17399
17400 @example
17401 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17402 @end example
17403
17404 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17405
17406 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17407 @table @code
17408
17409 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17410 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17411 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17412
17413 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17414
17415 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17416 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17417 @code{nngateway-address}.
17418 @end table
17419
17420 @end table
17421
17422 Here's an example:
17423
17424 @lisp
17425 (setq gnus-post-method
17426 '(nngateway
17427 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17428 (nngateway-header-transformation
17429 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17430 @end lisp
17431
17432 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17433
17434 @lisp
17435 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17436 @end lisp
17437
17438
17439
17440 @node Combined Groups
17441 @section Combined Groups
17442
17443 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17444 groups.
17445
17446 @menu
17447 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17448 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17449 @end menu
17450
17451
17452 @node Virtual Groups
17453 @subsection Virtual Groups
17454 @cindex nnvirtual
17455 @cindex virtual groups
17456 @cindex merging groups
17457
17458 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17459 other groups.
17460
17461 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17462 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17463 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17464
17465 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17466 regexp to match component groups.
17467
17468 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17469 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17470 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17471 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17472 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17473 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17474 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17475 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17476
17477 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17478 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17479
17480 @lisp
17481 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17482 @end lisp
17483
17484 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17485 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17486
17487 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17488 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17489 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17490 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17491
17492 @example
17493 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17494 @end example
17495
17496 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17497 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17498 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17499
17500 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17501 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17502 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17503 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17504 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17505
17506 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17507 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17508 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17509
17510 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17511 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17512 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17513 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17514 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17515 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17516 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17517 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17518 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17519 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17520 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17521
17522 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17523 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17524 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17525 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17526 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17527 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17528 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17529
17530 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17531 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17532
17533 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17534 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17535 inherited.
17536
17537
17538 @node Kibozed Groups
17539 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17540 @cindex nnkiboze
17541 @cindex kibozing
17542
17543 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17544 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17545 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17546 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17547
17548 @kindex G k (Group)
17549 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17550 buffer.
17551
17552 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17553 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17554 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17555 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17556
17557 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17558 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17559 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17560
17561 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17562 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17563 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17564 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17565 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17566 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17567 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17568 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17569
17570 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17571 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17572 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17573 Stranger things have happened.
17574
17575 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17576 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17577
17578 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17579 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17580 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17581 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17582 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17583 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17584 component articles.
17585
17586 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17587 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17588
17589
17590 @node Gnus Unplugged
17591 @section Gnus Unplugged
17592 @cindex offline
17593 @cindex unplugged
17594 @cindex agent
17595 @cindex Gnus agent
17596 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17597
17598 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17599 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17600 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17601 read news. Believe it or not.
17602
17603 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17604 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17605 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17606 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17607 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17608
17609 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17610 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17611 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17612 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17613 reading news on a machine.
17614
17615 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17616 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17617
17618 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17619
17620 @menu
17621 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17622 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17623 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17624 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17625 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17626 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17627 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17628 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17629 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17630 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17631 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17632 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17633 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17634 @end menu
17635
17636
17637 @node Agent Basics
17638 @subsection Agent Basics
17639
17640 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17641
17642 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17643 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17644 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17645 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17646
17647 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17648 connected to the net continuously.
17649
17650 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17651 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17652
17653 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17654 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17655 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17656 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17657 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17658
17659 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17660 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17661 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17662 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17663 they're kinda like plugged always).
17664
17665 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17666 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17667 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17668 the culprit.
17669
17670 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17671 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17672 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17673 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17674 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17675
17676 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17677
17678 @itemize @bullet
17679
17680 @item
17681 @findex gnus-unplugged
17682 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17683 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17684 already fetched while in this mode.
17685
17686 @item
17687 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17688 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17689 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17690 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17691 Source Specifiers}).
17692
17693 @item
17694 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17695 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17696 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17697 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17698 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17699
17700 @item
17701 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17702 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17703 then you read the news offline.
17704
17705 @item
17706 And then you go to step 2.
17707 @end itemize
17708
17709 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17710 the Agent.
17711
17712 @itemize @bullet
17713
17714 @item
17715 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17716 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17717 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17718 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17719 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17720 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17721 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17722 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17723
17724 @item
17725 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17726 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17727 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17728 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17729
17730 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17731 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17732 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17733 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17734 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17735 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17736 configure them.
17737
17738 @item
17739 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17740 @end itemize
17741
17742
17743 @node Agent Categories
17744 @subsection Agent Categories
17745
17746 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17747 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17748 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17749 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17750 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17751 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17752 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17753
17754 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17755 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17756 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17757 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17758 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17759
17760 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17761 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17762 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17763 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17764 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17765 sink.
17766
17767 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17768 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17769 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17770 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17771 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17772 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17773 your settings.
17774
17775 @menu
17776 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17777 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17778 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17779 @end menu
17780
17781
17782 @node Category Syntax
17783 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17784
17785 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17786 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17787 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17788 listed below.
17789
17790 @cindex Agent Parameters
17791 @table @code
17792 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17793 The name of the category.
17794
17795 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17796 The list of groups that are in this category.
17797
17798 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17799 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17800 are eligible for downloading; and
17801
17802 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17803 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17804 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17805 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17806
17807 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17808 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17809 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17810 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17811 only groups that should not be expired.
17812
17813 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17814 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17815 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17816
17817 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17818 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17819
17820 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17821 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17822
17823 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17824 an integer that overrides the value of
17825 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17826
17827 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17828 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17829
17830 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17831 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17832 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17833 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17834 @c all other symbols disable them.
17835
17836 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17837 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17838 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17839 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17840 all other symbols enable them.
17841 @end table
17842
17843 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17844 created.
17845
17846 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17847 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17848 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17849 category.
17850
17851 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17852 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17853 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17854 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17855
17856 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17857 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17858 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17859
17860 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17861 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17862 operators sprinkled in between.
17863
17864 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17865
17866 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17867 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17868
17869 @lisp
17870 short
17871 @end lisp
17872
17873 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17874 short (for some value of ``short'').
17875
17876 Here's a more complex predicate:
17877
17878 @lisp
17879 (or high
17880 (and
17881 (not low)
17882 (not long)))
17883 @end lisp
17884
17885 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17886 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17887 drift.
17888
17889 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17890 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17891 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17892
17893 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17894 you want to do, you can write your own.
17895
17896 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17897 bound to the value determined by calling
17898 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17899 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17900 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17901 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17902 predicate to individual groups.
17903
17904 @table @code
17905 @item short
17906 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17907 lines; default 100.
17908
17909 @item long
17910 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17911 lines; default 200.
17912
17913 @item low
17914 True iff the article has a download score less than
17915 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17916
17917 @item high
17918 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17919 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17920
17921 @item spam
17922 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17923 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17924 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17925
17926 @item true
17927 Always true.
17928
17929 @item false
17930 Always false.
17931 @end table
17932
17933 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17934 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17935 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17936 useful values.
17937
17938 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17939 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17940 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17941 something along the lines of the following:
17942
17943 @lisp
17944 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17945 "Say whether an article is old."
17946 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17947 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17948 @end lisp
17949
17950 with the predicate then defined as:
17951
17952 @lisp
17953 (not my-article-old-p)
17954 @end lisp
17955
17956 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17957 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17958 wherever.
17959
17960 @lisp
17961 (require 'gnus-agent)
17962 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17963 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17964 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17965 @end lisp
17966
17967 and simply specify your predicate as:
17968
17969 @lisp
17970 (not old)
17971 @end lisp
17972
17973 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17974 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17975 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17976 just don't give a damn.
17977
17978 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17979 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17980 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17981 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17982 parameters like so:
17983
17984 @lisp
17985 (agent-predicate . short)
17986 @end lisp
17987
17988 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17989 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17990 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17991
17992 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17993
17994 @lisp
17995 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17996 @end lisp
17997
17998 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17999 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18000 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18001
18002
18003 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18004 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18005 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18006 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18007 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18008 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18009
18010 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18011 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18012 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18013 if it's to be specific to that group.
18014
18015 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18016 three forms:
18017
18018 @enumerate
18019 @item
18020 Score rule
18021
18022 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18023 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18024
18025 example:
18026
18027 @itemize @bullet
18028 @item
18029 Category specification
18030
18031 @lisp
18032 (("from"
18033 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18034 ("lines"
18035 (500 -100 nil <)))
18036 @end lisp
18037
18038 @item
18039 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18040
18041 @lisp
18042 (agent-score ("from"
18043 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18044 ("lines"
18045 (500 -100 nil <)))
18046 @end lisp
18047
18048 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18049 @end itemize
18050
18051 @item
18052 Agent score file
18053
18054 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18055 keywords stated above.
18056
18057 example:
18058
18059 @itemize @bullet
18060 @item
18061 Category specification
18062
18063 @lisp
18064 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18065 @end lisp
18066
18067 or perhaps
18068
18069 @lisp
18070 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18071 @end lisp
18072
18073 @item
18074 Group Parameter specification
18075
18076 @lisp
18077 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18078 @end lisp
18079
18080 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18081 about parenthesis?
18082 @end itemize
18083
18084 @item
18085 Use @code{normal} score files
18086
18087 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18088 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18089 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18090 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18091
18092 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18093 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18094 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18095 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18096
18097 @itemize @bullet
18098 @item
18099 Category Specification
18100
18101 @lisp
18102 file
18103 @end lisp
18104
18105 @item
18106 Group Parameter specification
18107
18108 @lisp
18109 (agent-score . file)
18110 @end lisp
18111 @end itemize
18112 @end enumerate
18113
18114 @node Category Buffer
18115 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18116
18117 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18118 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18119 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18120
18121 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18122
18123 @table @kbd
18124 @item q
18125 @kindex q (Category)
18126 @findex gnus-category-exit
18127 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18128
18129 @item e
18130 @kindex e (Category)
18131 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18132 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18133 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18134
18135 @item k
18136 @kindex k (Category)
18137 @findex gnus-category-kill
18138 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18139
18140 @item c
18141 @kindex c (Category)
18142 @findex gnus-category-copy
18143 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18144
18145 @item a
18146 @kindex a (Category)
18147 @findex gnus-category-add
18148 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18149
18150 @item p
18151 @kindex p (Category)
18152 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18153 Edit the predicate of the current category
18154 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18155
18156 @item g
18157 @kindex g (Category)
18158 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18159 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18160 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18161
18162 @item s
18163 @kindex s (Category)
18164 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18165 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18166 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18167
18168 @item l
18169 @kindex l (Category)
18170 @findex gnus-category-list
18171 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18172 @end table
18173
18174
18175 @node Category Variables
18176 @subsubsection Category Variables
18177
18178 @table @code
18179 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18180 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18181 Hook run in category buffers.
18182
18183 @item gnus-category-line-format
18184 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18185 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18186 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18187
18188 @table @samp
18189 @item c
18190 The name of the category.
18191
18192 @item g
18193 The number of groups in the category.
18194 @end table
18195
18196 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18197 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18198 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18199
18200 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18201 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18202 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18203
18204 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18205 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18206 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18207
18208 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18209 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18210 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18211 0.
18212
18213 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18214 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18215 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18216 0.
18217
18218 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18219 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18220 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18221 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18222 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18223 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18224 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18225 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18226 read.
18227 Default 7.
18228
18229 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18230 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18231 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18232 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18233 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18234 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18235 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18236
18237 @end table
18238
18239
18240 @node Agent Commands
18241 @subsection Agent Commands
18242 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18243 @kindex J j (Agent)
18244
18245 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18246 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18247 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18248
18249
18250 @menu
18251 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18252 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18253 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18254 @end menu
18255
18256
18257
18258
18259 @node Group Agent Commands
18260 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18261
18262 @table @kbd
18263 @item J u
18264 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18265 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18266 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18267 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18268
18269 @item J c
18270 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18271 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18272 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18273
18274 @item J s
18275 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18276 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18277 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18278 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18279
18280 @item J S
18281 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18282 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18283 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18284 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18285
18286 @item J a
18287 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18288 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18289 Add the current group to an Agent category
18290 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18291 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18292
18293 @item J r
18294 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18295 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18296 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18297 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18298 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18299
18300 @item J Y
18301 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18302 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18303 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18304
18305
18306 @end table
18307
18308
18309 @node Summary Agent Commands
18310 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18311
18312 @table @kbd
18313 @item J #
18314 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18315 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18316 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18317
18318 @item J M-#
18319 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18320 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18321 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18322 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18323
18324 @cindex %
18325 @item @@
18326 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18327 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18328 Toggle whether to download the article
18329 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18330 default.
18331
18332 @item J c
18333 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18334 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18335 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18336
18337 @item J S
18338 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18339 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18340 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18341 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18342
18343 @item J s
18344 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18345 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18346 Download all processable articles in this group.
18347 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18348
18349 @item J u
18350 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18351 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18352 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18353 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18354
18355 @end table
18356
18357
18358 @node Server Agent Commands
18359 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18360
18361 @table @kbd
18362 @item J a
18363 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18364 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18365 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18366 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18367
18368 @item J r
18369 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18370 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18371 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18372 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18373
18374 @end table
18375
18376
18377 @node Agent Visuals
18378 @subsection Agent Visuals
18379
18380 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18381 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18382 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18383 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18384 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18385 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18386 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18387 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18388 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18389 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18390
18391 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18392 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18393 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18394 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18395 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18396 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18397 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18398 articles will be available when unplugged.
18399
18400 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18401 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18402 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18403 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18404 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18405 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18406 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18407 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18408
18409 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18410 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18411 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18412 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18413 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18414 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18415 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18416 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18417 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18418
18419 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18420 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18421 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18422 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18423 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18424
18425 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18426 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18427 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18428 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18429 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18430 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18431 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18432 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18433 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18434 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18435 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18436 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18437 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18438
18439 @node Agent as Cache
18440 @subsection Agent as Cache
18441
18442 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18443 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18444 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18445 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18446 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18447 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18448 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18449 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18450 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18451
18452 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18453 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18454 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18455 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18456 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18457
18458 @node Agent Expiry
18459 @subsection Agent Expiry
18460
18461 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18462 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18463 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18464 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18465 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18466 @cindex agent expiry
18467 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18468 @cindex expiry
18469
18470 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18471 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18472 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18473 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18474 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18475 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18476 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18477 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18478
18479 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18480 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18481 synchronized with the group.
18482
18483 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18484 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18485
18486 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18487 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18488 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18489 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18490 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18491 be kept indefinitely.
18492
18493 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18494 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18495 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18496 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18497
18498 @node Agent Regeneration
18499 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18500
18501 @cindex agent regeneration
18502 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18503 @cindex regeneration
18504
18505 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18506 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18507 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18508 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18509 internal inconsistencies.
18510
18511 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18512 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18513 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18514 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18515 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18516 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18517
18518 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18519 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18520 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18521 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18522 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18523 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18524
18525 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18526 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18527 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18528 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18529 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18530 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18531 agent as unread.
18532
18533 @node Agent and IMAP
18534 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18535
18536 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18537 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18538 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18539 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18540
18541 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18542 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18543 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18544 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18545
18546 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18547 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18548 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18549 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18550
18551 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18552 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18553 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18554 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18555 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18556 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18557
18558 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18559 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18560 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18561 in the group buffer.
18562
18563 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18564 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18565
18566 @itemize @bullet
18567
18568 @item
18569 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18570
18571 @item
18572 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18573
18574 @end itemize
18575
18576 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18577 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18578 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18579 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18580 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18581 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18582 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18583 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18584
18585
18586 @node Outgoing Messages
18587 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18588
18589 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18590 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18591 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18592
18593 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18594 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18595 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18596 messages in the draft group.
18597
18598
18599
18600 @node Agent Variables
18601 @subsection Agent Variables
18602
18603 @table @code
18604 @item gnus-agent-directory
18605 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18606 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18607 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18608
18609 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18610 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18611 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18612 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18613 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18614 by default.
18615
18616 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18617 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18618 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18619
18620 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18621 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18622 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18623
18624 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18625 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18626 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18627
18628 @item gnus-agent-cache
18629 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18630 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18631 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18632 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18633
18634 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18635 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18636 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18637 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18638 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18639 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18640 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18641 online status.
18642
18643 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18644 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18645 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18646 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18647 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18648 read. The default is @code{t}.
18649
18650 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18651 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18652 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18653 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18654 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18655 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18656 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18657 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18658 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18659 over and over again.
18660
18661 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18662 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18663 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18664 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18665 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18666 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18667 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18668 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18669 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18670 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18671 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18672 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18673 see any cycling.
18674
18675 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18676 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18677 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18678 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18679 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18680 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18681 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18682 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18683 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18684
18685 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18686 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18687 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18688 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18689 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18690 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18691
18692 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18693 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18694 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18695 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18696 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18697
18698 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18699 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18700 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18701 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18702 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18703 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18704 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18705 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18706 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18707 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18708 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18709
18710 @end table
18711
18712
18713 @node Example Setup
18714 @subsection Example Setup
18715
18716 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18717 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18718 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18719
18720 @lisp
18721 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18722 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18723 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18724
18725 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18726 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18727 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18728
18729 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18730 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18731
18732 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18733 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18734 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18735 @end lisp
18736
18737 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18738 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18739 gnus}.
18740
18741 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18742 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18743 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18744 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18745 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18746 once.
18747
18748 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18749 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18750 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18751 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18752 back all the killed groups.)
18753
18754 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18755 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18756 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18757
18758
18759 @node Batching Agents
18760 @subsection Batching Agents
18761 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18762
18763 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18764 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18765 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18766
18767 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18768 following incantation:
18769
18770 @example
18771 #!/bin/sh
18772 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18773 @end example
18774
18775
18776 @node Agent Caveats
18777 @subsection Agent Caveats
18778
18779 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18780 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18781 may ask:
18782
18783 @table @dfn
18784 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18785
18786 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18787 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18788 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18789
18790 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18791 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18792
18793 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18794
18795 @end table
18796
18797 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18798 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18799 locally stored articles.
18800
18801
18802 @node Scoring
18803 @chapter Scoring
18804 @cindex scoring
18805
18806 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18807 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18808 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18809 attention!
18810
18811 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18812 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18813 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18814 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18815 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18816
18817 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18818 before generating the summary buffer.
18819
18820 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18821 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18822 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18823
18824 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18825 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18826 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18827 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18828
18829 @menu
18830 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18831 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18832 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18833 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18834 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18835 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18836 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18837 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18838 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18839 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18840 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18841 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18842 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18843 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18844 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18845 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18846 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18847 @end menu
18848
18849
18850 @node Summary Score Commands
18851 @section Summary Score Commands
18852 @cindex score commands
18853
18854 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18855 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18856 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18857 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18858 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18859
18860 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18861 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18862 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18863 score file the current one.
18864
18865 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18866
18867 @table @kbd
18868
18869 @item V s
18870 @kindex V s (Summary)
18871 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18872 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18873
18874 @item V S
18875 @kindex V S (Summary)
18876 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18877 Display the score of the current article
18878 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18879
18880 @item V t
18881 @kindex V t (Summary)
18882 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18883 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18884 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18885 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18886 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18887 score file and edit it.
18888
18889 @item V w
18890 @kindex V w (Summary)
18891 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18892 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18893
18894 @item V R
18895 @kindex V R (Summary)
18896 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18897 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18898 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18899 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18900 effect you're having.
18901
18902 @item V c
18903 @kindex V c (Summary)
18904 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18905 Make a different score file the current
18906 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18907
18908 @item V e
18909 @kindex V e (Summary)
18910 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18911 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18912 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18913 File Editing}).
18914
18915 @item V f
18916 @kindex V f (Summary)
18917 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18918 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18919 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18920
18921 @item V F
18922 @kindex V F (Summary)
18923 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18924 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18925 after editing score files.
18926
18927 @item V C
18928 @kindex V C (Summary)
18929 @findex gnus-score-customize
18930 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18931 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18932
18933 @end table
18934
18935 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18936
18937 @table @kbd
18938
18939 @item V m
18940 @kindex V m (Summary)
18941 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18942 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18943 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18944
18945 @item V x
18946 @kindex V x (Summary)
18947 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18948 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18949 expunge all articles below this score
18950 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18951 @end table
18952
18953 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18954 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18955 them.)
18956
18957 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18958 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18959
18960 @enumerate
18961 @item
18962 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18963 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18964 @item
18965 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18966 keys are available:
18967 @table @kbd
18968
18969 @item a
18970 Score on the author name.
18971
18972 @item s
18973 Score on the subject line.
18974
18975 @item x
18976 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18977
18978 @item r
18979 Score on the @code{References} line.
18980
18981 @item d
18982 Score on the date.
18983
18984 @item l
18985 Score on the number of lines.
18986
18987 @item i
18988 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18989
18990 @item e
18991 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18992 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18993
18994 @item f
18995 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18996 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18997 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18998
18999 @item b
19000 Score on the body.
19001
19002 @item h
19003 Score on the head.
19004
19005 @item t
19006 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19007 files.)
19008
19009 @end table
19010
19011 @item
19012 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19013 what headers you are scoring on.
19014
19015 @table @code
19016
19017 @item strings
19018
19019 @table @kbd
19020
19021 @item e
19022 Exact matching.
19023
19024 @item s
19025 Substring matching.
19026
19027 @item f
19028 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19029
19030 @item r
19031 Regexp matching
19032 @end table
19033
19034 @item date
19035 @table @kbd
19036
19037 @item b
19038 Before date.
19039
19040 @item a
19041 After date.
19042
19043 @item n
19044 This date.
19045 @end table
19046
19047 @item number
19048 @table @kbd
19049
19050 @item <
19051 Less than number.
19052
19053 @item =
19054 Equal to number.
19055
19056 @item >
19057 Greater than number.
19058 @end table
19059 @end table
19060
19061 @item
19062 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19063 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19064 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19065 file.
19066 @table @kbd
19067
19068 @item t
19069 Temporary score entry.
19070
19071 @item p
19072 Permanent score entry.
19073
19074 @item i
19075 Immediately scoring.
19076 @end table
19077
19078 @item
19079 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19080 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19081 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19082
19083 @end enumerate
19084
19085 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19086 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19087 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19088 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19089
19090 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19091 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19092 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19093 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19094 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19095
19096 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19097 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19098 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19099 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19100 current score file.
19101
19102 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19103 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19104 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19105
19106
19107 @node Group Score Commands
19108 @section Group Score Commands
19109 @cindex group score commands
19110
19111 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19112
19113 @table @kbd
19114
19115 @item W f
19116 @kindex W f (Group)
19117 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19118 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19119 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19120 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19121
19122 @end table
19123
19124 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19125
19126 @findex gnus-batch-score
19127 @cindex batch scoring
19128 @example
19129 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19130 @end example
19131
19132
19133 @node Score Variables
19134 @section Score Variables
19135 @cindex score variables
19136
19137 @table @code
19138
19139 @item gnus-use-scoring
19140 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19141 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19142 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19143
19144 @item gnus-kill-killed
19145 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19146 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19147 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19148 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19149 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19150 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19151 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19152
19153 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19154 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19155 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19156 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19157 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19158
19159 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19160 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19161 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19162 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19163
19164 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19165 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19166 @cindex score cache
19167 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19168 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19169 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19170 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19171 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19172 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19173 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19174 be cached.
19175
19176 @item gnus-save-score
19177 @vindex gnus-save-score
19178 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19179 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19180 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19181
19182 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19183 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19184 across group visits.
19185
19186 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19187 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19188 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19189 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19190 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19191 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19192 manually entered data.
19193
19194 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19195 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19196 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19197
19198 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19199 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19200 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19201 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19202 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19203 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19204
19205 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19206 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19207 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19208 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19209
19210 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19211 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19212 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19213 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19214
19215 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19216 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19217 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19218 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19219
19220 Predefined functions available are:
19221 @table @code
19222
19223 @item gnus-score-find-single
19224 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19225 Only apply the group's own score file.
19226
19227 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19228 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19229 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19230 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19231 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19232 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19233 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19234 then a regexp match is done.
19235
19236 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19237 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19238
19239 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19240 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19241 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19242 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19243
19244 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19245 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19246 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19247 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19248 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19249 server.
19250
19251 @end table
19252 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19253 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19254 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19255 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19256 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19257 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19258 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19259 Phu.
19260
19261 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19262 overall score file, you could use the value
19263 @example
19264 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19265 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19266 @end example
19267
19268 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19269 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19270 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19271 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19272 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19273
19274 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19275 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19276 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19277 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19278 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19279 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19280 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19281 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19282
19283 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19284 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19285 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19286
19287 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19288 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19289 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19290 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19291 threading---according to the current value of
19292 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19293 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19294 simplified in this manner.
19295
19296 @end table
19297
19298
19299 @node Score File Format
19300 @section Score File Format
19301 @cindex score file format
19302
19303 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19304 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19305 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19306
19307 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19308
19309 @lisp
19310 (("from"
19311 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19312 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19313 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19314 ("subject"
19315 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19316 ("xref"
19317 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19318 ("lines"
19319 (2 -100 nil <))
19320 (mark 0)
19321 (expunge -1000)
19322 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19323 (read-only nil)
19324 (orphan -10)
19325 (adapt t)
19326 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19327 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19328 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19329 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19330 (eval (ding)))
19331 @end lisp
19332
19333 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19334 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19335
19336 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19337 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19338 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19339
19340 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19341
19342 @table @code
19343
19344 @item STRING
19345 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19346 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19347 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19348 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19349 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19350 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19351 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19352 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19353 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19354 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19355 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19356 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19357 to articles that matches these score entries.
19358
19359 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19360 score entry has one to four elements.
19361 @enumerate
19362
19363 @item
19364 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19365 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19366 integer.
19367
19368 @item
19369 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19370 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19371 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19372 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19373 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19374 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19375
19376 @item
19377 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19378 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19379 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19380 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19381 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19382
19383 @item
19384 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19385 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19386 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19387 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19388 @table @dfn
19389
19390 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19391 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19392 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19393 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19394 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19395 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19396 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19397 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19398 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19399 instead, if you feel like.
19400
19401 @item Extra
19402 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19403 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19404 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19405 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19406 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19407 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19408 overviews:
19409
19410 @lisp
19411 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19412 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19413 @end lisp
19414
19415 @item Lines, Chars
19416 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19417 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19418
19419 These predicates are true if
19420
19421 @example
19422 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19423 @end example
19424
19425 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19426 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19427 following form:
19428
19429 @lisp
19430 (< header-value 4)
19431 @end lisp
19432
19433 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19434 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19435 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19436 it's not. I think.)
19437
19438 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19439 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19440 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19441 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19442
19443 @item Date
19444 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19445 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19446 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19447 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19448 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19449 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19450 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19451
19452 @cindex ISO8601
19453 @cindex date
19454 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19455 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19456 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19457 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19458 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19459 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19460 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19461 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19462 whole family, eh?)
19463
19464 @item Head, Body, All
19465 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19466 header uses.
19467
19468 @item Followup
19469 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19470 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19471 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19472 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19473 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19474 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19475 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19476 files.)
19477
19478 @item Thread
19479 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19480 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19481 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19482 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19483 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19484 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19485 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19486 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19487 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19488 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19489 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19490 @end table
19491 @end enumerate
19492
19493 @cindex score file atoms
19494 @item mark
19495 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19496 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19497
19498 @item expunge
19499 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19500 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19501
19502 @item mark-and-expunge
19503 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19504 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19505 summary buffer.
19506
19507 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19508 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19509 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19510 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19511 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19512
19513 @item files
19514 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19515 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19516 this one was.
19517
19518 @item exclude-files
19519 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19520 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19521 other.
19522
19523 @item eval
19524 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19525 ignored when handling global score files.
19526
19527 @item read-only
19528 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19529 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19530 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19531 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19532
19533 @item orphan
19534 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19535 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19536 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19537 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19538
19539 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19540
19541 @example
19542 (orphan -500)
19543 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19544 @end example
19545
19546 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19547 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19548 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19549 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19550 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19551
19552 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19553 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19554 scoring rules exist.
19555
19556 @item adapt
19557 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19558 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19559 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19560 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19561 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19562 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19563 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19564 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19565 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19566 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19567 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19568 it.
19569
19570 @item adapt-file
19571 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19572 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19573 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19574 file for a number of groups.
19575
19576 @item local
19577 @cindex local variables
19578 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19579 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19580 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19581 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19582 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19583 be evaluated.
19584 @end table
19585
19586
19587 @node Score File Editing
19588 @section Score File Editing
19589
19590 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19591 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19592 with a mode for that.
19593
19594 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19595 additional commands:
19596
19597 @table @kbd
19598
19599 @item C-c C-c
19600 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19601 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19602 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19603 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19604
19605 @item C-c C-d
19606 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19607 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19608 Insert the current date in numerical format
19609 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19610 you were wondering.
19611
19612 @item C-c C-p
19613 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19614 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19615 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19616 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19617 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19618 you.
19619
19620 @end table
19621
19622 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19623
19624 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19625 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19626
19627 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19628 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19629
19630
19631 @node Adaptive Scoring
19632 @section Adaptive Scoring
19633 @cindex adaptive scoring
19634
19635 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19636 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19637 stupidity, to be precise.
19638
19639 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19640 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19641 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19642 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19643 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19644 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19645 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19646 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19647 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19648
19649 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19650 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19651 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19652 might look something like this:
19653
19654 @lisp
19655 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19656 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19657 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19658 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19659 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19660 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19661 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19662 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19663 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19664 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19665 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19666 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19667 @end lisp
19668
19669 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19670 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19671 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19672 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19673 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19674 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19675 entries.
19676
19677 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19678 will be applied to each article.
19679
19680 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19681 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19682 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19683 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19684
19685 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19686 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19687 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19688 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19689
19690 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19691 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19692 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19693 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19694
19695 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19696 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19697 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19698 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19699 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19700 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19701
19702 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19703 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19704 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19705
19706 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19707 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19708 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19709
19710 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19711 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19712 let you use different rules in different groups.
19713
19714 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19715 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19716 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19717 is @file{ADAPT}.
19718
19719 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19720 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19721 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19722 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19723 the length of the match is less than
19724 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19725 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19726 this problem.
19727
19728 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19729 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19730 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19731 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19732 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19733
19734 @lisp
19735 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19736 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19737 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19738 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19739 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19740 @end lisp
19741
19742 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19743 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19744 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19745 score with 30 points.
19746
19747 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19748 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19749 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19750 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19751 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19752
19753 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19754 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19755 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19756 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19757 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19758
19759 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19760 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19761 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19762 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19763
19764 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19765 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19766 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19767 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19768
19769 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19770 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19771 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19772 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19773 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19774
19775 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19776 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19777 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19778
19779 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19780 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19781 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19782 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19783
19784
19785 @node Home Score File
19786 @section Home Score File
19787
19788 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19789 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19790 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19791 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19792
19793 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19794 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19795 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19796
19797 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19798 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19799 be:
19800
19801 @enumerate
19802 @item
19803 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19804 groups.
19805
19806 @item
19807 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19808 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19809 parameter.
19810
19811 @item
19812 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19813
19814 @enumerate
19815 @item
19816 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19817 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19818
19819 @item
19820 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19821 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19822 name of the group as the parameter.
19823
19824 @item
19825 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19826 @end enumerate
19827
19828 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19829 for matches.
19830
19831 @end enumerate
19832
19833 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19834
19835 @lisp
19836 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19837 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19838 @end lisp
19839
19840 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19841 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19842
19843 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19844 @lisp
19845 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19846 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19847 @end lisp
19848
19849 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19850 Other functions include
19851
19852 @table @code
19853 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19854 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19855 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19856 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19857
19858 @end table
19859
19860 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19861 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19862 their own home score files:
19863
19864 @lisp
19865 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19866 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19867 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19868 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19869 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19870 @end lisp
19871
19872 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19873 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19874 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19875 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19876 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19877
19878 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19879 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19880 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19881 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19882 precedence over this variable.
19883
19884
19885 @node Followups To Yourself
19886 @section Followups To Yourself
19887
19888 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19889 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19890 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19891 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19892 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19893 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19894
19895 @table @code
19896
19897 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19898 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19899 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19900 article.
19901
19902 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19903 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19904 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19905 your own article.
19906 @end table
19907
19908 @vindex message-sent-hook
19909 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19910 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19911 @lisp
19912 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19913 @end lisp
19914
19915
19916 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19917 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19918 mine:
19919
19920 @example
19921 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19922 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19923 @end example
19924
19925 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19926 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19927 myself:
19928
19929 @lisp
19930 ("references"
19931 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19932 1000 nil r))
19933 @end lisp
19934
19935 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19936 is system-dependent.
19937
19938
19939 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19940 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19941 @cindex scoring on other headers
19942
19943 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19944 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19945 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19946 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19947 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19948
19949 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19950 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19951 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19952 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19953 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19954
19955 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19956
19957 @lisp
19958 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19959 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19960 @end lisp
19961
19962 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19963 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19964 time if you have much mail.
19965
19966 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19967 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19968
19969 See? Simple.
19970
19971
19972 @node Scoring Tips
19973 @section Scoring Tips
19974 @cindex scoring tips
19975
19976 @table @dfn
19977
19978 @item Crossposts
19979 @cindex crossposts
19980 @cindex scoring crossposts
19981 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19982 the @code{Xref} header.
19983 @lisp
19984 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19985 @end lisp
19986
19987 @item Multiple crossposts
19988 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19989 more than, say, 3 groups:
19990 @lisp
19991 ("xref"
19992 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19993 -1000 nil r))
19994 @end lisp
19995
19996 @item Matching on the body
19997 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19998 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19999 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20000 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20001 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20002 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20003 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20004 the matches.
20005
20006 @item Marking as read
20007 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20008 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20009 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20010 @lisp
20011 ((mark -100))
20012 @end lisp
20013 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20014
20015 @item Negated character classes
20016 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20017 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20018 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20019 @end table
20020
20021
20022 @node Reverse Scoring
20023 @section Reverse Scoring
20024 @cindex reverse scoring
20025
20026 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20027 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20028 like this in your score file:
20029
20030 @lisp
20031 (("subject"
20032 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20033 (mark 1)
20034 (expunge 1))
20035 @end lisp
20036
20037 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20038 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20039
20040
20041 @node Global Score Files
20042 @section Global Score Files
20043 @cindex global score files
20044
20045 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20046 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20047 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20048
20049 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20050 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20051 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20052
20053 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20054 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20055 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20056 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20057 files are applicable to which group.
20058
20059 To use the score file
20060 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20061 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20062 say this:
20063
20064 @lisp
20065 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20066 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20067 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20068 @end lisp
20069
20070 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20071 @noindent
20072 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20073 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20074 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20075 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20076
20077 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20078 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20079
20080 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20081 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20082 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20083 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20084 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20085 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20086
20087 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20088 head:
20089
20090 @itemize @bullet
20091
20092 @item
20093 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20094 @item
20095 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20096 @item
20097 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20098 @item
20099 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20100 lowered out of existence.
20101 @item
20102 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20103 articles completely.
20104
20105 @item
20106 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20107 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20108 old articles for a long time.
20109 @end itemize
20110
20111 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20112 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20113 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20114 holding our breath yet?
20115
20116
20117 @node Kill Files
20118 @section Kill Files
20119 @cindex kill files
20120
20121 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20122 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20123 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20124
20125 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20126 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20127 files into score files.
20128
20129 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20130 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20131 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20132 that isn't a very good idea.
20133
20134 Normal kill files look like this:
20135
20136 @lisp
20137 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20138 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20139 (gnus-expunge "X")
20140 @end lisp
20141
20142 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20143 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20144
20145 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20146 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20147 interpreting it.
20148
20149 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20150
20151 @table @kbd
20152
20153 @item M-k
20154 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20155 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20156 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20157
20158 @item M-K
20159 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20160 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20161 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20162 @end table
20163
20164 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20165
20166 @table @kbd
20167
20168 @item M-k
20169 @kindex M-k (Group)
20170 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20171 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20172
20173 @item M-K
20174 @kindex M-K (Group)
20175 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20176 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20177 @end table
20178
20179 Kill file variables:
20180
20181 @table @code
20182 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20183 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20184 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20185 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20186 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20187 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20188 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20189
20190 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20191 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20192 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20193 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20194 kills.
20195
20196 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20197 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20198 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20199 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20200 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20201 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20202 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20203 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20204 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20205
20206 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20207 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20208 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20209
20210 @end table
20211
20212
20213 @node Converting Kill Files
20214 @section Converting Kill Files
20215 @cindex kill files
20216 @cindex converting kill files
20217
20218 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20219 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20220 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20221 by hand.
20222
20223 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20224 You can fetch it from
20225 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20226
20227 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20228 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20229 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20230 before.
20231
20232
20233 @node GroupLens
20234 @section GroupLens
20235 @cindex GroupLens
20236
20237 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20238 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20239
20240 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20241 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20242 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20243 news articles generated every day.
20244
20245 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20246 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20247 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20248 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20249 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20250 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20251 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20252 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20253 article.
20254
20255 @menu
20256 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20257 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20258 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20259 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20260 @end menu
20261
20262
20263 @node Using GroupLens
20264 @subsection Using GroupLens
20265
20266 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20267 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20268 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20269
20270 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20271
20272 @table @code
20273
20274 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20275 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20276 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20277 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20278
20279 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20280 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20281 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20282 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20283
20284 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20285 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20286 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20287
20288 @end table
20289
20290 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20291 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20292 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20293 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20294 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20295 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20296
20297
20298 @node Rating Articles
20299 @subsection Rating Articles
20300
20301 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20302 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20303 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20304 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20305 like this one?''
20306
20307 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20308
20309 @table @kbd
20310
20311 @item r
20312 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20313 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20314 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20315
20316 @item k
20317 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20318 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20319 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20320 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20321 threads in rec.humor.
20322
20323 @end table
20324
20325 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20326 the score of the article you're reading.
20327
20328 @table @kbd
20329
20330 @item 1-5 n
20331 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20332 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20333 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20334
20335 @item 1-5 ,
20336 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20337 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20338 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20339
20340 @end table
20341
20342 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20343 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20344
20345
20346 @node Displaying Predictions
20347 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20348
20349 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20350 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20351 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20352 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20353 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20354
20355 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20356 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20357 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20358 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20359 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20360 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20361 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20362 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20363 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20364 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20365 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20366 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20367 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20368
20369 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20370 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20371 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20372 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20373
20374 The following are valid values for that variable.
20375
20376 @table @code
20377 @item prediction-spot
20378 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20379 displayed.
20380
20381 @item confidence-interval
20382 A numeric confidence interval.
20383
20384 @item prediction-bar
20385 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20386
20387 @item confidence-bar
20388 Numerical confidence.
20389
20390 @item confidence-spot
20391 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20392
20393 @item prediction-num
20394 Plain-old numeric value.
20395
20396 @item confidence-plus-minus
20397 Prediction +/- confidence.
20398
20399 @end table
20400
20401
20402 @node GroupLens Variables
20403 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20404
20405 @table @code
20406
20407 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20408 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20409 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20410 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20411 %s\n}.
20412
20413 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20414 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20415 default.
20416
20417 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20418 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20419
20420 @item grouplens-score-offset
20421 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20422 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20423 default is 0.
20424
20425 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20426 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20427 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20428
20429 @end table
20430
20431
20432 @node Advanced Scoring
20433 @section Advanced Scoring
20434
20435 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20436 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20437 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20438 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20439 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20440
20441 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20442 scoring patterns.
20443
20444 @menu
20445 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20446 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20447 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20448 @end menu
20449
20450
20451 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20452 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20453
20454 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20455 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20456 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20457 non-@code{nil} value.
20458
20459 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20460 operator, and various match operators.
20461
20462 Logical operators:
20463
20464 @table @code
20465 @item &
20466 @itemx and
20467 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20468 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20469 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20470 @code{true}.
20471
20472 @item |
20473 @itemx or
20474 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20475 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20476 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20477
20478 @item !
20479 @itemx not
20480 @itemx ¬
20481 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20482 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20483
20484 @end table
20485
20486 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20487 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20488 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20489 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20490 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20491 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20492 the ancestry you want to go.
20493
20494 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20495 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20496 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20497 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20498 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20499
20500
20501 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20502 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20503
20504 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20505 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20506 of parentheses.
20507
20508 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20509 when he's talking about Gnus:
20510
20511 @example
20512 @group
20513 ((&
20514 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20515 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20516 1000)
20517 @end group
20518 @end example
20519
20520 Quite simple, huh?
20521
20522 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20523
20524 @example
20525 ((&
20526 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20527 (|
20528 ("subject" "Gnus")
20529 ("lines" 100 >)))
20530 1000)
20531 @end example
20532
20533 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20534 really don't want to read what he's written:
20535
20536 @example
20537 ((&
20538 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20539 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20540 -100000)
20541 @end example
20542
20543 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20544 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20545 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20546 very interesting:
20547
20548 @example
20549 ((&
20550 (1-
20551 (&
20552 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20553 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20554 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20555 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20556 1000)
20557 @end example
20558
20559 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20560 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20561 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20562 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20563
20564 @example
20565 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20566 -200)
20567 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20568 200)
20569 @end example
20570
20571 The possibilities are endless.
20572
20573 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20574 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20575
20576 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20577 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20578 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20579 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20580 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20581 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20582 @samp{subject}) first.
20583
20584 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20585 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20586 something like:
20587
20588 @example
20589 ...
20590 (1-
20591 (1-
20592 ("from" "lars")))
20593 ...
20594 @end example
20595
20596 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20597 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20598
20599 @example
20600 (1-
20601 (&
20602 ("from" "Lars")
20603 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20604 @end example
20605
20606 than it is to say:
20607
20608 @example
20609 (&
20610 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20611 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20612 @end example
20613
20614
20615 @node Score Decays
20616 @section Score Decays
20617 @cindex score decays
20618 @cindex decays
20619
20620 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20621 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20622 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20623 use them in any sensible way.
20624
20625 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20626 @findex gnus-decay-score
20627 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20628 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20629 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20630 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20631 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20632 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20633 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20634 definition of that function:
20635
20636 @lisp
20637 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20638 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20639 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20640 (let ((n (- score
20641 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20642 (min (abs score)
20643 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20644 (* (abs score)
20645 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20646 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20647 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20648 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20649 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20650 (string-to-number
20651 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20652 (floor n))))
20653 @end lisp
20654
20655 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20656 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20657 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20658 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20659
20660 @enumerate
20661 @item
20662 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20663
20664 @item
20665 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20666
20667 @item
20668 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20669 score.
20670 @end enumerate
20671
20672 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20673 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20674 the new score, which should be an integer.
20675
20676 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20677 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20678
20679 @iftex
20680 @iflatex
20681 @chapter Message
20682 @include message.texi
20683 @chapter Emacs MIME
20684 @include emacs-mime.texi
20685 @chapter Sieve
20686 @include sieve.texi
20687 @chapter PGG
20688 @include pgg.texi
20689 @end iflatex
20690 @end iftex
20691
20692 @node Various
20693 @chapter Various
20694
20695 @menu
20696 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20697 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20698 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20699 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20700 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20701 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20702 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20703 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20704 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20705 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20706 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20707 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20708 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20709 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20710 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20711 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20712 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20713 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20714 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20715 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20716 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20717 @end menu
20718
20719
20720 @node Process/Prefix
20721 @section Process/Prefix
20722 @cindex process/prefix convention
20723
20724 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20725 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20726
20727 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20728 command to be performed on.
20729
20730 It goes like this:
20731
20732 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20733 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20734 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20735 with the current one.
20736
20737 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20738 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20739 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20740
20741 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20742 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20743 the process mark.
20744
20745 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20746 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20747
20748 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20749 are avoided.
20750
20751 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20752 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20753 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20754 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20755
20756 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20757 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20758 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20759 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20760 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20761 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20762 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20763 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20764
20765 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20766 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20767 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20768 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20769 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20770
20771
20772 @node Interactive
20773 @section Interactive
20774 @cindex interaction
20775
20776 @table @code
20777
20778 @item gnus-novice-user
20779 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20780 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20781 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20782 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20783 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20784 default.
20785
20786 @item gnus-expert-user
20787 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20788 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20789 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20790 matter how strange.
20791
20792 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20793 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20794 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20795 is @code{t} by default.
20796
20797 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20798 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20799 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20800 default.
20801 @end table
20802
20803
20804 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20805 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20806 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20807
20808 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20809 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20810 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20811 rule of 900 to the current article.
20812
20813 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20814 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20815 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20816 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20817 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20818 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20819 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20820
20821 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20822 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20823 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20824 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20825 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20826 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20827 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20828 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20829 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20830
20831 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20832 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20833 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20834
20835 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20836 Interactive}.
20837
20838
20839 @node Formatting Variables
20840 @section Formatting Variables
20841 @cindex formatting variables
20842
20843 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20844 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20845 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20846 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20847 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20848 be annoyed by.
20849
20850 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20851 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20852 lots of percentages everywhere.
20853
20854 @menu
20855 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20856 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20857 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20858 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20859 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20860 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20861 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20862 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20863 @end menu
20864
20865 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20866 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20867 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20868 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20869 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20870 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20871 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20872 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20873
20874 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20875 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20876
20877 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20878 @findex gnus-update-format
20879 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20880 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20881 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20882 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20883
20884
20885
20886 @node Formatting Basics
20887 @subsection Formatting Basics
20888
20889 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20890 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20891 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20892
20893 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20894 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20895 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20896 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20897 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20898 the right instead.
20899
20900 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20901 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20902 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20903 less than 4 characters wide.
20904
20905 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20906 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20907
20908
20909 @node Mode Line Formatting
20910 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20911
20912 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20913 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20914 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20915 with the following two differences:
20916
20917 @enumerate
20918
20919 @item
20920 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20921
20922 @item
20923 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20924 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20925 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20926 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20927 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20928 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20929 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20930
20931 @end enumerate
20932
20933
20934 @node Advanced Formatting
20935 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20936
20937 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20938 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20939 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20940 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20941
20942 These are the valid modifiers:
20943
20944 @table @code
20945 @item pad
20946 @itemx pad-left
20947 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20948 length.
20949
20950 @item pad-right
20951 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20952 length.
20953
20954 @item max
20955 @itemx max-left
20956 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20957
20958 @item max-right
20959 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20960 length.
20961
20962 @item cut
20963 @itemx cut-left
20964 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20965
20966 @item cut-right
20967 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20968
20969 @item ignore
20970 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20971
20972 @item form
20973 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20974 used.
20975
20976 Here's an example:
20977
20978 @lisp
20979 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20980 @end lisp
20981
20982 @end table
20983
20984 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20985 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20986 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20987 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20988 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20989 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20990 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20991
20992 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20993 last operation, padding.
20994
20995 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20996 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20997 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20998 @xref{Compilation}.
20999
21000
21001 @node User-Defined Specs
21002 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21003
21004 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21005 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21006 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21007 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21008 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21009 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21010 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21011 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21012 should protect against that.
21013
21014 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21015 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21016
21017 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21018 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21019 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21020 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21021 inserted.
21022
21023
21024 @node Formatting Fonts
21025 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21026
21027 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21028 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21029 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21030 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21031 over it.
21032
21033 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21034 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21035 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21036 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21037 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21038 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21039
21040 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21041 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21042 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21043 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21044 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21045 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21046 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21047 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21048 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21049 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21050 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21051 paragraph.)
21052
21053 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21054
21055 @lisp
21056 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21057 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21058 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21059
21060 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21061 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21062 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21063 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21064 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21065 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21066 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21067
21068 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21069 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21070 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21071 @end lisp
21072
21073 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21074 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21075
21076 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21077 mode-line variables.
21078
21079 @node Positioning Point
21080 @subsection Positioning Point
21081
21082 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21083 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21084 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21085
21086 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21087
21088 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21089 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21090 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21091
21092 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21093 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21094 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21095 place point there.
21096
21097
21098 @node Tabulation
21099 @subsection Tabulation
21100
21101 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21102 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21103 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21104 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21105
21106 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21107 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21108
21109 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21110 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21111 This is the soft tabulator.
21112
21113 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21114 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21115 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21116
21117
21118 @node Wide Characters
21119 @subsection Wide Characters
21120
21121 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21122 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21123 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21124
21125 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21126 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21127 these countries, that's not true.
21128
21129 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21130 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21131 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21132 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21133 for Emacs.
21134
21135
21136 @node Window Layout
21137 @section Window Layout
21138 @cindex window layout
21139
21140 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21141
21142 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21143 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21144 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21145 @code{t} by default.
21146
21147 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21148 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21149
21150 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21151 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21152 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21153
21154 @lisp
21155 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21156 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21157 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21158 (article 1.0))))
21159 @end lisp
21160
21161 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21162 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21163 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21164 possible names is listed below.
21165
21166 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21167 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21168
21169 @lisp
21170 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21171 (article 1.0)))
21172 @end lisp
21173
21174 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21175 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21176 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21177 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21178 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21179 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21180 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21181 size spec per split.
21182
21183 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21184 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21185 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21186 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21187 present) gets focus.
21188
21189 Here's a more complicated example:
21190
21191 @lisp
21192 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21193 (summary 0.25 point)
21194 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21195 (article 1.0)))
21196 @end lisp
21197
21198 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21199 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21200 occupy, not a percentage.
21201
21202 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21203 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21204 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21205 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21206 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21207 is non-@code{nil}.
21208
21209 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21210
21211 @lisp
21212 (article (horizontal 1.0
21213 (vertical 0.5
21214 (group 1.0)
21215 (gnus-carpal 4))
21216 (vertical 1.0
21217 (summary 0.25 point)
21218 (summary-carpal 4)
21219 (article 1.0))))
21220 @end lisp
21221
21222 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21223 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21224
21225 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21226 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21227 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21228 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21229 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21230
21231 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21232 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21233 lines from the splits.
21234
21235 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21236 may look like:
21237
21238 @example
21239 @group
21240 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21241 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21242 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21243 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21244 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21245 size = number | frame-params
21246 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21247 @end group
21248 @end example
21249
21250 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21251 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21252 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21253 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21254
21255 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21256 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21257 @cindex window height
21258 @cindex window width
21259 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21260 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21261 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21262 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21263 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21264 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21265
21266 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21267 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21268 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21269 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21270
21271 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21272 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21273 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21274 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21275 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21276 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21277 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21278 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21279 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21280 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21281 configuration list.
21282
21283 @lisp
21284 (gnus-configure-frame
21285 '(horizontal 1.0
21286 (vertical 10
21287 (group 1.0)
21288 (article 0.3 point))
21289 (vertical 1.0
21290 (article 1.0)
21291 (horizontal 4
21292 (group 1.0)
21293 (article 10)))))
21294 @end lisp
21295
21296 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21297 @code{frame} split:
21298
21299 @lisp
21300 (gnus-configure-frame
21301 '(frame 1.0
21302 (vertical 1.0
21303 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21304 (article 1.0))
21305 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21306 (user-position . t)
21307 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21308 (picon 1.0))))
21309
21310 @end lisp
21311
21312 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21313 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21314 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21315 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21316 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21317 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21318 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21319 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21320 is such a plist.
21321 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21322 be found in its default value.
21323
21324 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21325 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21326 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21327 might be used:
21328
21329 @lisp
21330 (message (horizontal 1.0
21331 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21332 (vertical 0.24
21333 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21334 '(summary 0.5))
21335 (group 1.0))))
21336 @end lisp
21337
21338 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21339 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21340 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21341
21342 @lisp
21343 (message
21344 (frame 1.0
21345 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21346 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21347 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21348 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21349 (name . "Message"))
21350 (message 1.0 point))))
21351 @end lisp
21352
21353 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21354 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21355 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21356 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21357 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21358
21359 @lisp
21360 (gnus-add-configuration
21361 '(article (vertical 1.0
21362 (group 4)
21363 (summary .25 point)
21364 (article 1.0))))
21365 @end lisp
21366
21367 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21368 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21369 Gnus has been loaded.
21370
21371 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21372 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21373 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21374 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21375 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21376
21377 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21378 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21379 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21380 windows resized.
21381
21382 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21383
21384 @itemize @bullet
21385 @item
21386 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21387 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21388
21389 @ifinfo
21390 @example
21391 +---+---------+
21392 | G | Summary |
21393 | r +---------+
21394 | o | |
21395 | u | Article |
21396 | p | |
21397 +---+---------+
21398 @end example
21399 @end ifinfo
21400
21401 @lisp
21402 (gnus-add-configuration
21403 '(article
21404 (horizontal 1.0
21405 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21406 (vertical 1.0
21407 (summary 0.16 point)
21408 (article 1.0)))))
21409
21410 (gnus-add-configuration
21411 '(summary
21412 (horizontal 1.0
21413 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21414 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21415 @end lisp
21416
21417 @end itemize
21418
21419
21420 @node Faces and Fonts
21421 @section Faces and Fonts
21422 @cindex faces
21423 @cindex fonts
21424 @cindex colors
21425
21426 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21427 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21428 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21429 interface.
21430
21431
21432 @node Compilation
21433 @section Compilation
21434 @cindex compilation
21435 @cindex byte-compilation
21436
21437 @findex gnus-compile
21438
21439 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21440 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21441 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21442 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21443 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21444 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21445 course.)
21446
21447 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21448 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21449 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21450 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21451 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21452 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21453 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21454
21455
21456 @node Mode Lines
21457 @section Mode Lines
21458 @cindex mode lines
21459
21460 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21461 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21462 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21463 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21464 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21465 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21466 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21467 quicker.
21468
21469 @cindex display-time
21470
21471 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21472 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21473 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21474 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21475 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21476 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21477 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21478 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21479 this variable:
21480
21481 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21482 @lisp
21483 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21484 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21485 (+ 21
21486 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21487 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21488 (length display-time-string)))))
21489 @end lisp
21490
21491 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21492 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21493 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21494 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21495 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21496
21497
21498 @node Highlighting and Menus
21499 @section Highlighting and Menus
21500 @cindex visual
21501 @cindex highlighting
21502 @cindex menus
21503
21504 @vindex gnus-visual
21505 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21506 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21507 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21508 file.
21509
21510 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21511 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21512
21513 @table @code
21514 @item group-highlight
21515 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21516 @item summary-highlight
21517 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21518 @item article-highlight
21519 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21520 @item highlight
21521 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21522 @item group-menu
21523 Create menus in the group buffer.
21524 @item summary-menu
21525 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21526 @item article-menu
21527 Create menus in the article buffer.
21528 @item browse-menu
21529 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21530 @item server-menu
21531 Create menus in the server buffer.
21532 @item score-menu
21533 Create menus in the score buffers.
21534 @item menu
21535 Create menus in all buffers.
21536 @end table
21537
21538 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21539 buffers, you could say something like:
21540
21541 @lisp
21542 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21543 @end lisp
21544
21545 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21546
21547 @lisp
21548 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21549 @end lisp
21550
21551 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21552 in all Gnus buffers.
21553
21554 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21555
21556 @table @code
21557 @item gnus-mouse-face
21558 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21559 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21560 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21561
21562 @end table
21563
21564 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21565
21566 @table @code
21567
21568 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21569 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21570 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21571
21572 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21573 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21574 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21575
21576 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21577 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21578 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21579
21580 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21581 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21582 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21583
21584 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21585 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21586 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21587
21588 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21589 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21590 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21591
21592 @end table
21593
21594
21595 @node Buttons
21596 @section Buttons
21597 @cindex buttons
21598 @cindex mouse
21599 @cindex click
21600
21601 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21602 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21603 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21604 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21605 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21606
21607 Right.
21608
21609 @vindex gnus-carpal
21610 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21611 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21612 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21613
21614
21615 @table @code
21616
21617 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21618 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21619 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21620
21621 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21622 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21623 Face used on buttons.
21624
21625 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21626 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21627 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21628
21629 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21630 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21631 Buttons in the group buffer.
21632
21633 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21634 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21635 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21636
21637 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21638 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21639 Buttons in the server buffer.
21640
21641 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21642 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21643 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21644 @end table
21645
21646 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21647 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21648 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21649
21650
21651 @node Daemons
21652 @section Daemons
21653 @cindex demons
21654 @cindex daemons
21655
21656 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21657 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21658 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21659 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21660 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21661
21662 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21663 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21664 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21665
21666 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21667 been idle for thirty minutes:
21668
21669 @lisp
21670 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21671 @end lisp
21672
21673 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21674 Emacs is idle:
21675
21676 @lisp
21677 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21678 @end lisp
21679
21680 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21681 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21682 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21683
21684 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21685 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21686 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21687 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21688
21689 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21690 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21691 @var{idle} minutes.
21692
21693 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21694 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21695 minutes.
21696
21697 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21698 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21699 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21700
21701 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21702 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21703 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21704 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21705
21706 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21707 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21708
21709 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21710 @lisp
21711 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21712 @end lisp
21713
21714 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21715 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21716 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21717 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21718 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21719 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21720 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21721 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21722 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21723 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21724 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21725
21726 @findex gnus-demon-init
21727 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21728 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21729 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21730 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21731 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21732
21733 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21734 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21735 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21736 behave.
21737
21738
21739 @node NoCeM
21740 @section NoCeM
21741 @cindex nocem
21742 @cindex spam
21743
21744 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21745 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21746
21747 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21748 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21749 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21750 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21751 away.
21752
21753 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21754 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21755 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21756 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21757
21758 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21759 this will make spam disappear.
21760
21761 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21762
21763 @table @code
21764 @item gnus-use-nocem
21765 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21766 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21767 by default.
21768
21769 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21770 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21771 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21772 default is
21773 @lisp
21774 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21775 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21776 @end lisp
21777
21778 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21779 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21780 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21781 people you want to listen to. The default is
21782 @lisp
21783 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21784 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21785 @end lisp
21786 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21787
21788 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21789 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21790
21791 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21792 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21793 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21794 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21795 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21796 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21797 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21798 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21799 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21800 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21801
21802 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21803 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21804
21805 @lisp
21806 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21807 @end lisp
21808
21809 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21810 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21811
21812 @lisp
21813 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21814 @end lisp
21815
21816 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21817
21818
21819 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21820 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21821 @findex pgg-verify
21822 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21823 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21824 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21825 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21826 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21827 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21828
21829 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21830 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21831 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21832 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21833
21834 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21835 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21836 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21837 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21838
21839 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21840 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21841 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21842 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21843 might then see old spam.
21844
21845 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21846 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21847 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21848 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21849 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21850 issuers.
21851
21852 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21853 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21854 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21855 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21856
21857 @end table
21858
21859 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21860 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21861 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21862 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21863
21864
21865 @node Undo
21866 @section Undo
21867 @cindex undo
21868
21869 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21870 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21871 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21872
21873 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21874 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21875 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21876 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21877 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21878 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21879 @code{undo} function.
21880
21881 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21882 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21883 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21884 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21885 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21886 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21887 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21888 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21889 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21890 never be totally undoable.
21891
21892 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21893 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21894 @findex gnus-undo
21895 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21896 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21897 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21898 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21899 command.
21900
21901
21902 @node Predicate Specifiers
21903 @section Predicate Specifiers
21904 @cindex predicate specifiers
21905
21906 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21907 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21908 to type all that much.
21909
21910 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21911
21912 Here's an example:
21913
21914 @lisp
21915 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21916 gnus-article-unread-p)
21917 @end lisp
21918
21919 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21920 functions all take one parameter.
21921
21922 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21923 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21924 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21925 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21926 specifier.
21927
21928
21929 @node Moderation
21930 @section Moderation
21931 @cindex moderation
21932
21933 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21934 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21935 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21936 get a copy.
21937
21938 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21939 buffers. Put
21940
21941 @lisp
21942 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21943 @end lisp
21944
21945 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21946
21947 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21948 supposed to work:
21949
21950 @enumerate
21951 @item
21952 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21953 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21954 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21955
21956 @item
21957 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21958 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21959
21960 @item
21961 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21962 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21963 @kbd{c} command.
21964 @end enumerate
21965
21966 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21967
21968 @lisp
21969 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21970 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21971 @end lisp
21972
21973
21974 @node Fetching a Group
21975 @section Fetching a Group
21976 @cindex fetching a group
21977
21978 @findex gnus-fetch-group
21979 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
21980 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
21981 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
21982 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
21983 It takes the group name as a parameter.
21984
21985
21986 @node Image Enhancements
21987 @section Image Enhancements
21988
21989 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21990 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21991 taken advantage of that.
21992
21993 @menu
21994 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21995 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21996 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21997 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21998 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21999 @end menu
22000
22001
22002 @node X-Face
22003 @subsection X-Face
22004 @cindex x-face
22005
22006 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22007 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22008 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22009 readers.
22010
22011 @cindex x-face
22012 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22013 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22014 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22015 @iftex
22016 @iflatex
22017 \include{xface}
22018 @end iflatex
22019 @end iftex
22020 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22021
22022 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22023 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22024 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
22025 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
22026
22027 The variable that controls this is the
22028 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
22029 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22030 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22031 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
22032 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22033
22034 The default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22035 @code{display} program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick
22036 package. For the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look
22037 for a package like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux
22038 system.} to view the face.
22039
22040 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
22041 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
22042 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
22043 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
22044 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
22045 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
22046 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
22047 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
22048
22049 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22050 @code{xface}).
22051
22052 @noindent
22053 Face and variable:
22054
22055 @table @code
22056 @item gnus-x-face
22057 @vindex gnus-x-face
22058 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22059 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22060 default colors are black and white.
22061 @end table
22062
22063 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22064 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
22065
22066 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22067 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22068 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22069 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22070 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22071 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22072 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22073 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22074 header data as a string.
22075
22076 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22077 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22078 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22079 randomly generated data.
22080
22081 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22082 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22083 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22084 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22085 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22086
22087 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22088 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22089
22090 @lisp
22091 (setq message-required-news-headers
22092 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22093 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22094 @end lisp
22095
22096 Using the last function would be something like this:
22097
22098 @lisp
22099 (setq message-required-news-headers
22100 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22101 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22102 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22103 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22104 @end lisp
22105
22106
22107 @node Face
22108 @subsection Face
22109 @cindex face
22110
22111 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
22112
22113 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22114 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22115 represent the author of the message.
22116
22117 @cindex face
22118 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22119 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22120 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22121 specifications.
22122
22123 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22124 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22125
22126 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22127 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22128 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22129
22130 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22131 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22132 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22133 converts the file to Face format by using the
22134 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22135
22136 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22137 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22138
22139 @lisp
22140 (setq message-required-news-headers
22141 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22142 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22143 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22144 @end lisp
22145
22146
22147 @node Smileys
22148 @subsection Smileys
22149 @cindex smileys
22150
22151 @iftex
22152 @iflatex
22153 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22154 \input{smiley}
22155 @end iflatex
22156 @end iftex
22157
22158 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22159 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22160
22161 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22162 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22163
22164 @lisp
22165 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22166 @end lisp
22167
22168 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22169 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22170 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22171 text and maps that to file names.
22172
22173 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22174 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22175 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22176 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22177 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22178 displayed.
22179
22180 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22181 files:
22182
22183 @table @code
22184
22185 @item smiley-data-directory
22186 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22187 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22188
22189 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22190 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22191 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22192
22193 @end table
22194
22195
22196 @node Picons
22197 @subsection Picons
22198
22199 @iftex
22200 @iflatex
22201 \include{picons}
22202 @end iflatex
22203 @end iftex
22204
22205 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22206 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22207 over your shoulder as you read news.
22208
22209 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22210
22211 @iftex
22212 @iflatex
22213 \margindex{}
22214 @end iflatex
22215 @end iftex
22216
22217 @quotation
22218 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22219 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22220 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22221 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22222 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22223 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22224 @code{GIF} formats.
22225 @end quotation
22226
22227 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22228 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22229 point your Web browser at
22230 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22231
22232 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22233 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22234
22235 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22236 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22237 Picons databases.
22238
22239 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22240
22241 @table @code
22242
22243 @item gnus-picon-databases
22244 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22245 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22246 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22247 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22248 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22249
22250 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22251 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22252 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22253 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22254
22255 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22256 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22257 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22258 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22259
22260 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22261 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22262 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22263 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22264 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22265
22266 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22267 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22268 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22269 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22270
22271 @end table
22272
22273
22274 @node XVarious
22275 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22276
22277 @table @code
22278 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22279 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22280 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22281 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22282 unusual directory structure.
22283
22284 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22285 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22286 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22287 default.
22288
22289 @end table
22290
22291 @subsubsection Toolbar
22292
22293 @table @code
22294
22295 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22296 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22297 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22298 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-nil, it should be one
22299 of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom}, @code{right},
22300 and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default toolbar, the
22301 rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those names show.
22302 The default is @code{default}.
22303
22304 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22305 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22306 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22307 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22308 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22309 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22310
22311 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22312 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22313 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22314
22315 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22316 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22317 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22318
22319 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22320 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22321 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22322
22323 @end table
22324
22325 @iftex
22326 @iflatex
22327 \margindex{}
22328 @end iflatex
22329 @end iftex
22330
22331
22332 @node Fuzzy Matching
22333 @section Fuzzy Matching
22334 @cindex fuzzy matching
22335
22336 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22337 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22338
22339 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22340 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22341 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22342
22343 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22344 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22345 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22346 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22347 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22348
22349
22350 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22351 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22352 @cindex email spam
22353 @cindex spam
22354 @cindex UCE
22355 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22356
22357 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22358 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22359 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22360 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22361 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22362 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22363 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22364 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22365 in the end.
22366
22367 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22368 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22369 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22370 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22371 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22372 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22373
22374 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22375
22376 @menu
22377 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22378 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22379 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22380 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22381 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22382 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22383 @end menu
22384
22385 @node The problem of spam
22386 @subsection The problem of spam
22387 @cindex email spam
22388 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22389 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22390 @cindex UCE
22391 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22392
22393 First, some background on spam.
22394
22395 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22396 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22397 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22398 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22399 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22400 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22401 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22402 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22403 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22404
22405 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22406 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22407 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22408 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22409 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22410 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22411 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22412 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22413 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22414 and processing.
22415
22416 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22417 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22418 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22419 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22420 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22421 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22422 from Bulgarian IPs.
22423
22424 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22425 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22426 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22427 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22428
22429 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22430 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22431 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22432 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22433
22434 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22435 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22436 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22437 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22438 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22439 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22440 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22441 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22442 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22443
22444 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22445 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22446 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22447 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22448 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22449 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22450 down for some time because of the incident.
22451
22452 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22453 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22454 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22455 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22456 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22457 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22458 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22459 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22460 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22461 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22462 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22463
22464 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22465 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22466 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22467 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22468 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22469 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22470 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22471 spam plague.
22472
22473 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22474 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22475 @cindex email spam
22476 @cindex spam
22477 @cindex UCE
22478 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22479
22480 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22481 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22482
22483 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22484 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22485 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22486 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22487 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22488 part of the mail address.)
22489
22490 @lisp
22491 (setq message-default-news-headers
22492 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22493 @end lisp
22494
22495 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22496 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22497
22498 @lisp
22499 (...
22500 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22501 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22502 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22503 "spam"))
22504 ...)
22505 @end lisp
22506
22507 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22508 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22509 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22510 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22511
22512 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22513 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22514 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22515 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22516 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22517 your fancy split rule in this way:
22518
22519 @lisp
22520 (
22521 ...
22522 (to "larsi" "misc")
22523 "spam")
22524 @end lisp
22525
22526 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22527 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22528 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22529 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22530 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22531
22532 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22533 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22534 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22535 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22536
22537 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22538
22539
22540 @node SpamAssassin
22541 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22542 @cindex SpamAssassin
22543 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22544 @cindex DCC
22545
22546 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22547 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22548 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22549 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22550 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22551 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22552 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22553
22554 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22555 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22556 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22557 recipes.
22558
22559 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22560 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22561 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22562 Specifiers}) follow.
22563
22564 @lisp
22565 (setq mail-sources
22566 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22567 (pop :user "jrl"
22568 :server "pophost"
22569 :postscript
22570 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22571 @end lisp
22572
22573 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22574 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22575 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22576
22577 @lisp
22578 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22579 ...))
22580 @end lisp
22581
22582 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22583
22584 @lisp
22585 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22586 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22587 ...))
22588 @end lisp
22589
22590 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22591 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22592 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22593 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22594
22595 @lisp
22596 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22597 ...))
22598 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22599 (save-excursion
22600 (save-restriction
22601 (widen)
22602 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22603 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22604 "spam"))))
22605 @end lisp
22606
22607 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22608 downloaded by default. You need to set
22609 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22610 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22611
22612 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22613 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22614 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22615
22616 @lisp
22617 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22618 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22619 (interactive)
22620 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22621 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22622 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22623 @end lisp
22624
22625 @node Hashcash
22626 @subsection Hashcash
22627 @cindex hashcash
22628
22629 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22630 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22631 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22632 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22633 in smaller communities.
22634
22635 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22636 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22637 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22638 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22639 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22640 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22641 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22642 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22643 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22644 one of them separately.
22645
22646 @cindex X-Hashcash
22647 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22648 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22649 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22650 header. For more details, and for the external application
22651 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22652 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22653 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22654
22655 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22656 like:
22657
22658 @lisp
22659 (require 'hashcash)
22660 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22661 @end lisp
22662
22663 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22664 contrib directory or at
22665 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22666
22667 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22668
22669 @table @code
22670
22671 @item hashcash-default-payment
22672 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22673 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22674 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22675 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22676
22677 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22678 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22679 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22680 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22681 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22682 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22683 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22684 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22685 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22686
22687 @item hashcash
22688 @vindex hashcash
22689 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22690
22691 @end table
22692
22693 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22694 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22695 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22696 a useful contribution, however.
22697
22698 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22699 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22700 @cindex spam filtering
22701 @cindex spam
22702
22703 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22704 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22705 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22706 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22707 non-spam messages.
22708
22709 @cindex spam-initialize
22710 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22711 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22712 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22713 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22714 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22715
22716 @example
22717 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22718 (spam-initialize)
22719 @end example
22720
22721 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22722
22723 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22724 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22725 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22726 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22727 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22728
22729 You get the following keyboard commands:
22730
22731 @table @kbd
22732
22733 @item M-d
22734 @itemx M s x
22735 @itemx S x
22736 @kindex M-d
22737 @kindex S x
22738 @kindex M s x
22739 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22740 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22741
22742 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22743 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22744 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22745 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22746
22747 @item M s t
22748 @itemx S t
22749 @kindex M s t
22750 @kindex S t
22751 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22752 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22753
22754 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22755
22756 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22757
22758 @end table
22759
22760 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22761 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22762 group.
22763
22764 @menu
22765 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22766 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22767 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22768 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22769 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22770 * BBDB Whitelists::
22771 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22772 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22773 * Blackholes::
22774 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22775 * Bogofilter::
22776 * ifile spam filtering::
22777 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22778 * SpamOracle::
22779 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22780 @end menu
22781
22782 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22783 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22784 @cindex spam filtering
22785 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22786 @cindex spam
22787
22788 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22789 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22790
22791 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22792 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22793 leaving a group.
22794
22795 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22796 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22797 when you enter the group.
22798
22799 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22800 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22801 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22802 Incoming Mail}.
22803
22804 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22805 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22806 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22807 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22808 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22809 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22810 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22811 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22812 customize-variable} as usual).
22813
22814 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22815 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22816 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22817 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22818 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22819 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22820
22821 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22822 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22823 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22824 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22825 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22826 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22827 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22828 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22829 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22830
22831 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22832 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22833 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22834 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22835 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22836 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22837 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22838 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22839 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22840 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22841
22842 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22843 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22844 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22845 depending on the article's classification. If the
22846 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22847 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22848 current group.
22849
22850 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22851 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22852 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22853 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22854 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22855 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22856 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22857 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22858 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22859 which is what most people want. If the
22860 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22861 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22862
22863 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22864 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22865
22866 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22867 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22868 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22869 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22870 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22871 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22872 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22873 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22874 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22875 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22876 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22877
22878 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22879 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22880
22881 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22882 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22883 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22884
22885 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22886 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22887 @cindex spam filtering
22888 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22889 @cindex spam
22890
22891 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22892 must add the following to your fancy split list
22893 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22894
22895 @example
22896 (: spam-split)
22897 @end example
22898
22899 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22900 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22901 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22902
22903 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22904
22905 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22906 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22907 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22908 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22909 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22910 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22911 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22912 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22913 actually give you the group
22914 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22915 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22916
22917 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22918 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22919 this useful?
22920
22921 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22922 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22923
22924 @example
22925 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22926 (any "ding" "ding")
22927 (: spam-split)
22928 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22929 "mail")
22930 @end example
22931
22932 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22933 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22934 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22935 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22936 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22937 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22938
22939 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22940 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22941 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22942
22943 @example
22944 nnimap-split-fancy
22945 '(|
22946 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
22947 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22948 (any "ding" "ding")
22949 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
22950 (: spam-split)
22951 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22952 "mail")
22953 @end example
22954
22955 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22956 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22957 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22958 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22959 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22960 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22961 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22962
22963 You should still have specific checks such as
22964 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22965 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22966 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22967 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22968 is usually not critical, though.
22969
22970 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22971
22972 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22973 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22974 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22975 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22976 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22977 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22978 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22979 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22980
22981 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22982
22983 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22984 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22985 don't.}
22986
22987 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22988 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22989 @cindex spam filtering
22990 @cindex spam filtering variables
22991 @cindex spam variables
22992 @cindex spam
22993
22994 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22995 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22996 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22997 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22998 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22999 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
23000 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
23001 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
23002 will be detected later.
23003
23004 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
23005 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
23006 for more information.
23007
23008 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23009 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23010 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23011 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23012 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23013 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23014 by customizing the corresponding variable
23015 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23016 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23017 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23018 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23019 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23020 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23021 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23022 default.
23023
23024 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23025 @cindex $
23026 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23027 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23028 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23029 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23030 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23031 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23032 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23033 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23034 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23035 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23036 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23037 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23038 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23039
23040 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23041 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23042 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23043 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23044 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23045 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23046 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23047 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23048
23049 @defvar ham-marks
23050 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23051 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23052 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23053 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23054 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23055 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23056 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23057 happy for you.
23058 @end defvar
23059
23060 @defvar spam-marks
23061 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23062 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23063 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23064 you really want to.
23065 @end defvar
23066
23067 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23068 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23069 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23070 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23071 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23072 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23073 and nothing else.
23074
23075 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23076 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23077 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23078 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23079 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23080 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23081 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23082 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23083 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23084 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23085 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23086 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23087 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23088 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23089 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23090
23091 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23092 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23093
23094 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23095 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23096 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23097
23098 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23099 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23100
23101 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23102 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23103 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23104 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23105 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23106
23107 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23108 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23109 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23110 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23111 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23112 it there.
23113
23114 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23115 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23116 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23117 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23118 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23119 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23120 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23121 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23122 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23123 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23124 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23125 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23126 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23127
23128 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23129 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23130
23131 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23132 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23133 training} groups.
23134
23135 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23136 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23137 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23138 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23139 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23140 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23141 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23142
23143 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23144 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23145 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23146 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23147
23148 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23149 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23150 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23151 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23152 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23153 from the mail server.
23154
23155 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23156 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23157 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23158 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23159
23160 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23161 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23162 @cindex spam filtering
23163 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23164 @cindex spam configuration examples
23165 @cindex spam
23166
23167 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23168
23169 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23170 @example
23171 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23172 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23173 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23174 (spam-initialize)
23175
23176 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23177 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23178
23179 (setq
23180 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23181 spam-use-BBDB t
23182 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23183 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23184 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23185 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23186 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23187 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23188 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23189 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23190 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23191 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23192 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23193 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23194 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23195 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23196 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23197 (any "ding" "ding")
23198 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23199 (: spam-split)
23200 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23201 "mail"))
23202
23203 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23204
23205 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23206 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23207 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23208 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23209
23210 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23211
23212 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23213 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23214 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23215 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23216 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23217
23218 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23219 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23220
23221 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23222
23223 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23224 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23225
23226 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23227 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23228 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23229
23230 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23231
23232 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23233 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23234
23235 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23236 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23237 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23238 (ham-marks
23239 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23240 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23241 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23242 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23243
23244 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23245 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23246 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23247
23248 @end example
23249
23250 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23251 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23252
23253 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23254 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23255 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23256 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23257 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23258 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23259 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23260 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23261 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23262
23263 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23264 does most of the job for me:
23265
23266 @lisp
23267 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23268 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23269 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23270 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23271 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23272 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23273 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23274 @end lisp
23275
23276 @itemize
23277
23278 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23279
23280 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23281 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23282 bogofilter or DCC).
23283
23284 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23285 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23286 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23287 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23288 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23289 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23290 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23291
23292 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23293 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23294 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23295 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23296 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23297 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23298
23299 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23300
23301 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23302 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23303 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23304 @samp{training.ham}.
23305 @end itemize
23306
23307 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23308
23309 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23310
23311 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23312 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23313 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23314
23315 @lisp
23316 ("^gmane\\."
23317 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23318 @end lisp
23319
23320 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23321 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23322 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23323 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23324 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23325
23326 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23327 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23328 @cindex spam filtering
23329 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23330 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23331 @cindex spam
23332
23333 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23334
23335 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23336 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23337 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23338 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23339 be spammers.
23340
23341 @end defvar
23342
23343 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23344
23345 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23346 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23347 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23348 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23349 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23350
23351 @end defvar
23352
23353 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23354
23355 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23356 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23357 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23358
23359 @end defvar
23360
23361 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23362
23363 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23364 customizing the group parameters or the
23365 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23366 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23367 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23368
23369 @emph{WARNING}
23370
23371 Instead of the obsolete
23372 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23373 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23374 the same way, we promise.
23375
23376 @end defvar
23377
23378 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23379
23380 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23381 customizing the group parameters or the
23382 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23383 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23384 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23385 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23386 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23387
23388 @emph{WARNING}
23389
23390 Instead of the obsolete
23391 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23392 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23393 the same way, we promise.
23394
23395 @end defvar
23396
23397 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23398 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23399 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23400 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23401 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23402
23403 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23404 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23405 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23406 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23407
23408 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23409 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23410 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23411 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23412 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23413 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23414
23415 @node BBDB Whitelists
23416 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23417 @cindex spam filtering
23418 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23419 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23420 @cindex spam
23421
23422 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23423
23424 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23425 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23426 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23427 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23428 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23429 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23430 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23431
23432 @end defvar
23433
23434 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23435
23436 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23437 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23438 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23439 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23440 classified as spammers.
23441
23442 @end defvar
23443
23444 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23445
23446 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23447 customizing the group parameters or the
23448 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23449 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23450 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23451 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23452 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23453
23454 @emph{WARNING}
23455
23456 Instead of the obsolete
23457 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23458 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23459 the same way, we promise.
23460
23461 @end defvar
23462
23463 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23464 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23465 @cindex spam reporting
23466 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23467 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23468 @cindex spam
23469
23470 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23471
23472 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23473 customizing the group parameters or the
23474 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23475 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23476 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23477 HTTP request.
23478
23479 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23480
23481 @emph{WARNING}
23482
23483 Instead of the obsolete
23484 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23485 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23486 same way, we promise.
23487
23488 @end defvar
23489
23490 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23491
23492 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23493 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23494 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23495 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23496 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23497 Gmane provides.
23498
23499 @end defvar
23500
23501 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23502 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23503 @cindex spam filtering
23504 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23505 @cindex spam
23506
23507 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23508
23509 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23510 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23511 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23512 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23513 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23514 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23515 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23516 ham.
23517
23518 @end defvar
23519
23520 @node Blackholes
23521 @subsubsection Blackholes
23522 @cindex spam filtering
23523 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23524 @cindex spam
23525
23526 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23527
23528 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23529 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23530 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23531 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23532 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23533 contains outdated servers.
23534
23535 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23536 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23537 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23538 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23539 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23540 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23541
23542 @end defvar
23543
23544 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23545
23546 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23547
23548 @end defvar
23549
23550 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23551
23552 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23553 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23554
23555 @end defvar
23556
23557 @defvar spam-use-dig
23558
23559 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23560 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23561
23562 @end defvar
23563
23564 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23565 ham processor for blackholes.
23566
23567 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23568 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23569 @cindex spam filtering
23570 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23571 @cindex spam
23572
23573 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23574
23575 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23576 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23577 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23578 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23579 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23580 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23581
23582 @end defvar
23583
23584 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23585
23586 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23587 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23588
23589 @end defvar
23590
23591 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23592
23593 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23594 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23595
23596 @end defvar
23597
23598 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23599 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23600
23601 @node Bogofilter
23602 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23603 @cindex spam filtering
23604 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23605 @cindex spam
23606
23607 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23608
23609 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23610 speedy Bogofilter.
23611
23612 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23613 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23614 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23615 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23616 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23617 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23618
23619 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23620 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23621 documentation.
23622
23623 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23624 processing will be turned off.
23625
23626 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23627
23628 @end defvar
23629
23630 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23631
23632 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23633 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23634 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23635 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23636 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23637 installation documents for details.
23638
23639 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23640
23641 @end defvar
23642
23643 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23644 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23645 customizing the group parameters or the
23646 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23647 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23648 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23649
23650 @emph{WARNING}
23651
23652 Instead of the obsolete
23653 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23654 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23655 the same way, we promise.
23656 @end defvar
23657
23658 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23659 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23660 customizing the group parameters or the
23661 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23662 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23663 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23664 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23665 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23666
23667 @emph{WARNING}
23668
23669 Instead of the obsolete
23670 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23671 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23672 the same way, we promise.
23673 @end defvar
23674
23675 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23676
23677 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23678 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23679 database directory.
23680
23681 @end defvar
23682
23683 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23684 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23685 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23686 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23687 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23688 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23689
23690 @node ifile spam filtering
23691 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23692 @cindex spam filtering
23693 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23694 @cindex spam
23695
23696 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23697
23698 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23699 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23700
23701 @end defvar
23702
23703 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23704
23705 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23706 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23707 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23708
23709 @end defvar
23710
23711 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23712
23713 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23714 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23715 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23716 @end defvar
23717
23718 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23719
23720 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23721 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23722
23723 @end defvar
23724
23725 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23726 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23727 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23728 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23729 functionality.
23730
23731 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23732 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23733 @cindex spam filtering
23734 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23735 @cindex spam-stat
23736 @cindex spam
23737
23738 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23739
23740 @defvar spam-use-stat
23741
23742 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23743 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23744
23745 @end defvar
23746
23747 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23748 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23749 customizing the group parameters or the
23750 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23751 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23752 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23753
23754 @emph{WARNING}
23755
23756 Instead of the obsolete
23757 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23758 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23759 the same way, we promise.
23760 @end defvar
23761
23762 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23763 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23764 customizing the group parameters or the
23765 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23766 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23767 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23768 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23769 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23770
23771 @emph{WARNING}
23772
23773 Instead of the obsolete
23774 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23775 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23776 the same way, we promise.
23777 @end defvar
23778
23779 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23780 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23781 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23782 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23783 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23784
23785 @node SpamOracle
23786 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23787 @cindex spam filtering
23788 @cindex SpamOracle
23789 @cindex spam
23790
23791 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23792 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23793 installed separately.
23794
23795 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23796 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23797 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23798 mail as a spam mail or not.
23799
23800 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23801 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23802 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23803
23804 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23805 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23806
23807 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23808 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23809 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23810 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23811 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23812 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23813 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23814 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23815 in @samp{INBOX}:
23816
23817 @example
23818 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23819 spam-split-group "Junk"
23820 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23821 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23822 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23823 @end example
23824
23825 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23826 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23827 SpamOracle.
23828 @end defvar
23829
23830 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23831 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23832 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23833 can be customized.
23834 @end defvar
23835
23836 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23837 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23838 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23839 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23840 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23841 database to live somewhere special, set
23842 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23843 @end defvar
23844
23845 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23846 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23847 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23848 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23849 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23850 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23851 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23852 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23853 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23854 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23855
23856 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23857 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23858 customizing the group parameter or the
23859 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23860 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23861 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23862
23863 @emph{WARNING}
23864
23865 Instead of the obsolete
23866 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23867 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23868 the same way, we promise.
23869 @end defvar
23870
23871 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23872 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23873 customizing the group parameter or the
23874 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23875 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23876 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23877 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23878 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23879
23880 @emph{WARNING}
23881
23882 Instead of the obsolete
23883 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23884 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23885 the same way, we promise.
23886 @end defvar
23887
23888 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23889 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23890 messages.
23891 @example
23892 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23893 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23894 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23895 @end example
23896 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23897 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23898 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23899 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23900 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23901 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23902
23903 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23904 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23905 @cindex spam filtering
23906 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23907 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23908
23909 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23910 incoming mail, provide the following:
23911
23912 @enumerate
23913
23914 @item
23915 Code
23916
23917 @lisp
23918 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23919 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23920 @end lisp
23921
23922 Add
23923 @lisp
23924 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23925 @end lisp
23926 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23927
23928 Add
23929 @lisp
23930 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23931 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23932 @end lisp
23933
23934 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23935
23936 Add
23937 @lisp
23938 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23939 nil
23940 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23941 nil)
23942 @end lisp
23943
23944 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23945 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23946 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23947 Blackbox.
23948
23949 @item
23950 Functionality
23951
23952 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23953 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23954 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23955 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23956 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23957
23958 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23959 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23960 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23961
23962 @end enumerate
23963
23964 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23965
23966 @enumerate
23967
23968 @item
23969 Code
23970
23971 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23972 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23973
23974 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23975 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23976 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23977 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23978
23979 @lisp
23980 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23981 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23982 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23983
23984 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23985 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23986 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23987
23988 @end lisp
23989
23990 @item
23991 Gnus parameters
23992
23993 Add
23994 @lisp
23995 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23996 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23997 @end lisp
23998 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23999 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24000 variable customization.
24001
24002 Add
24003 @lisp
24004 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24005 @end lisp
24006 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24007 @code{gnus.el}.
24008
24009 @end enumerate
24010
24011
24012 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24013 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24014 @cindex Paul Graham
24015 @cindex Graham, Paul
24016 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24017 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24018 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24019
24020 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24021 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24022 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24023 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24024 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24025 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24026 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24027 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24028 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24029 or not.
24030
24031 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24032 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24033 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24034 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24035 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24036 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24037 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24038 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24039
24040 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
24041 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24042 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24043 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24044 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24045
24046 @menu
24047 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24048 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24049 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24050 @end menu
24051
24052 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24053 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24054
24055 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24056 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24057 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24058 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24059 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24060
24061 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24062 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24063 per mail. Use the following:
24064
24065 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24066 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24067 is treated as one spam mail.
24068 @end defun
24069
24070 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24071 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24072 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24073 @end defun
24074
24075 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24076 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24077 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24078 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24079 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24080 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24081
24082 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24083 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24084 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24085 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24086 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24087
24088 @defvar spam-stat
24089 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24090 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24091 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24092 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24093 @end defvar
24094
24095 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24096 reset the dictionary.
24097
24098 @defun spam-stat-reset
24099 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24100 @end defun
24101
24102 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24103 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24104 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24105 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24106 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24107 only non-spam mails.
24108
24109 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24110 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24111 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24112 @end defun
24113
24114 @defun spam-stat-save
24115 Save the dictionary.
24116 @end defun
24117
24118 @defvar spam-stat-file
24119 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24120 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24121 @end defvar
24122
24123 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24124 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24125
24126 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24127 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24128
24129 @lisp
24130 (require 'spam-stat)
24131 (spam-stat-load)
24132 @end lisp
24133
24134 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24135 created.
24136
24137 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24138 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24139 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24140 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24141
24142 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24143 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24144 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24145 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24146
24147 @lisp
24148 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24149 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24150 "mail.misc"))
24151 @end lisp
24152
24153 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24154 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24155 @end defvar
24156
24157 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24158 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24159 expression are considered potential spam.
24160
24161 @lisp
24162 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24163 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24164 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24165 "mail.misc"))
24166 @end lisp
24167
24168 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24169 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24170 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24171 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24172 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24173
24174 @lisp
24175 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24176 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24177 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24178 "mail.misc"))
24179 @end lisp
24180
24181 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24182 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24183 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24184 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24185 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24186 dictionary!
24187
24188 @lisp
24189 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24190 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24191 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24192 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24193 "mail.misc"))
24194 @end lisp
24195
24196
24197 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24198 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24199
24200 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24201
24202 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24203 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24204 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24205 @end defun
24206
24207 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24208 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24209 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24210 @end defun
24211
24212 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24213 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24214 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24215 already been processed as non-spam.
24216 @end defun
24217
24218 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24219 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24220 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24221 been processed as spam.
24222 @end defun
24223
24224 @defun spam-stat-save
24225 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24226 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24227 @end defun
24228
24229 @defun spam-stat-load
24230 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24231 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24232 @end defun
24233
24234 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24235 Return the spam score for a word.
24236 @end defun
24237
24238 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24239 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24240 @end defun
24241
24242 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24243 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24244 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24245 @end defun
24246
24247 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24248 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24249
24250 @lisp
24251 (require 'spam-stat)
24252 (spam-stat-load)
24253 @end lisp
24254
24255 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24256
24257 @smallexample
24258 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24259 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24260 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24261 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24262 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24263 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24264 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24265 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24266 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24267 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24268 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24269 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24270 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24271 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24272 @end smallexample
24273
24274 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24275
24276 @smallexample
24277 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24278 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24279 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24280 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24281 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24282 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24283 @end smallexample
24284
24285 @node Other modes
24286 @section Interaction with other modes
24287
24288 @subsection Dired
24289 @cindex dired
24290
24291 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24292 buffers. It is enabled with
24293 @lisp
24294 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24295 @end lisp
24296
24297 @table @kbd
24298 @item C-c C-m C-a
24299 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24300 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24301 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24302
24303 @item C-c C-m C-l
24304 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24305 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24306 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24307 buffer.
24308
24309 @item C-c C-m C-p
24310 @findex gnus-dired-print
24311 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24312 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24313 @end table
24314
24315 @node Various Various
24316 @section Various Various
24317 @cindex mode lines
24318 @cindex highlights
24319
24320 @table @code
24321
24322 @item gnus-home-directory
24323 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24324 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24325 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24326
24327 @item gnus-directory
24328 @vindex gnus-directory
24329 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24330 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24331 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24332
24333 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24334 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24335 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24336 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24337
24338 @item gnus-default-directory
24339 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24340 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24341 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24342 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24343 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24344 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24345 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24346
24347 @item gnus-verbose
24348 @vindex gnus-verbose
24349 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24350 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24351 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24352 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24353 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24354
24355 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24356 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24357 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24358 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24359
24360 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24361 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24362 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24363 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24364 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24365 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24366 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24367 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24368 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24369 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24370
24371 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24372 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24373 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24374 read when doing the operation described above.
24375
24376 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24377 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24378 @cindex file names
24379 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24380 @cindex characters in file names
24381 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24382 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24383 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24384
24385 @lisp
24386 @group
24387 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24388 '((?: . ?_)))
24389 @end group
24390 @end lisp
24391
24392 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24393 Windows (phooey) systems.
24394
24395 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24396 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24397 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24398 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24399 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24400
24401 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24402 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24403 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24404 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24405 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24406
24407 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24408 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24409 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24410
24411 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24412 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24413
24414 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24415 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24416 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24417 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24418 group).
24419
24420 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24421
24422
24423 @end table
24424
24425 @node The End
24426 @chapter The End
24427
24428 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24429 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24430
24431 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24432
24433 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24434
24435 @quotation
24436 @strong{Te Deum}
24437
24438 @sp 1
24439 Not because of victories @*
24440 I sing,@*
24441 having none,@*
24442 but for the common sunshine,@*
24443 the breeze,@*
24444 the largess of the spring.
24445
24446 @sp 1
24447 Not for victory@*
24448 but for the day's work done@*
24449 as well as I was able;@*
24450 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24451 but at the common table.@*
24452 @end quotation
24453
24454
24455 @node Appendices
24456 @chapter Appendices
24457
24458 @menu
24459 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24460 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24461 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24462 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24463 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24464 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24465 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24466 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24467 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24468 @end menu
24469
24470
24471 @node XEmacs
24472 @section XEmacs
24473 @cindex XEmacs
24474 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24475
24476 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24477 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24478 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24479 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24480 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24481 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24482
24483
24484 @node History
24485 @section History
24486
24487 @cindex history
24488 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24489 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24490
24491 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24492 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24493 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24494 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24495 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24496
24497 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24498 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24499 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24500 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24501 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24502 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24503
24504 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24505 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24506 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24507 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24508
24509 @menu
24510 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24511 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24512 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24513 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24514 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24515 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24516 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24517 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24518 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24519 @end menu
24520
24521
24522 @node Gnus Versions
24523 @subsection Gnus Versions
24524 @cindex ding Gnus
24525 @cindex September Gnus
24526 @cindex Red Gnus
24527 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24528 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24529 @cindex Oort Gnus
24530 @cindex No Gnus
24531 @cindex Gnus versions
24532
24533 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24534 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24535 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24536
24537 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24538 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24539
24540 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24541 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24542
24543 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24544 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24545
24546 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24547 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24548 1999.
24549
24550 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24551 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24552
24553 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24554
24555 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24556 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24557 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24558 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24559 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24560 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24561
24562
24563 @node Other Gnus Versions
24564 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24565 @cindex Semi-gnus
24566
24567 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24568 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24569 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24570 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24571
24572 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24573 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24574 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24575 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24576 Japanese users.
24577
24578
24579 @node Why?
24580 @subsection Why?
24581
24582 What's the point of Gnus?
24583
24584 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24585 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24586 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24587 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24588 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24589 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24590 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24591 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24592 keep track of millions of people who post?
24593
24594 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24595 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24596 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24597 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24598 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24599 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24600 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24601 every one of you to explore and invent.
24602
24603 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24604 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24605
24606
24607 @node Compatibility
24608 @subsection Compatibility
24609
24610 @cindex compatibility
24611 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24612 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24613 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24614
24615 Our motto is:
24616 @quotation
24617 @cartouche
24618 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24619 @end cartouche
24620 @end quotation
24621
24622 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24623 their names.
24624
24625 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24626 Articles}.
24627
24628 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24629 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24630 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24631 important variables have their values copied into their global
24632 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24633 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24634
24635 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24636 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24637 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24638 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24639 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24640 peculiar results.
24641
24642 @cindex hilit19
24643 @cindex highlighting
24644 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24645 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24646 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24647 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24648 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24649 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24650 Away!
24651
24652 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24653 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24654 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24655 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24656
24657 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24658 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24659 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24660 to stop doing it the old way.
24661
24662 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24663
24664 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24665 @findex gnus-bug
24666 @cindex reporting bugs
24667 @cindex bugs
24668 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24669 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24670 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24671
24672 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24673 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24674 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24675 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24676 up at you.
24677
24678
24679 @node Conformity
24680 @subsection Conformity
24681
24682 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24683 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24684 with, of course.
24685
24686 @table @strong
24687
24688 @item RFC (2)822
24689 @cindex RFC 822
24690 @cindex RFC 2822
24691 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24692
24693 @item RFC 1036
24694 @cindex RFC 1036
24695 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24696
24697 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24698 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24699 We do have some breaches to this one.
24700
24701 @table @emph
24702
24703 @item X-Newsreader
24704 @itemx User-Agent
24705 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24706 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24707 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24708 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24709 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24710 @end table
24711
24712 @item USEFOR
24713 @cindex USEFOR
24714 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24715 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24716 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24717 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24718
24719 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24720 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24721 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24722
24723 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24724 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24725
24726 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24727 @cindex RFC 1991
24728 @cindex RFC 2440
24729 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24730 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24731 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24732 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24733 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24734 decryption).
24735
24736 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24737 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24738 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24739 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24740
24741 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24742 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24743
24744 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24745 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24746 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24747 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24748 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24749 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24750 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24751 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24752
24753 @end table
24754
24755 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24756 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24757 know.
24758
24759
24760 @node Emacsen
24761 @subsection Emacsen
24762 @cindex Emacsen
24763 @cindex XEmacs
24764 @cindex Mule
24765 @cindex Emacs
24766
24767 Gnus should work on:
24768
24769 @itemize @bullet
24770
24771 @item
24772 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24773
24774 @item
24775 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24776
24777 @end itemize
24778
24779 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24780 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24781 Emacs versions.
24782
24783 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24784 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24785 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24786 Emacsen.
24787
24788
24789 @node Gnus Development
24790 @subsection Gnus Development
24791
24792 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24793 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24794 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24795 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24796 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24797 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24798 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24799 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24800
24801 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24802 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24803 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24804 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24805 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24806
24807 @cindex Incoming*
24808 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24809 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24810 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24811 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24812 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24813
24814 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24815 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24816 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24817 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24818 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24819 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24820 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24821 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24822 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24823 can't be assumed to do so.
24824
24825
24826
24827 @node Contributors
24828 @subsection Contributors
24829 @cindex contributors
24830
24831 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24832 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24833 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24834 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24835 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24836 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24837 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24838 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24839 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24840 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24841
24842 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24843 wrong show.
24844
24845 @itemize @bullet
24846
24847 @item
24848 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24849
24850 @item
24851 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24852 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24853 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24854 functionality and stuff.
24855
24856 @item
24857 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24858 well as numerous other things).
24859
24860 @item
24861 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24862
24863 @item
24864 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24865
24866 @item
24867 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24868
24869 @item
24870 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24871
24872 @item
24873 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24874 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24875
24876 @item
24877 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24878
24879 @item
24880 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24881 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24882
24883 @item
24884 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24885
24886 @item
24887 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24888
24889 @item
24890 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24891
24892 @item
24893 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24894
24895 @item
24896 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24897 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24898
24899 @item
24900 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24901
24902 @item
24903 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24904
24905 @item
24906 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24907
24908 @item
24909 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24910 .newsrc files.
24911
24912 @item
24913 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24914
24915 @item
24916 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24917
24918 @item
24919 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24920
24921 @item
24922 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24923 well as autoconf support.
24924
24925 @end itemize
24926
24927 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24928 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24929
24930 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24931
24932 Christopher Davis,
24933 Andrew Eskilsson,
24934 Kai Grossjohann,
24935 Kevin Greiner,
24936 Jesper Harder,
24937 Paul Jarc,
24938 Simon Josefsson,
24939 David KÃ¥gedal,
24940 Richard Pieri,
24941 Fabrice Popineau,
24942 Daniel Quinlan,
24943 Michael Shields,
24944 Reiner Steib,
24945 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24946 Jack Vinson,
24947 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24948 and
24949 Teodor Zlatanov.
24950
24951 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24952
24953 Jari Aalto,
24954 Adrian Aichner,
24955 Vladimir Alexiev,
24956 Russ Allbery,
24957 Peter Arius,
24958 Matt Armstrong,
24959 Marc Auslander,
24960 Miles Bader,
24961 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24962 Frank Bennett,
24963 Robert Bihlmeyer,
24964 Chris Bone,
24965 Mark Borges,
24966 Mark Boyns,
24967 Lance A. Brown,
24968 Rob Browning,
24969 Kees de Bruin,
24970 Martin Buchholz,
24971 Joe Buehler,
24972 Kevin Buhr,
24973 Alastair Burt,
24974 Joao Cachopo,
24975 Zlatko Calusic,
24976 Massimo Campostrini,
24977 Castor,
24978 David Charlap,
24979 Dan Christensen,
24980 Kevin Christian,
24981 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24982 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24983 Laura Conrad,
24984 Michael R. Cook,
24985 Glenn Coombs,
24986 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24987 Neil Crellin,
24988 Frank D. Cringle,
24989 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24990 Andre Deparade,
24991 Ulrik Dickow,
24992 Dave Disser,
24993 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
24994 Joev Dubach,
24995 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24996 Dave Edmondson,
24997 Paul Eggert,
24998 Mark W. Eichin,
24999 Karl Eichwalder,
25000 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25001 Michael Ernst,
25002 Luc Van Eycken,
25003 Sam Falkner,
25004 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25005 Sigbjorn Finne,
25006 Sven Fischer,
25007 Paul Fisher,
25008 Decklin Foster,
25009 Gary D. Foster,
25010 Paul Franklin,
25011 Guy Geens,
25012 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25013 David S. Goldberg,
25014 Michelangelo Grigni,
25015 Dale Hagglund,
25016 D. Hall,
25017 Magnus Hammerin,
25018 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25019 Raja R. Harinath,
25020 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25021 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25022 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25023 Scott Hofmann,
25024 Marc Horowitz,
25025 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25026 Richard Hoskins,
25027 Brad Howes,
25028 Miguel de Icaza,
25029 François Felix Ingrand,
25030 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25031 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25032 Lee Iverson,
25033 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25034 Rajappa Iyer,
25035 Andreas Jaeger,
25036 Adam P. Jenkins,
25037 Randell Jesup,
25038 Fred Johansen,
25039 Gareth Jones,
25040 Greg Klanderman,
25041 Karl Kleinpaste,
25042 Michael Klingbeil,
25043 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25044 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25045 Petr Konecny,
25046 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25047 Thor Kristoffersen,
25048 Jens Lautenbacher,
25049 Martin Larose,
25050 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25051 Joerg Lenneis,
25052 Carsten Leonhardt,
25053 James LewisMoss,
25054 Christian Limpach,
25055 Markus Linnala,
25056 Dave Love,
25057 Mike McEwan,
25058 Tonny Madsen,
25059 Shlomo Mahlab,
25060 Nat Makarevitch,
25061 Istvan Marko,
25062 David Martin,
25063 Jason R. Mastaler,
25064 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25065 Timo Metzemakers,
25066 Richard Mlynarik,
25067 Lantz Moore,
25068 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25069 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25070 Hrvoje Niksic,
25071 Andy Norman,
25072 Fred Oberhauser,
25073 C. R. Oldham,
25074 Alexandre Oliva,
25075 Ken Olstad,
25076 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25077 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25078 Ettore Perazzoli,
25079 William Perry,
25080 Stephen Peters,
25081 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25082 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25083 Matt Pharr,
25084 Andy Piper,
25085 John McClary Prevost,
25086 Bill Pringlemeir,
25087 Mike Pullen,
25088 Jim Radford,
25089 Colin Rafferty,
25090 Lasse Rasinen,
25091 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25092 Joe Reiss,
25093 Renaud Rioboo,
25094 Roland B. Roberts,
25095 Bart Robinson,
25096 Christian von Roques,
25097 Markus Rost,
25098 Jason Rumney,
25099 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25100 Jay Sachs,
25101 Dewey M. Sasser,
25102 Conrad Sauerwald,
25103 Loren Schall,
25104 Dan Schmidt,
25105 Ralph Schleicher,
25106 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25107 Andreas Schwab,
25108 Randal L. Schwartz,
25109 Danny Siu,
25110 Matt Simmons,
25111 Paul D. Smith,
25112 Jeff Sparkes,
25113 Toby Speight,
25114 Michael Sperber,
25115 Darren Stalder,
25116 Richard Stallman,
25117 Greg Stark,
25118 Sam Steingold,
25119 Paul Stevenson,
25120 Jonas Steverud,
25121 Paul Stodghill,
25122 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25123 Kurt Swanson,
25124 Samuel Tardieu,
25125 Teddy,
25126 Chuck Thompson,
25127 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25128 Philippe Troin,
25129 James Troup,
25130 Trung Tran-Duc,
25131 Jack Twilley,
25132 Aaron M. Ucko,
25133 Aki Vehtari,
25134 Didier Verna,
25135 Vladimir Volovich,
25136 Jan Vroonhof,
25137 Stefan Waldherr,
25138 Pete Ware,
25139 Barry A. Warsaw,
25140 Christoph Wedler,
25141 Joe Wells,
25142 Lee Willis,
25143 and
25144 Lloyd Zusman.
25145
25146
25147 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25148 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25149 (550kB and counting).
25150
25151 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25152 sure.
25153
25154 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25155 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25156
25157
25158 @node New Features
25159 @subsection New Features
25160 @cindex new features
25161
25162 @menu
25163 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25164 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25165 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25166 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25167 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25168 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25169 @end menu
25170
25171 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25172 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25173 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25174
25175 @node ding Gnus
25176 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25177
25178 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25179
25180 @itemize @bullet
25181
25182 @item
25183 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25184 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25185
25186 @item
25187 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25188 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25189
25190 @item
25191 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25192
25193 @item
25194 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25195 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25196 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25197
25198 @item
25199 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25200 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25201 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25202 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25203
25204 @item
25205 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25206 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25207
25208 @item
25209 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25210 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25211 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25212
25213 @item
25214 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25215 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25216
25217 @item
25218 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25219 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25220 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25221
25222 @item
25223 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25224 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25225 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25226
25227 @item
25228 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25229 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25230
25231 @item
25232 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25233 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25234
25235 @item
25236 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25237 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25238
25239 @item
25240 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25241 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25242
25243 @item
25244 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25245 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25246
25247 @item
25248 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25249 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25250
25251 @item
25252 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25253
25254 @item
25255 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25256 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25257
25258 @item
25259 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25260 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25261
25262 @item
25263 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25264 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25265
25266 @item
25267 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25268
25269 @item
25270 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25271 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25272
25273 @item
25274 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25275 Articles}).
25276
25277 @item
25278 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25279 Buttons}).
25280
25281 @item
25282 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25283 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25284
25285 @item
25286 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25287 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25288
25289 @end itemize
25290
25291
25292 @node September Gnus
25293 @subsubsection September Gnus
25294
25295 @iftex
25296 @iflatex
25297 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25298 @end iflatex
25299 @end iftex
25300
25301 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25302
25303 @itemize @bullet
25304
25305 @item
25306 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25307 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25308 now obsolete.
25309
25310 @item
25311 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25312 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25313 Threading}).
25314
25315 @lisp
25316 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25317 @end lisp
25318
25319 @item
25320 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25321 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25322
25323 @item
25324 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25325 referred.
25326
25327 @item
25328 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25329
25330 @item
25331 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25332
25333 @item
25334 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25335
25336 @lisp
25337 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25338 @end lisp
25339
25340 @item
25341 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25342 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25343
25344 @lisp
25345 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25346 @end lisp
25347
25348 @item
25349 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25350 Groups}).
25351
25352 @item
25353 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25354 Topics}).
25355
25356 @lisp
25357 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25358 @end lisp
25359
25360 @item
25361 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25362
25363 @item
25364 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25365 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25366
25367 @lisp
25368 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25369 @end lisp
25370
25371 @item
25372 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25373 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25374
25375 @item
25376 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25377
25378 @item
25379 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25380 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25381 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25382
25383 @item
25384 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25385 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25386
25387 @item
25388 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25389
25390 @item
25391 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25392 Groups}).
25393
25394 @item
25395 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25396 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25397
25398 @item
25399 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25400 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25401
25402 @item
25403 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25404 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25405
25406 @item
25407 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25408 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25409 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25410
25411 @item
25412 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25413 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25414
25415 @item
25416 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25417
25418 @item
25419 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25420
25421 @item
25422 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25423
25424 @item
25425 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25426
25427 @item
25428 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25429 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25430
25431 @item
25432 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25433 Layout}).
25434
25435 @item
25436 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25437 @iftex
25438 @iflatex
25439 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25440 @end iflatex
25441 @end iftex
25442
25443 @item
25444 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25445
25446 @lisp
25447 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25448 @end lisp
25449
25450 @item
25451 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25452
25453 @lisp
25454 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25455 @end lisp
25456
25457 @item
25458 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25459
25460 @item
25461 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25462
25463 @item
25464 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25465 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25466
25467 @lisp
25468 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25469 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25470 @end lisp
25471
25472 @item
25473 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25474 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25475
25476 @lisp
25477 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25478 @end lisp
25479
25480 @item
25481 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25482 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25483
25484 @item
25485 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25486
25487 @item
25488 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25489 Articles}).
25490
25491 @lisp
25492 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25493 @end lisp
25494
25495 @item
25496 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25497 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25498
25499 @lisp
25500 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25501 @end lisp
25502
25503 @item
25504 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25505 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25506
25507 @item
25508 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25509 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25510
25511 @lisp
25512 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25513 @end lisp
25514
25515 @item
25516 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25517
25518 @item
25519 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25520
25521 @item
25522 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25523
25524 @end itemize
25525
25526
25527 @node Red Gnus
25528 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25529
25530 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25531
25532 @iftex
25533 @iflatex
25534 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25535 @end iflatex
25536 @end iftex
25537
25538 @itemize @bullet
25539
25540 @item
25541 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25542
25543 @item
25544 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25545 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25546
25547 @item
25548 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25549 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25550 Scoring}).
25551
25552 @item
25553 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25554 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25555
25556 @item
25557 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25558
25559 @item
25560 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25561 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25562
25563 @lisp
25564 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25565 @end lisp
25566
25567 @item
25568 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25569 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25570 been added.
25571
25572 @item
25573 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25574 Server Internals}).
25575
25576 @item
25577 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25578 Parameters}).
25579
25580 @item
25581 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25582
25583 @item
25584 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25585 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25586
25587 @item
25588 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25589 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25590 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25591
25592 @item
25593 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25594 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25595
25596 @item
25597 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25598 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25599
25600 @item
25601 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25602 (@pxref{Undo}).
25603
25604 @item
25605 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25606 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25607
25608 @item
25609 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25610 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25611
25612 @lisp
25613 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25614 @end lisp
25615
25616 @item
25617 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25618
25619 @lisp
25620 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25621 @end lisp
25622
25623 @item
25624 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25625 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25626
25627 @item
25628 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25629 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25630
25631 @item
25632 A new command for reading collections of documents
25633 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25634 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25635
25636 @item
25637 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25638 Marks}).
25639
25640 @item
25641 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25642 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25643
25644 @item
25645 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25646 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25647 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25648
25649 @item
25650 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25651 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25652 Sorting}).
25653
25654 @item
25655 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25656 Groups}).
25657
25658 @item
25659 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25660 Commands}).
25661 @iftex
25662 @iflatex
25663 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25664 @end iflatex
25665 @end iftex
25666
25667 @item
25668 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25669 Variables}).
25670
25671 @item
25672 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25673 Mail}).
25674
25675 @item
25676 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25677 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25678
25679 @item
25680 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25681
25682 @end itemize
25683
25684
25685 @node Quassia Gnus
25686 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25687
25688 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25689
25690 @itemize @bullet
25691
25692 @item
25693 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25694 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25695 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25696
25697 @item
25698 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25699 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25700 group, which is created automatically.
25701
25702 @item
25703 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25704 values.
25705
25706 @item
25707 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25708
25709 @item
25710 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25711 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25712
25713 @item
25714 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25715 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25716
25717 @item
25718 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25719
25720 @item
25721 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25722 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25723
25724 @item
25725 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25726
25727 @item
25728 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25729 details.
25730
25731 @item
25732 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25733 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25734
25735 @item
25736 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25737 control over simplification.
25738
25739 @item
25740 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25741
25742 @item
25743 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25744 limit.
25745
25746 @item
25747 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25748
25749 @item
25750 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25751
25752 @item
25753 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25754 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25755 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25756
25757 @item
25758 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25759 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25760
25761 @item
25762 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25763 text---@kbd{W d}.
25764
25765 @item
25766 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25767 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25768
25769 @item
25770 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25771 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25772
25773 @item
25774 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25775 has been added.
25776
25777 @item
25778 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25779
25780 @item
25781 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25782
25783 @item
25784 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25785 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25786
25787 @item
25788 A new function for citing in Message has been
25789 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25790
25791 @item
25792 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25793
25794 @item
25795 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25796 been added.
25797
25798 @item
25799 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25800 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25801
25802 @item
25803 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25804 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25805
25806 @item
25807 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25808
25809 @item
25810 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25811
25812 @end itemize
25813
25814 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25815 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25816
25817 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25818
25819 @itemize @bullet
25820
25821 @item
25822 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25823 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25824
25825 If you used procmail like in
25826
25827 @lisp
25828 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25829 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25830 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25831 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25832 @end lisp
25833
25834 this now has changed to
25835
25836 @lisp
25837 (setq mail-sources
25838 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25839 :suffix ".in")))
25840 @end lisp
25841
25842 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25843
25844 @item
25845 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25846 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25847
25848 @item
25849 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25850 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25851
25852 @item
25853 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25854 called to position point.
25855
25856 @item
25857 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25858 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25859
25860 @item
25861 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25862 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25863
25864 @item
25865 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25866 subtly different manner.
25867
25868 @item
25869 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25870 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25871 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25872
25873 @item
25874 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25875
25876 @end itemize
25877
25878 @node Oort Gnus
25879 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25880 @cindex Oort Gnus
25881
25882 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25883
25884 @itemize @bullet
25885
25886 @item
25887 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25888 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25889 region if the region is active.
25890
25891 @item
25892 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25893 using @kbd{G M}.
25894
25895 @item
25896 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25897 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25898
25899 @item
25900 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25901 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25902
25903 @item
25904 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25905
25906 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25907 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25908 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25909 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25910 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25911 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25912 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25913 isn't save in general.
25914
25915 @item
25916 Article Buttons
25917
25918 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25919 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25920 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25921 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25922
25923 @item
25924 Dired integration
25925
25926 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25927 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25928 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25929 entry.
25930
25931 @item
25932 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25933
25934 @item
25935 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25936
25937 @item
25938 Picons
25939
25940 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25941 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25942
25943 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25944 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25945 @xref{Picons}.
25946
25947 @item
25948 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25949 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25950
25951 @item
25952 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25953
25954 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25955 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25956
25957 @item
25958 Delayed articles
25959
25960 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25961 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25962 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25963
25964 @item
25965 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25966 decompressed when activated.
25967
25968 @item
25969 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25970 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25971
25972 @item
25973 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25974
25975 @item
25976 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25977 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25978
25979 @item
25980 Warn about email replies to news
25981
25982 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25983 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25984 you.
25985
25986 @item
25987 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25988 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25989 built.
25990
25991 @item
25992 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25993 opposed to old but unread messages).
25994
25995 @item
25996 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25997 Gcc articles as read.
25998
25999 @item
26000 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26001
26002 @item
26003 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26004 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26005
26006 @item
26007 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26008 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26009
26010 @item
26011 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26012 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26013
26014 @item
26015 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26016 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26017
26018 @item
26019 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26020
26021 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26022 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26023 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26024 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26025
26026 @item
26027 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26028
26029 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26030 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26031 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26032 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26033 the second parameter.
26034
26035 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26036 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26037 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26038 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26039 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26040 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26041 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26042 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26043 cycle used under Unix systems.
26044
26045 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
26046 been removed.
26047
26048 @item
26049 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26050
26051 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26052 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26053 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26054 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26055 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26056 controls this.
26057
26058 @item
26059 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26060
26061 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26062 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26063 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26064 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26065 citations.
26066
26067 @item
26068 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26069
26070 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26071 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26072 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26073 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26074
26075 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26076 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26077 message cited below.
26078
26079 @item
26080 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26081
26082 @item
26083 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26084
26085 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26086 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26087 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26088 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26089 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26090 parameters, a'la:
26091 @lisp
26092 (setq gnus-parameters
26093 '(("mail\\..*"
26094 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26095 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26096 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26097 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26098 @end lisp
26099
26100 @item
26101 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26102
26103 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26104 disable it.
26105
26106 @item
26107 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26108
26109 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26110 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26111 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26112 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26113 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26114 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26115 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26116 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26117 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26118
26119 @item
26120 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26121
26122 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26123 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26124 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26125 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26126 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26127 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26128
26129 @item
26130 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26131 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26132 @code{nil}.
26133
26134 @item
26135 Improved anti-spam features.
26136
26137 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26138 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26139 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26140 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26141 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26142
26143 @item
26144 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26145
26146 @item
26147 Face headers handling.
26148
26149 @item
26150 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26151 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26152
26153 @item
26154 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26155
26156 @item
26157 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26158
26159 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26160 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26161 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26162 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26163 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26164 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26165 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26166 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26167 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26168
26169 @item
26170 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26171
26172 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26173 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26174 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26175 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26176 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26177 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26178 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26179 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26180 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26181 was inserted directly.
26182
26183 @item
26184 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26185
26186 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26187 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26188 hierarchy.
26189
26190 @item
26191 @code{gnus-agent}
26192
26193 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26194 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26195 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26196 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26197 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26198 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26199 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26200 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26201 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26202 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26203 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26204 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26205 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26206 is not needed any more.
26207
26208 @item
26209 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26210
26211 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26212 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26213 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26214 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26215 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26216 groups.
26217
26218 @item
26219 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26220
26221 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26222 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26223
26224 @item
26225 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26226
26227 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26228 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26229 lisp directory into load-path.
26230
26231 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26232 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26233
26234 @item
26235 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26236
26237 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26238
26239 @item
26240 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26241
26242 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26243 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26244 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26245 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26246
26247 @item
26248 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26249
26250 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26251 @lisp
26252 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26253 'bbdb-complete-name)
26254 @end lisp
26255
26256 @item
26257 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26258
26259 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26260 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26261 local files as external parts.
26262
26263 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26264 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26265 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26266 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26267 that support editing.
26268
26269 @item
26270 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26271
26272 The default value is determined from the
26273 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26274 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26275 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26276
26277 @item
26278 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26279
26280 Add a new format of match like
26281 @lisp
26282 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26283 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26284 @end lisp
26285 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26286 @lisp
26287 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26288 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26289 @end lisp
26290
26291 @item
26292 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26293
26294 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26295 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26296 need add those two headers too.
26297
26298 @item
26299 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26300
26301 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26302 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26303 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26304
26305 @item
26306 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26307 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26308 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26309 versions.
26310
26311 @item
26312 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26313 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26314 inline PGP signed messages. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26315
26316 @item
26317 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26318
26319 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26320
26321 @item
26322 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26323
26324 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26325
26326 @item
26327 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26328
26329 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26330 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26331 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26332
26333 @item
26334 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26335
26336 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26337 the valid values.
26338
26339 @item
26340 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26341
26342 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26343 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26344 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26345 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26346 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26347 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26348 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26349 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26350
26351 @item
26352 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26353
26354 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26355 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26356 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26357 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26358 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26359
26360 @item
26361 Extended format specs.
26362
26363 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26364 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26365 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26366 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26367 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26368 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26369
26370 @item
26371 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26372
26373 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26374 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26375 out other articles.
26376
26377 @item
26378 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26379
26380 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26381 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26382 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26383 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26384
26385 @item
26386 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26387
26388 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26389 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26390 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26391
26392 @item
26393 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26394
26395 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26396 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26397 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26398 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26399 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26400 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26401 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26402 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26403 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26404 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26405 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26406
26407 @item
26408 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26409 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26410
26411 @item
26412 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26413 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26414 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26415 message, Message Manual}).
26416
26417 @item
26418 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26419 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26420
26421 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26422 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26423 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26424 @lisp
26425 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26426 @end lisp
26427
26428 @item
26429 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26430 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26431
26432 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26433 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26434 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26435 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26436
26437 @item
26438 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26439
26440 @item
26441 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26442 C-m}.
26443
26444 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26445 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26446
26447 @item
26448 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26449
26450 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26451 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26452 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26453 invalidate the digital signature.
26454 @end itemize
26455
26456 @iftex
26457
26458 @page
26459 @node The Manual
26460 @section The Manual
26461 @cindex colophon
26462 @cindex manual
26463
26464 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26465 either @code{texi2dvi}
26466 @iflatex
26467 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26468 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26469 @end iflatex
26470 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26471
26472 The following conventions have been used:
26473
26474 @enumerate
26475
26476 @item
26477 This is a @samp{string}
26478
26479 @item
26480 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26481
26482 @item
26483 This is a @file{file}
26484
26485 @item
26486 This is a @code{symbol}
26487
26488 @end enumerate
26489
26490 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26491 mean:
26492
26493 @lisp
26494 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26495 @end lisp
26496
26497 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26498
26499 @lisp
26500 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26501 @end lisp
26502
26503 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26504 ever get them confused.
26505
26506 @iflatex
26507 @c @head
26508 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26509 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26510 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26511 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26512 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26513 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26514 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26515 @end iflatex
26516
26517 @end iftex
26518
26519
26520 @node On Writing Manuals
26521 @section On Writing Manuals
26522
26523 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26524 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26525 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26526 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26527 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26528 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26529 hand in hand.
26530
26531 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26532 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26533 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26534 started with Gnus.
26535
26536 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26537 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26538
26539
26540 @page
26541 @node Terminology
26542 @section Terminology
26543
26544 @cindex terminology
26545 @table @dfn
26546
26547 @item news
26548 @cindex news
26549 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26550 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26551 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26552 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26553 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26554
26555 @item mail
26556 @cindex mail
26557 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26558 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26559 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26560 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26561
26562 @item reply
26563 @cindex reply
26564 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26565
26566 @item follow up
26567 @cindex follow up
26568 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26569 are reading.
26570
26571 @item back end
26572 @cindex back end
26573 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26574 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26575 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26576 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26577 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26578 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26579 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26580 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26581 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26582 number 4711''.
26583
26584 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26585 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26586 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26587 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26588 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26589 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26590
26591 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26592 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26593 access the articles.
26594
26595 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26596 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26597 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26598 confusing.
26599
26600 @item native
26601 @cindex native
26602 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26603 default, way of getting news.
26604
26605 @item foreign
26606 @cindex foreign
26607 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26608 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26609 news.
26610
26611 @item secondary
26612 @cindex secondary
26613 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26614 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26615
26616 @item article
26617 @cindex article
26618 A message that has been posted as news.
26619
26620 @item mail message
26621 @cindex mail message
26622 A message that has been mailed.
26623
26624 @item message
26625 @cindex message
26626 A mail message or news article
26627
26628 @item head
26629 @cindex head
26630 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26631 put.
26632
26633 @item body
26634 @cindex body
26635 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26636 body.
26637
26638 @item header
26639 @cindex header
26640 A line from the head of an article.
26641
26642 @item headers
26643 @cindex headers
26644 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26645 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26646
26647 @item @acronym{NOV}
26648 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26649 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26650 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26651 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26652 normal @sc{head} format.
26653
26654 @item level
26655 @cindex levels
26656 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26657 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26658 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26659 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26660 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26661 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26662
26663 @item killed groups
26664 @cindex killed groups
26665 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26666 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26667
26668 @item zombie groups
26669 @cindex zombie groups
26670 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26671
26672 @item active file
26673 @cindex active file
26674 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26675 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26676 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26677
26678 @item bogus groups
26679 @cindex bogus groups
26680 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26681 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26682 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26683
26684 @item activating
26685 @cindex activating groups
26686 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26687 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26688 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26689
26690 @item spool
26691 @cindex spool
26692 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26693 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26694 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26695
26696 @item server
26697 @cindex server
26698 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26699
26700 @item select method
26701 @cindex select method
26702 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26703 server settings.
26704
26705 @item virtual server
26706 @cindex virtual server
26707 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26708 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26709 whole is a virtual server.
26710
26711 @item washing
26712 @cindex washing
26713 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26714 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26715 original.
26716
26717 @item ephemeral groups
26718 @cindex ephemeral groups
26719 @cindex temporary groups
26720 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26721 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26722 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26723
26724 @item solid groups
26725 @cindex solid groups
26726 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26727 group buffer are solid groups.
26728
26729 @item sparse articles
26730 @cindex sparse articles
26731 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26732 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26733
26734 @item threading
26735 @cindex threading
26736 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26737 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26738
26739 @item root
26740 @cindex root
26741 @cindex thread root
26742 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26743 articles in the thread.
26744
26745 @item parent
26746 @cindex parent
26747 An article that has responses.
26748
26749 @item child
26750 @cindex child
26751 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26752
26753 @item digest
26754 @cindex digest
26755 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26756 specified by RFC 1153.
26757
26758 @item splitting
26759 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26760 @cindex mail sorting
26761 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26762 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26763 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26764
26765 @end table
26766
26767
26768 @page
26769 @node Customization
26770 @section Customization
26771 @cindex general customization
26772
26773 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26774 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26775 for some quite common situations.
26776
26777 @menu
26778 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26779 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26780 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26781 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26782 @end menu
26783
26784
26785 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26786 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26787
26788 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26789 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26790 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26791
26792 @table @code
26793
26794 @item gnus-read-active-file
26795 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26796 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26797 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26798 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26799 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26800
26801 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26802 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26803 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26804 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26805 @end table
26806
26807
26808 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26809 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26810
26811 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26812 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26813 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26814
26815 @table @code
26816
26817 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26818 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26819 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26820 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26821 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26822
26823 @item gnus-visible-headers
26824 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26825 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26826 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26827 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26828
26829 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
26830 @lisp
26831 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26832 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26833 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26834 @end lisp
26835
26836 @item gnus-use-full-window
26837 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26838 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26839 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26840 want to read them anyway.
26841
26842 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26843 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26844 hidden initially.
26845
26846
26847 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26848 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26849 lines, which might save some time.
26850 @end table
26851
26852
26853 @node Little Disk Space
26854 @subsection Little Disk Space
26855 @cindex disk space
26856
26857 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26858 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26859
26860 @table @code
26861
26862 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26863 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26864 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26865 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26866 default.
26867
26868 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26869 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26870 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26871 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26872 default.
26873
26874 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26875 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26876 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26877 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26878 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26879
26880 @end table
26881
26882
26883 @node Slow Machine
26884 @subsection Slow Machine
26885 @cindex slow machine
26886
26887 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26888 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26889
26890 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26891 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26892
26893 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26894 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26895 summary buffer faster.
26896
26897
26898 @page
26899 @node Troubleshooting
26900 @section Troubleshooting
26901 @cindex troubleshooting
26902
26903 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26904 problems, really.
26905
26906 Ahem.
26907
26908 @enumerate
26909
26910 @item
26911 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26912
26913 @item
26914 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26915 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26916 Gnus will work.
26917
26918 @item
26919 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26920 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26921 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26922
26923 @item
26924 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26925 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26926
26927 @item
26928 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26929 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26930 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26931 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26932 something like that.
26933 @end enumerate
26934
26935 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26936
26937 @cindex bugs
26938 @cindex reporting bugs
26939
26940 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26941 @findex gnus-bug
26942 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26943 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26944 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26945 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26946
26947 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26948 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26949 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26950 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26951 time.
26952
26953 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26954 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26955 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26956 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26957 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26958 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26959
26960 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26961 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26962 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26963 the bug report.
26964
26965 @cindex patches
26966 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26967 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26968
26969 @cindex edebug
26970 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26971 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26972 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26973 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26974 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26975 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26976 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26977 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26978 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26979 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26980 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26981 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26982 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26983 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26984
26985 @cindex elp
26986 @cindex profile
26987 @cindex slow
26988 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26989 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26990 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26991 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26992 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26993
26994 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26995 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26996 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26997 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26998 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26999 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27000 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27001 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27002 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27003 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27004 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27005 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27006 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27007 work perfectly.
27008
27009 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27010 @cindex ding mailing list
27011 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27012 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27013 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27014 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27015
27016
27017 @page
27018 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27019 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27020
27021 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27022 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27023 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27024 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27025 it.
27026
27027 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27028 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27029 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27030 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27031 and general methods of operation.
27032
27033 @menu
27034 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27035 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27036 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27037 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27038 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27039 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27040 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27041 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27042 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27043 @end menu
27044
27045
27046 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27047 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27048 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27049 @cindex utility functions
27050 @cindex functions
27051 @cindex internal variables
27052
27053 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27054 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27055 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27056
27057 @table @code
27058
27059 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27060 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27061 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27062
27063 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27064 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27065 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27066
27067 @item gnus-group-real-name
27068 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27069 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27070 name.
27071
27072 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27073 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27074 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27075 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27076
27077 @item gnus-get-info
27078 @findex gnus-get-info
27079 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27080
27081 @item gnus-group-unread
27082 @findex gnus-group-unread
27083 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27084 unknown.
27085
27086 @item gnus-active
27087 @findex gnus-active
27088 The active entry for @var{group}.
27089
27090 @item gnus-set-active
27091 @findex gnus-set-active
27092 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27093
27094 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27095 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27096 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27097 exit.
27098
27099 @item gnus-continuum-version
27100 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27101 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27102 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27103 versions.
27104
27105 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27106 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27107 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27108
27109 @item gnus-news-group-p
27110 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27111 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27112
27113 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27114 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27115 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27116
27117 @item gnus-server-to-method
27118 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27119 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27120
27121 @item gnus-server-equal
27122 @findex gnus-server-equal
27123 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27124
27125 @item gnus-group-native-p
27126 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27127 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27128
27129 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27130 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27131 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27132
27133 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27134 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27135 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27136
27137 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27138 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27139 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27140 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27141
27142 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27143 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27144 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27145
27146 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27147 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27148 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27149
27150 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27151 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27152 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27153 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27154
27155 @lisp
27156 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27157 @result{} t
27158 @end lisp
27159
27160 @item gnus-read-method
27161 @findex gnus-read-method
27162 Prompts the user for a select method.
27163
27164 @end table
27165
27166
27167 @node Back End Interface
27168 @subsection Back End Interface
27169
27170 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27171 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27172 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27173 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27174 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27175 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27176
27177 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27178 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27179 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27180 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27181 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27182 been opened, the function should fail.
27183
27184 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27185 name. Take this example:
27186
27187 @lisp
27188 (nntp "odd-one"
27189 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27190 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27191 @end lisp
27192
27193 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27194 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27195
27196 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27197 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27198 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27199
27200 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27201 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27202 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27203
27204 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27205 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27206 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27207 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27208 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27209 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27210 return value.
27211
27212 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27213 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27214 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27215 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27216 more.
27217
27218 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27219 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27220 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27221 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27222 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27223 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27224 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27225 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27226 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27227 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27228
27229 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27230 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27231 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27232 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27233 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27234 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27235 of numbers as long as possible.
27236
27237 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27238 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27239 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27240
27241 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27242 @code{nnchoke}.
27243
27244 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27245
27246 @menu
27247 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27248 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27249 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27250 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27251 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27252 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27253 @end menu
27254
27255
27256 @node Required Back End Functions
27257 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27258
27259 @table @code
27260
27261 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27262
27263 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27264 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27265 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27266 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27267
27268 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27269 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27270 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27271 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27272
27273 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27274 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27275 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27276 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27277 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27278 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27279 number, do maximum fetches.
27280
27281 Here's an example HEAD:
27282
27283 @example
27284 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27285 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27286 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27287 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27288 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27289 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27290 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27291 Lines: 26
27292 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27293 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27294 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27295 .
27296 @end example
27297
27298 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27299 these in the data buffer.
27300
27301 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27302
27303 @example
27304 headers = *head
27305 head = error / valid-head
27306 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27307 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27308 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27309 header = <text> eol
27310 @end example
27311
27312 @cindex BNF
27313 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27314
27315 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27316 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27317 separated by tabs.
27318
27319 @example
27320 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27321 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27322 field = <text except TAB>
27323 @end example
27324
27325 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27326 @pxref{Headers}.
27327
27328
27329 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27330
27331 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27332 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27333
27334 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27335 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27336 server. In fact, it should do so.
27337
27338 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27339 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27340
27341
27342 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27343
27344 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27345 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27346 reason.
27347
27348 There should be no data returned.
27349
27350
27351 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27352
27353 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27354 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27355 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27356 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27357
27358 There should be no data returned.
27359
27360
27361 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27362
27363 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27364 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27365 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27366 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27367
27368 There should be no data returned.
27369
27370
27371 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27372
27373 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27374
27375 There should be no data returned.
27376
27377
27378 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27379
27380 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27381 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27382 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27383 it would be nice if that were possible.
27384
27385 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27386 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27387 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27388 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27389 into its article buffer.
27390
27391 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27392 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27393 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27394 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27395 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27396 on successful article retrieval.
27397
27398
27399 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27400
27401 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27402 making @var{group} the current group.
27403
27404 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27405 the current group.
27406
27407 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27408
27409 @example
27410 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27411 @end example
27412
27413 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27414 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27415 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27416 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27417 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27418 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27419 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27420 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27421 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27422 highest as 0.
27423
27424 @example
27425 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27426 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27427 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27428 @end example
27429
27430
27431 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27432
27433 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27434 a no-op on most back ends.
27435
27436 There should be no data returned.
27437
27438
27439 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27440
27441 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27442 @emph{all}.
27443
27444 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27445
27446 @example
27447 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27448 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27449 @end example
27450
27451 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27452 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27453 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27454 and the highest as 0.
27455
27456 @example
27457 active-file = *active-line
27458 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27459 name = <string>
27460 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27461 @end example
27462
27463 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27464 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27465 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27466
27467
27468 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27469
27470 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27471 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27472 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27473 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27474 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27475 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27476
27477 There should be no result data from this function.
27478
27479 @end table
27480
27481
27482 @node Optional Back End Functions
27483 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27484
27485 @table @code
27486
27487 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27488
27489 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27490 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27491 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27492
27493 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27494 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27495 former is in the same format as the data from
27496 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27497 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27498
27499 @example
27500 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27501 @end example
27502
27503
27504 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27505
27506 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27507 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27508 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27509 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27510 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27511
27512 There should be no result data from this function.
27513
27514
27515 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27516
27517 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27518 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27519 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27520 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27521 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27522 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27523 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27524 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27525
27526 There should be no result data from this function.
27527
27528
27529 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27530
27531 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27532 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27533 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27534 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27535 propagate the mark information to the server.
27536
27537 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27538
27539 @example
27540 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27541 @end example
27542
27543 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27544 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27545 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27546 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27547 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27548 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27549 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27550 possible, not limit itself to these.
27551
27552 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27553 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27554 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27555 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27556
27557 An example action list:
27558
27559 @example
27560 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27561 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27562 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27563 @end example
27564
27565 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27566 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27567
27568 There should be no result data from this function.
27569
27570 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27571
27572 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27573 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27574 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27575 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27576 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27577
27578 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27579 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27580 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27581 expirable.
27582
27583 There should be no result data from this function.
27584
27585
27586 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27587
27588 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27589 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27590 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27591 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27592 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27593 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27594 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27595 local if that's practical.
27596
27597 There should be no result data from this function.
27598
27599
27600 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27601
27602 The result data from this function should be a description of
27603 @var{group}.
27604
27605 @example
27606 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27607 name = <string>
27608 description = <text>
27609 @end example
27610
27611 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27612
27613 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27614 groups available on the server.
27615
27616 @example
27617 description-buffer = *description-line
27618 @end example
27619
27620
27621 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27622
27623 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27624 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27625 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27626 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27627 in the active buffer format.
27628
27629 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27630 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27631 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27632 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27633 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27634 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27635 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27636
27637
27638 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27639
27640 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27641
27642 There should be no return data.
27643
27644
27645 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27646
27647 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27648 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27649 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27650 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27651 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27652 they are.
27653
27654 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27655 able to delete.
27656
27657 There should be no result data returned.
27658
27659
27660 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27661
27662 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27663 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27664
27665 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27666 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27667 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27668 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27669 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27670 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27671
27672 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27673 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27674 optimizations.
27675
27676 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27677 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27678
27679 There should be no data returned.
27680
27681
27682 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27683
27684 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27685 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27686 this function in short order.
27687
27688 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27689 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27690
27691 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27692 article for that group.
27693
27694 There should be no data returned.
27695
27696
27697 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27698
27699 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27700 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27701
27702 There should be no data returned.
27703
27704
27705 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27706
27707 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27708 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27709 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27710
27711 There should be no data returned.
27712
27713
27714 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27715
27716 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27717 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27718
27719 There should be no data returned.
27720
27721 @end table
27722
27723
27724 @node Error Messaging
27725 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27726
27727 @findex nnheader-report
27728 @findex nnheader-get-report
27729 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27730 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27731 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27732 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27733 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27734 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27735
27736 @lisp
27737 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27738
27739 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27740 @end lisp
27741
27742 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27743 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27744 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27745 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27746
27747 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27748 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27749 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27750
27751
27752 @node Writing New Back Ends
27753 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27754
27755 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27756 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27757 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27758 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27759 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27760 editing articles.
27761
27762 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27763 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27764 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27765
27766 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27767 package called @code{nnoo}.
27768
27769 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27770 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27771 following macros:
27772
27773 @table @code
27774
27775 @item nnoo-declare
27776 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27777 parameters. For instance:
27778
27779 @lisp
27780 (nnoo-declare nndir
27781 nnml nnmh)
27782 @end lisp
27783
27784 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27785 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27786
27787 @item defvoo
27788 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27789 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27790 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27791
27792 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27793 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27794 a function in those back ends.
27795
27796 @lisp
27797 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27798 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27799 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27800 @end lisp
27801
27802 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27803 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27804 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27805
27806 @item nnoo-define-basics
27807 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27808 have.
27809
27810 @lisp
27811 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27812 @end lisp
27813
27814 @item deffoo
27815 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27816 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27817 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27818
27819 @item nnoo-map-functions
27820 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27821 functions from the parent back ends.
27822
27823 @lisp
27824 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27825 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27826 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27827 @end lisp
27828
27829 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27830 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27831 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27832 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27833
27834 @item nnoo-import
27835 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27836 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27837 haven't already been defined.
27838
27839 @lisp
27840 (nnoo-import nndir
27841 (nnmh
27842 nnmh-request-list
27843 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27844 (nnml))
27845 @end lisp
27846
27847 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27848 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27849 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27850 defined now.
27851
27852 @end table
27853
27854 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27855
27856 @lisp
27857 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27858 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27859
27860 ;;; @r{Code:}
27861
27862 (require 'nnheader)
27863 (require 'nnmh)
27864 (require 'nnml)
27865 (require 'nnoo)
27866 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27867
27868 (nnoo-declare nndir
27869 nnml nnmh)
27870
27871 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27872 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27873 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27874
27875 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27876 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27877 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27878
27879 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27880 nil
27881 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27882 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27883 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27884
27885 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27886 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27887
27888 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27889
27890 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27891
27892 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27893 (setq nndir-directory
27894 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27895 server))
27896 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27897 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27898 (push `(nndir-current-group
27899 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27900 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27901 defs)
27902 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27903 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27904 defs)
27905 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27906
27907 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27908 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27909 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27910 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27911 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27912
27913 (nnoo-import nndir
27914 (nnmh
27915 nnmh-status-message
27916 nnmh-request-list
27917 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27918
27919 (provide 'nndir)
27920 @end lisp
27921
27922
27923 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27924 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27925
27926 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27927 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27928 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27929 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27930 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27931
27932 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27933 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27934
27935 Here's an example:
27936
27937 @lisp
27938 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27939 @end lisp
27940
27941 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27942
27943 The abilities can be:
27944
27945 @table @code
27946 @item mail
27947 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27948 @item post
27949 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27950 @item post-mail
27951 This back end supports both mail and news.
27952 @item none
27953 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27954 different.
27955 @item respool
27956 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27957 articles and groups.
27958 @item address
27959 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27960 true for almost all back ends.
27961 @item prompt-address
27962 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27963 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27964 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27965 @end table
27966
27967
27968 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27969 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27970
27971 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27972 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27973 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27974 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27975
27976 @lisp
27977 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27978 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27979 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27980 @end lisp
27981
27982 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27983 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27984 mail.
27985
27986 This function takes four parameters.
27987
27988 @table @var
27989 @item method
27990 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27991 the call.
27992
27993 @item exit-function
27994 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27995
27996 @item temp-directory
27997 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27998
27999 @item group
28000 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28001 performed for one group only.
28002 @end table
28003
28004 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28005 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28006 find the article number assigned to this article.
28007
28008 The function also uses the following variables:
28009 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28010 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28011 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28012 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28013 this:
28014
28015 @example
28016 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28017 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28018 @end example
28019
28020
28021 @node Score File Syntax
28022 @subsection Score File Syntax
28023
28024 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28025 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28026 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28027
28028 Here's a typical score file:
28029
28030 @lisp
28031 (("summary"
28032 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28033 ("Gnus"))
28034 ("from"
28035 ("Lars" -1000))
28036 (mark -100))
28037 @end lisp
28038
28039 BNF definition of a score file:
28040
28041 @example
28042 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28043 element = rule / atom
28044 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28045 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28046 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28047 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28048 quote = <ascii 34>
28049 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28050 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28051 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28052 date-header = "date"
28053 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28054 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28055 score = "nil" / <integer>
28056 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28057 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28058 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28059 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28060 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28061 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28062 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28063 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28064 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28065 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28066 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28067 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28068 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28069 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28070 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28071 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28072 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28073 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28074 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28075 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28076 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28077 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28078 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28079 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28080 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28081 eval = "eval" space <form>
28082 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28083 @end example
28084
28085 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28086 discarded.
28087
28088 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28089 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28090 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28091 one looong line, then that's ok.
28092
28093 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28094 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28095
28096
28097 @node Headers
28098 @subsection Headers
28099
28100 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28101 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28102 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28103 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28104
28105 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28106 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28107 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28108 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28109 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28110 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28111 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28112
28113 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28114 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28115 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28116 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28117 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28118
28119 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28120 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28121
28122
28123 @node Ranges
28124 @subsection Ranges
28125
28126 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28127 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28128
28129 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28130 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28131 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28132 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28133
28134 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28135 sequence.
28136
28137 @example
28138 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28139 @end example
28140
28141 is transformed into
28142
28143 @example
28144 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28145 @end example
28146
28147 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28148 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28149
28150 @example
28151 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28152 @end example
28153
28154 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28155 is slightly tricky:
28156
28157 @example
28158 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28159 @end example
28160
28161 and
28162
28163 @example
28164 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28165 @end example
28166
28167 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28168
28169 @example
28170 (1 2 3 4 5)
28171 @end example
28172
28173 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28174 also valid:
28175
28176 @example
28177 (1 . 5)
28178 @end example
28179
28180 and is equal to the previous range.
28181
28182 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28183 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28184 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28185 range handling.)
28186
28187 @example
28188 range = simple-range / normal-range
28189 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28190 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28191 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28192 number *[ " " contents ]
28193 @end example
28194
28195 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28196 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28197 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28198 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28199 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28200 sequences.)
28201
28202
28203 @node Group Info
28204 @subsection Group Info
28205
28206 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28207 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28208 describes the group.
28209
28210 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28211 second is a more complex one:
28212
28213 @example
28214 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28215
28216 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28217 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28218 (nnml "")
28219 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28220 @end example
28221
28222 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28223 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28224 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28225 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28226 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28227 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28228 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28229 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28230 this section is about.
28231
28232 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28233 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28234 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28235
28236 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28237
28238 @example
28239 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28240 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28241 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28242 group = quote <string> quote
28243 ralevel = rank / level
28244 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28245 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28246 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28247 read = range
28248 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28249 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28250 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28251 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28252 @end example
28253
28254 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28255 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28256 in pseudo-BNF.
28257
28258 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28259 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28260
28261 @table @code
28262 @item gnus-info-group
28263 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28264 @findex gnus-info-group
28265 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28266 Get/set the group name.
28267
28268 @item gnus-info-rank
28269 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28270 @findex gnus-info-rank
28271 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28272 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28273
28274 @item gnus-info-level
28275 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28276 @findex gnus-info-level
28277 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28278 Get/set the group level.
28279
28280 @item gnus-info-score
28281 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28282 @findex gnus-info-score
28283 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28284 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28285
28286 @item gnus-info-read
28287 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28288 @findex gnus-info-read
28289 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28290 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28291
28292 @item gnus-info-marks
28293 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28294 @findex gnus-info-marks
28295 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28296 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28297
28298 @item gnus-info-method
28299 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28300 @findex gnus-info-method
28301 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28302 Get/set the group select method.
28303
28304 @item gnus-info-params
28305 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28306 @findex gnus-info-params
28307 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28308 Get/set the group parameters.
28309 @end table
28310
28311 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28312 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28313
28314 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28315 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28316 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28317 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28318
28319
28320 @node Extended Interactive
28321 @subsection Extended Interactive
28322 @cindex interactive
28323 @findex gnus-interactive
28324
28325 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28326 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28327 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28328
28329 @lisp
28330 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28331 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28332 ...
28333 )
28334 @end lisp
28335
28336 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28337 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28338 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28339 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28340 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28341 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28342 @code{interactive}.
28343
28344 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28345 adds a few more.
28346
28347 @table @samp
28348 @item y
28349 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28350 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28351 variable.
28352
28353 @item Y
28354 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28355 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28356 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28357
28358 @item A
28359 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28360 function.
28361
28362 @item H
28363 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28364 function.
28365
28366 @item g
28367 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28368 function.
28369
28370 @end table
28371
28372
28373 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28374 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28375 @cindex XEmacs
28376 @cindex Emacsen
28377
28378 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28379 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28380 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28381
28382 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28383 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28384 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28385 Gnus, that's very useful.
28386
28387 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28388 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28389 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28390 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28391 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28392 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28393 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28394 following function:
28395
28396 @lisp
28397 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28398 (start-itimer
28399 "gnus-run-at-time"
28400 `(lambda ()
28401 (,function ,@@args))
28402 time repeat))
28403 @end lisp
28404
28405 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28406 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28407 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28408 all over.
28409
28410 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28411 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28412 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28413
28414 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28415 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28416 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28417
28418
28419 @node Various File Formats
28420 @subsection Various File Formats
28421
28422 @menu
28423 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28424 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28425 @end menu
28426
28427
28428 @node Active File Format
28429 @subsubsection Active File Format
28430
28431 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28432 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28433 in each group.
28434
28435 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28436
28437 @example
28438 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28439 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28440 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28441 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28442 no.general 1000 900 y
28443 @end example
28444
28445 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28446
28447 @example
28448 active = *group-line
28449 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28450 group = <non-white-space string>
28451 spc = " "
28452 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28453 low-number = <positive integer>
28454 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28455 @end example
28456
28457 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28458 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28459
28460
28461 @node Newsgroups File Format
28462 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28463
28464 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28465 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28466 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28467 the user.
28468
28469 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28470 Here's the definition:
28471
28472 @example
28473 newsgroups = *line
28474 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28475 group = <non-white-space string>
28476 tab = <TAB>
28477 description = <string>
28478 @end example
28479
28480
28481 @page
28482 @node Emacs for Heathens
28483 @section Emacs for Heathens
28484
28485 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28486 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28487 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28488 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28489 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28490 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28491 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28492 cat instead.
28493
28494 @menu
28495 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28496 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28497 @end menu
28498
28499
28500 @node Keystrokes
28501 @subsection Keystrokes
28502
28503 @itemize @bullet
28504 @item
28505 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28506
28507 @item
28508 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28509 @end itemize
28510
28511 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28512 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28513 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28514 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28515 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28516 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28517
28518 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28519 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28520 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28521 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28522 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28523 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28524 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28525
28526 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28527 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28528 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28529 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28530 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28531 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28532 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28533
28534 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28535 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28536 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28537 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28538 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28539 it.
28540
28541
28542
28543 @node Emacs Lisp
28544 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28545
28546 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28547 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28548 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28549 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28550
28551 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28552 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28553 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28554 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28555 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28556 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28557 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28558 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28559 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28560 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28561
28562 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28563 write the following:
28564
28565 @lisp
28566 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28567 @end lisp
28568
28569 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28570 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28571 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28572 change how Gnus works.
28573
28574 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28575 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28576 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28577 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28578 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28579
28580 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28581 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28582 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28583
28584 Some pitfalls:
28585
28586 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28587 that means:
28588
28589 @lisp
28590 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28591 @end lisp
28592
28593 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28594 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28595
28596 @lisp
28597 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28598 @end lisp
28599
28600 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28601 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28602
28603 @page
28604 @include gnus-faq.texi
28605
28606 @node Index
28607 @chapter Index
28608 @printindex cp
28609
28610 @node Key Index
28611 @chapter Key Index
28612 @printindex ky
28613
28614 @summarycontents
28615 @contents
28616 @bye
28617
28618 @iftex
28619 @iflatex
28620 \end{document}
28621 @end iflatex
28622 @end iftex
28623
28624 @c Local Variables:
28625 @c mode: texinfo
28626 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28627 @c End:
28628
28629 @ignore
28630 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28631 @end ignore